Cargo WorkFor Maritime Operations
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page i
This page intentionally left blank
Cargo WorkFor Maritime Operations
Seventh Edition
D.J. House(formerly Kemp & Young’s Cargo Work)
AMSTERDAM BOSTON HEIDELBERG LONDON NEW YORK OXFORDPARIS SAN DIEGO SAN FRANCISCO SINGAPORE SYDNEY TOKYO
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page iii
Elsevier Butterworth-HeinemannLinacre House, Jordan Hill, Oxford OX2 8DP30 Corporate Drive, Burlington, MA 01803
First published as Cargo Work by Stanford Maritime Ltd 1960Second edition 1965Third edition 1971Reprinted 1972, 1974, 1975, 1977Fourth edition 1980Fifth edition 1982Reprinted 1983, 1985, 1987First published by Butterworth-Heinemann 1990Reprinted 1991Sixth edition 1998Reprinted 2000, 2002, 2003Seventh edition 2005
Copyright © 1982, 1998 Peter Young. All rights reservedCopyright © 1998, D.J. House (Chapter 5). All rights reservedCopyright © 2005, David House. All rights reserved
No part of this publication may be reproduced in any material form (including photocopyingor storing in any medium by electronic means and whether or not transiently or incidentallyto some other use of this publication) without the written permission of the copyright holderexcept in accordance with the provisions of the Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 orunder the terms of a licence issued by the Copyright Licensing Agency Ltd, 90 TottenhamCourt Road, London, England W1T 4LP. Applications for the copyright holder’s writtenpermission to reproduce any part of this publication should be addressed to the publishers
Permissions may be sought directly from Elsevier’s Science and Technology RightsDepartment in Oxford, UK; phone: (�44) (0) 1865 843830; fax: (�44) (0) 1865 853333; email: [emailprotected]. You may also complete your request on-line via theElsevier homepage (http://www.elsevier.com), by selecting ‘Customer Support’ and then‘Obtaining Permissions’
British Library Cataloguing in Publication DataA catalogue record for this book is available from the British Library
Library of Congress Cataloguing in Publication Data2004118249
ISBN 0 7506 6555 6
Typeset by Charon Tec Pvt. Ltd, Chennai, Indiawww.charontec.comPrinted and bound in Great Britain
For information on all Elsevier Butterworth-Heinemann publications visit our website at www.books.elsevier.com
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page iv
Contents
Preface viiAbout the author ixAcknowledgements xiList of abbreviations used in the context of cargo work xiiiConversion and measurement table xix
Chapter 1. General principles of the handling, stowage andcarriage of cargoes 1
Chapter 2. Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 33Chapter 3. Stowage properties of general cargoes 69Chapter 4. Bulk cargoes 100Chapter 5. Tanker cargoes 126Chapter 6. Specialist cargoes – timber, refrigerated and livestock
cargoes 188Chapter 7. Roll-on, Roll-off operations 202Chapter 8. Containers and containerization 230Chapter 9. Special cargoes, hazardous goods and deck cargoes 259Chapter 10. Security, cargo documentation, stability examples 276
Appendix A Miscellaneous cargo information 290Appendix B Self-examiner – questions and recommended answers to cargo
related examples 295Appendix C Codes and conventions affecting cargo work operations,
additional references and bibliography 303
Commodity and detail index 305General index 315
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page v
This page intentionally left blank
Preface
The world of cargo operations has changed considerably from the days ofthe open stowage of merchandise. Unitized cargoes in the form of ‘contain-ers’ or Roll-on, Roll-off cargoes and pallatization have generated a need foralternative handling methods and changing procedures.
The work of the stevedore/longshoreman has moved on to a vastly dif-ferent role to that previously employed in general cargo holds. The cargounits are labour saving and tend to require a different mode of working. Inmany cases, ship’s crews or rigging gangs have replaced the role of the pre-vious style of dock labour. The fork lift truck and the container gantry havebeen the source of the major causes of change within the cargo-handlingenvironment and the demise of labour intensive activities.
Unlike the previous editions of ‘Cargo Work’, this new text has taken thechanges to the industry and included the cargo-handling equipment andthe procedures being adopted in our present day. It is anticipated that car-goes can no longer be a stand-alone topic and must incorporate the modernmethods of handling, stowage and commodity together.
The two topics of cargoes and handling equipment have therefore beencombined in order to appeal to a wider readership and give greater cover-age to the prime function of shipping.
This edition has been totally revised by:D.J. House
Master MarinerSenior Lecturer Nautical StudiesMarine AuthorPatent Holder (GB2240748)
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page vii
This page intentionally left blank
About the author
David House started his sea-going career on general cargo/passenger liners in 1963. During his sea-going career he gained experience of manyvessel types and trades, including refrigerated (reefer) vessels to SouthAmerica on the chilled and frozen meat trade.
His activities included shipping containers from Europe to NorthAmerica and general cargoes worldwide, during which period he gainedextensive knowledge on heavy-lift operations.
His bulk cargo experience was obtained from the carriage of a variety ofproducts, inclusive of grain, sugar, tallow, sulphur and coal.
The types of vessels and various trades in which he was engaged hasprovided the foundation for this up-to-date version of Kemp & Young’soriginal work.
David House has served on Roll-on, Roll-off vessels, as well as containertonnage, dealing with all aspects of modern cargo-handling techniques:steel cargoes, heavy lifts, special cargoes, foodstuffs, livestock, as well asthe bulk commodities and general merchandise. He has been involved asboth a Junior and a Senior Cargo Officer, and currently lectures on virtuallyall nautical subjects at the Fleetwood Nautical Campus.
He has researched and published 13 profusely illustrated Marine publi-cations, which are widely read throughout the maritime world. Amongsthis books you can find the following: Navigation for Masters (1995); MarineSurvival and Rescue Systems (1997); An Introduction to Helicopter Operations atSea – a Guide for Industry (1998); Seamanship Techniques, Volume III ‘The Com-mand Companion’ (2000); Anchor Practice – a Guide for Industry (2001); MarineFerry Transports – an Operators Guide (2002); Dry Docking and Shipboard Mainte-nance (2003); Seamanship Techniques, third edition (2004); Seamanship Examiner(2005); Heavy Lift and Rigging (in press). www.djhouseonline.com
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page ix
This page intentionally left blank
Acknowledgements
B&V, Industrietechnik GmbHBritish Nuclear FuelsBritish Standards InstitutionBruntons (Musselburgh) Ltd.Dubai Dry Docks UAEInternational Maritime Organization (publications)James Fisher Shipping CompanyMacGregor International OrganisationMaritime and Coastguard AgencyMotor Ship (published by IPC Industrial Press Ltd.)Overseas Containers Ltd.P&O European (Irish Sea) FerriesScheuerle Fahrzeugfabrik GmbHSeaform Design (Isle of Man)Smit InternationalTTS – Mongstad AS
Additional photographyCapt. K.B. Millar, Master Mariner, Lect., Nautical Studies of Millar Marine
ServicesCapt. J.G. Swindlehurst (MN) Master MarinerCapt. A. Malpass (MN) Master MarinerMr M. Gooderman, Master Mariner, B.A. Lecturer Nautical StudiesMr G. Edwards Ch/Eng (MN) Rtd.Mr P. Brooks Ch/Off (MN)Mr J. Leyland (Nautical Lecturer)
I.T. Consultant: Mr C.D. House
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page xi
This page intentionally left blank
List of abbreviations used in the context of Cargo Work
oA Degrees absoluteAAA Association of Average AdjustersABS American Bureau of ShippingAIS Automatic Identification System
B Representative of the ship’s centre of buoyancyBACAT BArge CATamaranBCH Bulk Chemical CodeB/L Bill of LadingBLU (Code) The Code of Practice for Loading and Unloading of Bulk
CargoesBOG Boil-off gasBS (i) Breaking strainBS (ii) British StandardBS (iii) Broken stowageBT Ballast tank
C CentigradeCAS Condition Assessment SchemeCBM Conventional buoy mooringCBT Clean ballast tankCCTV Close Circuit TelevisionCEU Car equivalent unitCh/Off (C/O) Chief Officercm CentimetresCNG Compressed natural gasCoF Certificate of FitnessC of G Centre of gravityCOW Crude oil washingCO2 Carbon dioxide
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page xiii
CSO Company Security OfficerCSS Cargo Stowage and Securing (IMO Code of Safe Practice of)CSWP Code of Safe Working PracticeCTU Cargo transport unitcu Cubic
D DensityDGN Dangerous Goods NoticeDNV Det Norske VeritasDOC Document of ComplianceDWA Dock water allowanceDwt Deadweight tonnage
EC European CommunityEDI Electronic data interchangeEEBDs Emergency escape breathing devicesEFSWR Extra flexible steel wire ropeEU European Union
F (i) FreshF (ii) FahrenheitFloFlo Float-on, Float-offFO Fuel oilFPSOS Floating Production Storage Offloading SystemFSE Free surface effectFSM Free surface momentFSRU Floating storage and re-gasification unitFSU Floating storage unitFSWR Flexible steel wire ropeft FeetFW Fresh waterFWA Fresh water allowance
G Ship’s centre of gravityG/A General averagegal GallonsGG1 Representation of the movement of the ship’s C of G when
moving a weight aboard the vessel.GM Metacentric heightgrt Gross registered tonnageGZ Ship’s righting lever
HCFC Hydro chlorofluorocarbonsHDFD Heavy duty, floating derrickHMSO Her Majesty’s Stationary OfficeHP (i) High pressure
(ii) Horse power
xiv Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page xiv
HSC High-speed craftHSE Health and Safety ExecutiveHSMS Hull stress monitoring systemHSSC Harmonized System of Survey and Certification
IACS International Association of Classification SocietiesIBC International Bulk Cargo (Code)ICS International Chamber of ShippingIG Inert gasIGC Inert Gas CodeIGS Inert Gas SystemILO International Labour OrganizationIMDG International Maritime Dangerous Goods (code)IMO International Maritime OrganizationIOPP International Oil Pollution Prevention (certificate)ISGOTT International Safety Guide for Oil Tankers and TerminalsISM International Safety ManagementISPS International Ship and Port Facility Security (Code)ISSC International Ships Security CertificationITU Inter-modal transport unit
K Representative of the ship’s keelkg (k) Kilograms (kilo)KM Representative of the distance from the ship’s keel to the
metacentrekN Kilo-newtonskt KnotskW Kilowatt
L Lumber (loadlines)LASH Lighter Aboard SHip (system)lb PoundsLCG Longitudinal centre of gravityLEL Lower explosive limitLFL Lower flammable limitL/H Lower holdLNG Liquefied natural gasLo-Lo Load-on, Load-offLP Low PressureLPG (i) Liquid propane gas
(ii) Liquid petroleum gas
m MetresM MetacentreMA Mechanical advantageMARPOL Maritime Pollution (convention)
List of abbreviations xv
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page xv
MARVs Maximum Allowable Relief Value SettingsMCA Maritime and Coastguard AgencyMCTC (MTC) Moment to change trim 1 cmMEPC Marine Environment Protection CommitteeMFAG Medical First Aid Guide (for use with accidents involving
dangerous goods)MGN Marine Guidance NoticeMIN Marine Information Noticemm MillimetresMN Mercantile Marine (Merchant Navy)MPCU Marine Pollution Control UnitMS Merchant Shipping ActMSC (i) Maritime Safety Committee (of IMO)MSC (ii) Mediterranean Shipping CompanyMSL Maximum securing loadMSN Merchant Shipping NoticeMTSA Maritime Transport Security Act (US)MV Motor vesselMW Megawatt
NLS Noxious liquid substancesNMVOC Non-methane volatile organic compoundNOS Not otherwise specifiedNPSH Net positive suction headNRV Non-return valve
OBO Oil, bulk, ore (carrier)OCIMF Oil Companies International Marine ForumORB Oil Record Book
P PortPa PascalP/A System Public Address SystemPCC Pure car carrierPCTC Pure car and truck carrierPEL Permissible exposure limitPFSP Port Facility Security PlanP/L Protective locationPMA Permanent means of accessPNG Pressurized natural gasppm Parts per millionPSC Port State Controlpsi Pounds per square inchPSO Port Security OfficerP/V Pressure vacuum
xvi Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page xvi
R ResistanceRD Relative densityRMC Refrigerated Machinery CertificateRo-Pax Roll-on, Roll-off plus PassengersRo-Ro Roll-on, Roll-offrpm Revolutions per minuteRVP Reid vapour pressure
S (Stbd)(i) StarboardS (ii) SummerSBM Single buoy mooringSBT Segregated ballast tankSCBA Self-contained breathing apparatusSeaBee Sea bargeSECU StoraEnso Cargo UnitSF Stowage factorS.I. Statutory InstrumentSMC Safety Management CertificateSOLAS Safety of Life at Sea (Convention)SOPEP Ships Oil Pollution Emergency PlanSOx Oxides of sulphurSPG Self-supporting Prismatic-shape Gas tankSRV system Shuttle and Re-gasification Vessel systemSSO Ship Security OfficerSSP Ship Security PlanSW Salt waterSWL Safe working loadSWR Steel wire rope
T TropicalT/D Tween deckTEU Twenty feet equivalent unitTF Tropical freshTk TankTLVs Threshold limit valuesTPC Tonnes per centimetreTWA Time weighted average
U Union Purchase – safe working loadUEL Upper explosive limitUFL Upper flammable limitUHP Ultra high pressureUK United KingdomUKC Under keel clearanceULCC Ultra large crude carrierULLNGC Ultra large liquefied natural gas carrier
List of abbreviations xvii
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page xvii
UN United NationsUS United StatesUSA United States of AmericaUSCG United States Coast GuardU-SWL Union Rig – safe working load
VCM Vinyl chloride monomerVDR Voyage Data RecorderVLCC Very large crude carrierVOCs Volatile organic compoundsVR Velocity ratio
W (i) WinterW (ii) Representative of the ship’s displacementWBT Water ballast tankWC Water-closet (Toilet)W/L WaterlineWNA Winter North Atlanticwps Wires per strand
YAR York Antwerp Rules (2004)
xviii Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page xviii
Conversion and measurementtable
Imperial/metric measurement1 in. � 2.5400 cm 1 cm � 0.3937 in.1 ft � 0.3048 m 1 m � 3.2808 ft
1 in.2 � 6.4516 cm2 1 cm2 � 0.1550 in.2
1ft2 � 0.09293 m2 1 m2 � 10.7639 ft2
1 in.2 � 16.3871 cm3 1 cm3 � 0.0610 m3
1 ft3 � 0.02832 m3 1 m3 � 35.3146 ft2
(where in. represents inches)
Metres to feetCm Feet Metres Feet Metres Feet Metres Feet1 0.03 1 3.28 17 55.77 60 196.852 0.06 2 6.56 18 59.06 70 229.663 0.09 3 9.84 19 62.34 80 262.474 0.13 4 13.12 20 65.62 90 295.285 0.16 5 16.40 21 68.90 100 328.086 0.19 6 19.69 22 72.18 200 656.177 0.22 7 22.97 23 75.46 300 984.258 0.26 8 26.25 24 78.74 400 1312.339 0.30 9 29.53 25 82.02 500 1640.42
10 0.33 10 32.81 26 85.30 600 1968.5020 0.66 11 36.09 27 88.58 700 2296.5830 0.98 12 39.37 28 91.86 800 2624.6640 1.31 13 42.65 29 95.15 900 2952.7450 1.64 14 45.93 30 98.43 1000 3280.8360 1.97 15 49.21 40 131.2370 2.30 16 52.49 50 164.0480 2.6290 2.95
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page xix
Tonnage and fluid measurementUS gallons Imperial gallons Capacity cubic feet
1 gal (imp) �1.2 �1 �0.16041 gal (US) �1.0 �0.8333 �0.13371 ft3 �7.48 �0.2344 �1.01 l �0.2642 �0.22 �0.03531-tonne fresh water �269 �224 �35.841-tonne salt water �262.418 �218.536 �35
Weight Short ton Long ton Metric tonne
Long ton (imp) �1.12 �1.0 �1.01605Short ton (USA) �1.0 �0.89286 �0.90718Metric tonne �1.10231 �0.98421 �1.0
Grain Bushel (imp) Bushel (USA) Cubic feet
1 Bushel (imp) �1.0 �1.0316 �1.28371 Bushel (USA) �0.9694 �1.0 �1.24451 ft3 �0.789 �0.8035 �1.0
Miscellaneous1 lb � 0.45359 kg 1 kg � 2.20462 lb1 ft3/tonne � 0.16 imp gal/tonne1 tonne/m3 � 0.02787 tonne/ft3
1 m3/tonne � 35.8816 ft3/tonne
xx Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Feet to metres
Inches Metres Feet Metres Feet Metres Feet Metres1 0.03 1 0.30 80 24.38 800 243.842 0.05 2 0.61 90 27.43 850 259.083 0.08 3 0.91 100 30.48 900 274.324 0.10 4 1.22 150 45.72 950 289.565 0.13 5 1.52 200 60.96 1000 304.806 0.15 6 1.83 250 76.20 1100 335.287 0.18 7 2.13 300 91.44 1200 365.768 0.20 8 2.44 350 106.68 1300 396.249 0.23 9 2.74 400 121.92 1400 426.72
10 0.25 10 3.05 450 137.16 1500 457.2011 0.28 20 6.10 500 152.40 2000 609.6012 0.30 30 9.14 550 167.64 3000 914.40
40 12.19 600 182.88 4000 1219.2050 15.24 650 198.12 5000 1524.0060 18.29 700 213.3670 21.34 750 228.60
Prelims.qxd 3/3/05 6:01 PM Page xx
Chapter 1
General principles of thehandling, stowage and carriage of cargoes
IntroductionThe transport of cargoes dates back through the centuries to the Egyptians,the Phoenicians, ancient Greeks and early Chinese, long before theEuropeans, ventured beyond the shores of the Atlantic. Strong evidenceexists that the Chinese Treasure Ships traded for spices, and charted theAmericas, Antarctica, Australia and the Pacific and Indian Oceans, beforeColumbus reportedly discovered America.*
The stones for the Pyramids of Egypt had to be brought up the River Nileor across the Mediterranean and this would reflect the means of lifting heavyweights, and transporting the same was a known science even before the birthof Christ. Marco Polo reported 200 000 vessels a year were plying the YangtzeRiver of China in 1271 and it must be assumed that commerce was verymuch alive with a variety of merchandise being transported over water.
Products from the world’s markets have grown considerably alongsidetechnology.
Bigger and better ships feed the world populations and the methods offaster and safer transport have evolved over the centuries.
The various cargoes and merchandise may be broadly divided into thefollowing six types:
1. Bulk solids2. Bulk liquids3. Containerized units4. Refrigerated/chilled5. General, which includes virtually everything not in (1), (2), (3) and (4)
above6. Roll-on, Roll-off (Ro-Ro) cargoes.
* Menzies, G. (2002) 1421 The Year China Discovered the World, Bantam Press.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 1
Bulk cargoes can be loaded and discharged from a ship quickly and effi-ciently. Conversely, we have yet to see 10 000 tonnes of grain being loadedinto a Jumbo Jet. Ships remain the most efficient means of transport for allcargo parcels of any respectable weight or size.
It is here that the business of how it is loaded, how it is stowed and sub-sequently shipped to its destination is investigated. Later chapters will dealwith specifics on the commodities, but the methods of handling prior tostarting the voyage and the practical stowage of goods, should be con-sidered an essential element of the foundation to successful trade.
Definitions and cargo terminologyAir draught – means the vertical distance from the surface of the water to thehighest point of the ship’s mast or aerial.
Bale space capacity – is that cubic capacity of a cargo space when the breadthis measured from the inside of the cargo battens (spar ceiling) and themeasured depth is from the wood tank top ceiling to the underside of thedeck beams. The length is measured from the inside of the fore and aftbulkhead stiffeners.Broken stowage – is defined as that space between packages which remainsunfilled. The percentage that has to be allowed varies with the type of cargoand with the shape of the ship’s hold. It is greatest when large cases arestowed in an end hold or at the turn of a bilge.Cargo information – means appropriate information relevant to the cargoand its stowage and securing which should specify, in particular, the pre-cautions necessary for the safe carriage of that cargo by sea.Cargo plan – a ship’s plan which shows the distribution of all cargo parcelsstowed on board the vessel for the voyage. Each entry onto the plan woulddetail the quantity, the weight and the port of discharge. The plan is con-structed by the Ship’s Cargo Officer and would effectively show specialloads such as heavy-lifts, hazardous cargoes, and valuable cargo, in add-ition to all other commodities being shipped.Cargo runner – a general term used to describe the cargo lifting wire used ona derrick. It may be found rove as a ‘single whip’ or doubled up into a ‘guntackle’ (two single blocks) or set into a multi-sheave lifting purchase. It is partof the derricks ‘running rigging’ passing over at least two sheaves set in thehead block and the heel block, prior to being led to the barrel of the winch.Normal size is usually 24 mm and its construction is flexible steel wire rope(FSWR) of 6 � 24 wires per strand (wps).Cargo securing manual – a manual that is pertinent to an individual ship, andwhich will show the lashing points and details of the securing of relevantcargoes carried by the vessel. It is a ship’s reference which specifies the on-board securing arrangements for cargo units, including vehicles andcontainers, and other entities. The securing examples are based on the trans-verse, longitudinal and vertical forces which may arise during adverse
2 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 2
weather conditions at sea. The manual is drawn up to the standard containedin Maritime Safety Committee (MSC) Circular of the Organization,MSC/Circ. 745.
Cargo ship – defined as any ship which is not a ‘Passenger Ship’, troop ship,pleasure vessel or fishing boat.
Cargo spaces – (e.g. cargo hold) – means all enclosed spaces which areappropriate for the transport of cargo to be discharged from the ship. Spaceavailable for cargo may be expressed by either the vessel’s deadweight orher cubic capacity in either bale or grain space terms.
Cargo unit – includes a cargo transport unit and means wheeled cargo, vehicles, containers, flat pallet, portable tank packaged unit or any othercargo and loading equipment or any part thereof, which belongs to the shipand which is not fixed to the ship.
Centre of buoyancy – is defined as the centre of the underwater volume; thatpoint through which all the forces due to buoyancy are considered to act.
Centre of gravity (C of G) – is defined as that point through which all theforces due to gravity are considered to act. Each cargo load will have itsown C of G.
Dangerous goods – are defined as such in the Merchant Shipping (DangerousGoods and Marine Pollutants) Regulations 1990.
Deadweight – means the difference in tonnes between the displacement of a ship at the summer load waterline in water of specific gravity of 1025, andthe lightweight of the ship.
Deadweight cargo – is cargo on which freight is usually charged on its weight.While no hard and fast rules are in force, cargo stowing at less than1.2 m3/tonne (40 ft3/tonne) is likely to be rated as deadweight cargo.
Dunnage – an expression used to describe timber boards which can be laidsingularly or in double pattern under cargo parcels to keep the surface ofthe cargo off the steel deck plate. Its purpose is to provide air space aroundthe cargo and so prevent ‘cargo sweat’. Heavy-lift cargoes would normallyemploy heavy timber bearers to spread the load and dunnage wouldnormally be used for lighter-load cargoes.
Flemish Eye – a name given to a Reduced Eye made of three strands (notsix), spliced into the end of a cargo runner which is secured to the barrel ofa winch (alternative names are Spanish Eye, or Reduced Eye).
Flemish hook – a large hook, often used in conjunction with the lower pur-chase block in the rigging of a heavy-lift derrick. The hook can be openedto accommodate the load slings and then bolt locked.
Floodable length – the maximum length of a compartment that can beflooded to bring a damaged vessel to float at a waterline which is tangentialto the margin line. Note: In determining this length account must be takenof the permeability of the compartment.
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 3
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 3
Freight – the term used to express the monetary charge which is levied forthe carriage of the cargo.
Gooseneck – the bearing and swivel fitment, found at the heel of a derrickwhich allows the derrick to slew from port to starboard, and luff up anddown when in operation.
Grain capacity – is that cubic capacity of a cargo space when the length,breadth and depth are measured from the inside of the ship’s shell plating, allallowances being made for the volume occupied by frames and beams.
Gross tonnage – is defined by the measurement of the total internal capacityof the ship. GT being determined by the formula: GT � KiV where
Ki � 0.2 � 0.02 Log 10V
V � Total volume of all enclosed spaces in cubic metres
Hallen universal swinging derrick – a single swinging derrick with a liftingcapacity of up to about 100 tonnes safe working load (SWL) The originaldesign employed a ‘D’ frame, to segregate the leads of the combined slew-ing and topping lift guys. The more modern design incorporates ‘outrig-gers’ for the same purpose.
Hounds Band – a lugged steel band that straps around a ‘mast’. It is used to shackle on shrouds and stays. It is also employed to secure ‘PreventorBackstays’ when a heavy derrick is being deployed in order to provideadditional strength to the mast structure when making the heavy lift.
Load density plan – a ships plan which indicates the deck load capacity ofcargo space areas of the ship. The Ship’s Chief Officer would consult this planto ensure that the space is not being overloaded by very dense, heavy cargoes.
Long tonne – a unit of mass weight, equal to 2240 lb (tonne).
Luffing – a term which denotes the movement of a crane jib or derrick boomto move up or down, i.e. ‘luff up’ or ‘luff down’.
Luffing derrick – a conventional single swinging derrick rigged in such a man-ner that permits the derrick head to be raised and lowered to establish any lineof plumb, as opposed to static rigged derricks, as with a ‘Union Purchase Rig’.
Measurement cargo – is cargo on which freight is usually charged on thevolume occupied by the cargo. Such cargo is usually light and bulky stow-ing at more than 1.2 m3 per tonne (40 cu. ft./tonne), but may also be heavycastings of an awkward shape where a lot of space is occupied.
Passenger Ship – a ship designed to carry more than 12 passengers.
Permeability – in relation to a compartment space means the percentage of that space which lies below the margin line which can be occupied bywater. Note: various formulae within the Ship Construction Regulations areused to determine the permeability of a particular compartment. Examplevalues are spaces occupied by cargo or stores 60%, spaces employed formachinery 85%, passengers and crew spaces 95%.
4 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 4
Permissible length – of a compartment having its centre at any point in theships length is determined by the product of the floodable length at thatpoint and the factor of subdivision of the vessel:
permissible length � floodable length � factor of subdivision.
Riding turn – an expression that describes a cross turn of wire around a bar-rel of a winch, or stag horn. It is highly undesirable and could cause theload to jump or slip when in movement. The condition should be cleared assoon as possible.
Ring bolt – a deck ring or ‘pad eye’ often used in conjunction with a doubling plate or screw securing. It is employed to provide an anchor pointfor associated rigging around a derrick position.
Running rigging – a descriptive term used to describe wire or cordage ropeswhich pass around the sheave of a block (see also ‘Standing Rigging’).Where steel wire ropes are employed for running rigging they are of a flex-ible construction, examples include: 6 � 24 wps and 6 � 36 wps.
Safe working load – an acceptable working tonnage used for a weight-bear-ing item of equipment. The marine industry uses a factor of one-sixth thebreaking strain (BS) to establish the safe working value.
Safety tongue – a spring clip sealing device to cover the jaw of a lifting hook.It should be noted that these devices are not fool proof and have been knownto slip themselves unintentionally. The tongue is meant to replace the need of‘mousing’ the hook, and is designed to serve the same purpose as a ‘mousing’.
Schooner guy – a bracing guy which joins the spider bands at the derrickheads of a ‘Union Purchase Rig’.
Sheer legs – a large lifting device employed extensively within the marineindustry. It is constructed with a pair of inclined struts resembling a crane,although the action when working is similar to a craning activity. (Smallerversions of sheer legs were previously used within the marine industry ontankers to hoist pipelines on board or more commonly found in trainingestablishments for training cadets in rigging applications.) The modern day sheer legs are now found on floating heavy-lift (crane) barges andemployed for extreme lifting operations usually with ‘project cargoes’.
Shore – a term used to describe a support, given to decks, bulkheads orcargo. They are usually timber, but may be in the form of a metal stanchion,depending on the intended use (see tomming).
Slings – a term which describes the lifting strops to secure the load to behoisted to the lift hook of the derrick or crane. Slings may be manufacturedin steel wire rope, chains, rope or canvas.
Snatch block – a single sheave block, often employed to change the directionof lead, of a wire or rope. The block has a hinged clamp situated over the‘swallow’ which allows the bight of a wire or rope to be set into the blockwithout having to pull the end through.
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 5
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 5
Snotter – a length of steel wire with an eye in each end. Employed aroundloads as a lifting sling, with one eye passed through the other to tighten thewire around the load.
Speed crane – modern derrick design with multi-gear operation which oper-ates on the principle of the single jib, point loading crane.
Spider band – a steel lugged strap found around the head of a derrick whichthe rigging, such as the topping lift and guys are shackled onto. The equiv-alent on a mast structure is known as a ‘Hounds Band’.
Spreader – a steel or wood batten which effectively spreads the wire slingarrangement wider apart when lifting a large area load. Use of such aspreader generally provides greater stability to the movement of theweight. Formerly referred to as a lifting beam.
Stabilizers – Steel outriders, often telescopic in design and fitted with spreadfeet, which are extended from the base unit of a shoreside mobile crane.Prior to taking the load the stabilizers are set to ensure that the load on thecrane jib will not cause the crane to topple. (Not to be confused with shipstabilizers fitted to ships to reduce rolling actions of the vessel when at sea.)
Standing Rigging – a term used to describe fixed steel wire rope supports.Examples can be found in ship’s stays and shrouds. Construction of Stand-ing Rigging is usually 6 � 6 wps.
Stowage factor – this is defined as that volume occupied by unit weight ofcargo. Usually expressed as cubic metres per tonne (m3/tonnes) or cubicfeet per tonne (ft3/tonne). It does not take account of any space which may be lost due to ‘broken stowage’. A representative list of stowage factors isprovided at the end of this book.
Subdivision factor – the factor of subdivision varies inversely with the ship’slength, the number of passengers and the proportion of the underwaterspace used for passenger/crew and machinery space. In effect it is the fac-tor of safety allowed in determining the maximum space of transversewatertight bulkheads, i.e. the permissible length.
Tomming off – an expression that describes the securing of cargo parcels bymeans of baulks of timber. These being secured against the cargo to preventits movement if and when the vessel is in a seaway and experiencing heavyrolling or pitching motions (alternative term is ‘shore’).
Tonne – originated from the word ‘tun’ which was a term used to describe awine cask or wine container, the capacity of which was stated as being 252gallons as required by an Act of 1423, made by the English Parliament. It issynonymous that 252 gallons of wine equated to approximately 2240 lb, ‘1 tonne’ as we know it today.
Trunnion – a similar arrangement to the ‘gooseneck’ of a small derrick. TheTrunnion is normally found on intermediate size derricks of 40 tonnes orover. They are usually manufactured in cast steel and allow freedom ofmovement from the lower heel position of the derrick.
6 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 6
Tumbler – a securing swivel connection found attached to the ‘Samson Post’or ‘Mast Table’ to support the topping lift blocks of the span tackle.
‘U’ bolt – a bolt application which secures the reduced eye of a cargo runnerto the barrel of a winch.
Union Plate – a triangular steel plate set with three eyelets used in ‘UnionRig’ to join the cargo runners and hook arrangement when a ‘triple swivelhook’ is not employed. It can also be used with a single span, topping liftderrick to couple the downhaul with the chain preventor and bull wire.Sometimes referred to as ‘Monkey Face Plate’.
Union Rig – Alt; Union Purchase Rig. A derrick rig which joins two singleswinging derricks to work in ‘Union’ with cargo runners joined to a tripleswivel hook arrangement known as a ‘Seattle Hook’ or ‘Union Hook’. The rig was previously known as ‘Yard and Stay’ and is a fast method ofloading/discharging lighter parcels of cargo. Union Rig operates atapproximately one-third of the SWL of the smallest derrick of the pair.
Velle Derrick – a moderate heavy-lift derrick that can be operated as a craneby a single operator. The derrick is constructed with a ‘T’ bridle piece at thehead of the derrick which allows topping lift wires to be secured to act inway of slewing guys and/or topping lift.
Walk back – an expression which signifies reversing the direction of a winch inorder to allow the load to descend or the weight to come off the hoist wires.
Weather deck – means the uppermost complete deck exposed to the weatherand the sea.
Wires per strand – an expression (abbreviated as wps) which describes thetype of construction of the strands of a steel wire rope.
Yard and Stay – alternative descriptive term for Union Purchase Rig.
Conventional general cargo handling
Cargo gearDerricks, cranes and winches, together with their associated fittings shouldbe regularly overhauled and inspected under a planned maintenanceschedule, appropriate to the ship. Winch guards should always be in placethroughout winching operations and operators should conform to theCode of Safe Working Practice (CSWP) (Figure 1.1).
Only certificated tested wires, blocks and shackles should be used forcargo handling and lifting operations.
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 7
Note: Wire ropes which have broken wires in strands should be replaced. Whenever 10%of wires are broken in any eight (8) diameters length, the wire should be condemned. Guypennants, blocks and tackles should be kept in good condition.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 7
Derrick rigs – Union Purchase MethodThe Union Purchase Method of rigging derricks is perhaps the most com-mon with conventional derrick rigs (Figure 1.2). With this operation, one oftwo derricks plumbs the hatch and the other derrick plumbs overside. Thetwo runner falls of the two derricks are joined together at the cargo ‘UnionHook’ (this is a triple swivel hook arrangement sometimes referred to as a‘Seattle Hook’). The load is lifted by the fall which plumbs the load, whenthe load has been lifted above the height of the bulwark or ship’s rail, orhatch coaming, the load is gradually transferred to the fall from the secondderrick (Figure 1.3).
Cargo movement is achieved by heaving on one derrick runner andslacking on the other. The safe working angle between the runners is 90° andshould never be allowed to exceed 120°. There is a danger from overstress-ing the gear if unskilled winch drivers are employed or if winch drivers do not have an unobstructed view of the lifting/lowering operation. In thelatter case, signallers and hatch foremen should always be employed withinline of sight of winch operators.
The CSWP for Merchant Seaman provides a code of hand signals for usein such cargo operations.
Single swinging derricksThe conventional derrick was initially evolved as a single hoist operationfor the loading and discharging of weights. It was the basic concept as anaid which became popular when combined within a ‘Union Rig’. However,
8 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 1.1 The conventional ‘general cargo’ vessel ‘Sunny Jane’ lies port side to,alongside in the Port of Amsterdam. The vessel is fitted with conventional derricks,
supported by bi-pod mast structures.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 8
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 9
Fig. 1.2 Union purchase. Derrick rig.
Fig. 1.3 The conventional derrick rig. Modern general cargo vessel riggedwith conventional 5 tonne SWL derricks and steel hatch covers. The derrickscan be rigged to operate as single swinging derricks or rigged in ‘Union Purchase’SWL (U) � 1.6 tonnes. Such vessels are in decline because of the growth in unit
load ‘Container and Ro-Ro, Traffic’.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 9
improved materials and better designs have created sophisticated, single derricks in the form of the ‘Hallen’, the ‘Velle’ and the more popular speedcranes. All of which now dominate the reduced activities of general cargoships (Figure 1.4).
Where the single swinging derrick concept has been retained is in thearena of the heavy-lift operation. Here conventional ‘Jumbo Derricks’, ofthe single swinging variety, are still employed amongst specialist rigs as‘Stuelckens’ and heavy-lift ships.
Specialized derrick rigsThe many changes which have occurred in cargo-handling methods havebrought about extensive developments in specialized lifting gear. Thesedevelopments have aimed at efficient and cost-effective cargo handlingand modern vessels will be equipped with some type of specialist rig foroperation within the medium to heavy-lift range.
The ‘Hallen derrick’This is a single swinging derrick which is fast in operation and can work against a list of up to 15°. They are usually manufactured in the 25–40
10 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Topping wires
Compensating wires
Cargopurchaseor runner
Slewing wires
Cargopurchase
Fig. 1.4 Single swinging derrick.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 10
tonne SWL range and, when engaged, operate under a single-man control(Figure 1.5).
Joystick control for luffing and slewing is achieved by the Port andStarboard slewing guys being incorporated into the topping lift arrange-ment. Use of the outriggers from a ‘Y’ mast structure provides clear leads even when the derrick is working at 90° to the ships fore and aft line.A second hoist control can be operated simultaneously with the derrickmovement.
As a one-man operation, it is labour saving over and above the use ofconventional derricks, while at the same time keeps the deck area clear ofguy ropes and preventors. Should heavy loads be involved only the cargohoist would need to be changed to satisfy different load requirements.
The ‘Hallen Derrick’ has a similar concept to the ‘Velle’, in that the toppinglift arrangement and the slewing wires are incorporated together and securedaloft, clear of the lower deck. The outreach and slew are wide achieved by the‘T’ yoke on the Velle Derrick and by outriggers with the Hallen.
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 11
Outrigger stay
Outrigger
Non-twisthoist wire
Roller bearingswivel
Topping/ slewing winch
Derrickjoystick control
Hoist control
Cargo hoist winch
Topping/slewing winch
Fig. 1.5 Hallen Derrick.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 11
Both systems are labour saving and can be operated by a single con-troller, operating the luffing and slewing movement together with thecargo hoist movement.
The Hallen is distinctive by the ‘Y’ mast structure that provides theanchor points for the wide leads. The derrick also accommodates a centrelead sheave to direct the hoist wire to the relevant winch.
‘Velle Derrick’Similar in design to the ‘Hallen’ but without use of outriggers. The leads forthe topping lift and slewing arrangement are spread by a cross ‘T’ piece at the head of the derrick. A widespread structured mast is also a feature ofthis rig (Figures 1.6 and 1.7).
12 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Mast
Hoistwinch
Slew winch
Derrick
Topping winch
Hoist wire
Yoke
Fig. 1.6 Rigging system on the Velle Derrick. Luffing and slewing actions ofthe derrick are powered by two winches each equipped with divided barrels
to which the bare ends of the fall wires are secured.
Again it is a single-man operation, with clear decks being achieved whilein operation. Generally, the ‘Velle’ is manufactured as a heavier rig andvariations of the design with a pivot cross piece at the derrick head are usedwith multi-sheave purchases to accept the heavy type load.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 12
Working with a lifting plantAt no time should any attempt be made to lift weights in excess of the SWLof the weakest part of the gear. The SWL is stamped on all derricks, blocksand shackles as well as noted on the ‘test certificates’. Wire ropes are deliv-ered with a test certificate on which will be found the SWL of the wire.
Assuming that the SWL is one-sixth of the BS, the regulations require aminimum of one-fifth. The approximate SWL of various materials can beobtained from the formula shown in Table 1.1.
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 13
Table 1.1 SWLs for cordage and FSWR
Material Structure BS formula SWL @one-sixth BS
Cordage Manila 3 stranded 2D2/300 2D2/1800hawser laid
Polypropylene 3 stranded hawser laid 3D2/300 3D2/1800
Terylene 3 stranded hawser laid 4D2/300 4D2/1800
Nylon 3 stranded hawser laid 5D2/300 5D2/1800
FSWR FSWR 6 � 24 wps 20D2/500 20D2/3000Grade 1, stud 12.5–120 mm 20D2/600 20D2/3600chain
Fig. 1.7 Velle derrick.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 13
When lifting loads in excess of about 1.5 tonnes, steam winches shouldgenerally be used in double gear. Electric winches are usually fused for a SWL of up to about 3 tonnes. For loads in excess of 2–3 tonnes it would be normal practice with conventional derricks to double up the rig, asopposed to operating on a single part runner wire.
Derricks may be encountered with two SWL marks on them. In suchcases the lesser value is usually marked with a ‘U’ signifying the SWL foruse in Union Purchase Rig. In the event the derrick is not marked, andintended for use in a Union Rig, the SWL is recommended not to exceedone-third of the smallest of the two derricks (approx).
Use of lifting purchasesThe purchase diagrams shown are rigged to disadvantage. The velocityratio (VR) is increased by ‘1’ if the tackle is rigged to advantage.
The required purchase (the common ones are illustrated in Figure 1.8).The stress factors incurred with their use can be found by the following for-mula assuming 10% for friction:
S � P � W � nW (10/100)
where S is the stress in the hauling part; P is the power gained by the purchase (this is the same as the number of rope parts at the moving block);n is the number of sheaves in the purchase; W is the weight being lifted 10, which is the numerator of the fraction, is an arbitrary 10% allowance for friction.
14 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Guntackle
V.R.2. V.R.3. V.R.4. V.R.5. V.R.6.
Luff orwatch
Double Gyn Threefold
Fig. 1.8 All tackles rove to disadvantage and VRs stated for this rig (whentackles are rove to advantage add � 1 to the VR).
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 14
Cargo-handling equipment – condition andperformanceBefore any cargo operation takes place it is essential that the Chief Officeris confident that the ships lifting equipment and associated loading/dis-charge facilities are 100% operational and free of any defects. Under theLifting Plant Regulations, the International Safety Management (ISM)Code, and ship’s planned maintenance schedule all-cargo-handling equip-ment could expect to be inspected and maintained at regular intervals.
In the case of lifting plant, derricks, cranes, shackles, wires, etc. the fol-lowing test times would be required:
1. after installation when new2. following any major repair3. at intervals of every 5 years.
Testing and inspection of plantCargo lifting appliances must be inspected to establish that they are cor-rectly rigged on every occasion they are used. To this end, the Chief Officerswould normally delegate this duty to the Deck Cargo Officers to check therig prior to commencing loading or discharge operations.
A thorough inspection would also take place annually by a ‘competentperson’, namely the Chief Officer himself. This duty would not be dele-gated to a Junior Officer. This inspection would cause a detailed inspectionto take place of all aspects – hydraulic, mechanical and electrical – of thelifting appliances. All wires would be visually inspected for defects and themousing on shackles would be sighted to be satisfactory. The ‘gooseneck’of derricks and all blocks would be stripped down and overhauled.
Thorough inspections would detect corrosion, damage, hairline cracksand excessive wear and tear. Once defects are found corrective actionwould be taken to ensure that the plant is retained at 100% efficiency. Theseinspections would normally be carried out systematically under the ship’splanned maintenance schedule. This allows a permanent record to bemaintained and is evidence to present to an ISM Auditor.
Testing plantLifting appliances are tested by a cargo surveyor at intervals of 5 years, orfollowing installation or repairs. The test could be conducted by either oftwo methods:
1. By lifting the proof load, and swinging the load through the derrick orcrane’s operating arc, as per the ship’s rigging plan. This test is known as the ‘dynamic test’ and concrete blocks of the correct weight are normally used to conduct this operation.
2. The static test is carried out employing a ‘dynamometer’ secured to thelifting point of the rig and an anchored position on the deck. The proofload weight is then placed on the rig and measured by the dynamometer,to the satisfaction of the surveyor.
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 15
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 15
CertificationOnce the testing has been completed satisfactorily, each lifting apparatuswould be issued with a test certificate and the Chief Officer would retain all certificates in the ‘Register of Ships Lifting Appliances and Cargo-Handling Gear’.
In addition to these test certificates all shackles, wires, blocks, etc. wouldbe purchased as proof tested and delivered to the vessel with its respectivecertificate. These would be retained in the Chief Officers Register. The SWLand the certificate number are found stamped into the binding straps of eachblock. Grease recesses are found inside the bush and inside the inner-bearingsurface of the centre of each sheave. The ‘axle bolt’ is of a square cross-sectionto hold the bearing ‘bush’, this allows the sheave to rotate about the bush. In the event that a shackle or block is changed, the certificate in the registerwould also be changed, so keeping the ships records up to date (Figure 1.9).
Derrick maintenanceAs with many items of equipment, derrick rigs must similarly be checkedand seen to be correctly rigged on every occasion prior to their engage-ment. It would be normal practice for the Ship’s Chief Officer to delegatethis supervisory task to the duty Deck/Cargo Officer before loading or dis-charge operations is allowed to commence.
In addition to the regular working checks, all lifting gear should undergoan annual inspection by a responsible person, namely the Ship’s ChiefOfficer. This annual inspection is never delegated but would be carried outunder the scrutiny of the ship’s mate. The annual inspection would entail theoverhaul and total inspection of all the derrick’s moving parts inclusive ofthe head and heel blocks, the lifting purchase blocks, the topping lift and run-ner wires. The condition of the guys would also be inspected and the empha-sis would be placed on the main weight-bearing element of the ‘gooseneck’.
The annual inspections do not usually require the derrick to be testedunless a degrading fault is found in the rig, necessitating a new part or a replacement part to be used. Testing normally taking place at 5-yearlyintervals or if repairs have been necessary or in the event of the derricksbeing brought back into use, after a period of lay up. If testing is required,this would be carried out in the presence of a cargo surveyor and the liftinggear would have to show handling capability up to the proof load.
In order to conduct an annual inspection, the Chief Officer would orderthe complete overhaul of all the blocks associated with the derrick rig.Normal practice would dictate that the ship’s boatswain would strip theblocks down and clean off any old grease and clear the grease recesses inthe bush and the inside of the sheaves. The ‘bolt’ would be extracted andthe bush bearing would be withdrawn. Inspection by the Senior Officerwould take place and any signs of corrosion, hairline cracks or excessivewear and tear would be monitored. If the steelwork is found to be in goodworking order without any visible defects or signs of deterioration it wouldbe re-greased and re-assembled for continued use.
16 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 16
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 17
Ovaleye becket
Cross head
Grease nipple
Rope guards
Swallow
Sheaves
Bush
Axle bolt
Side (binding)straps
Bolt
Cheek plates
Distance piece
Lower becket
Fig. 1.9 Parts of the Cargo Block.
It is a requirement of the ISM system that lifting gear is correctly main-tained and inspected at regular intervals. Most shipping companies complywith this requirement by carrying out such inspections and maintenanceunder a ‘planned maintenance schedule’. Such a procedure ensures that notonly lifting gear, but mooring winches, pilot hoists and any other mechanicalor weight-bearing equipment is regularly maintained and continuouslymonitored; inspections, tests and repairs being dated and certificates beingretained in the Register of Lifting Appliances and Cargo-Handling Gear.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 17
Deck cranes
Preparation for maintenance of topping lift blocksPrior to carrying out any overhaul of the topping lift blocks, the wire mustbe cleared from the sheaves. In order to strip the wire clear of the blocks thederrick should be stowed in the crutch support at deck level. The bare endof the downhaul should be crimped to a cable sock and joined to a heavingline. This will permit the wire itself to be pulled through the sheaves fromthe end of the wire which has the hard eye shackled to the block. Thisaction will leave the heaving line (long length) rove through the sheaves ofthe two blocks.
The blocks can then be lowered from the position aloft without bearingthe excessive weight of the wire. At deck level the upper blocks can be over-hauled in a safe environment.
Once the topping lift wire has been lubricated at deck level, it can be re-rove by pulling the heaving line with the oiled wire back through thesheaves of the blocks.
Cranes on cargo ships
Shipboard heavy duty cranesTo say that cranes are more fashionable than derricks is not strictly a correctstatement. To say that they are probably more compact and versatile is
18 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 1.10 Speed crane/derricks in operation from on top of the Mast Houseof a general cargo vessel.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 18
more to the point. They tend to be more labour saving than derricks but if comparisons are made for that heavier load capacity and greater liftingcapability, then the modern heavy-lift derrick must remain dominant(Figure 1.10).
Single-man drive and control is the key feature of the crane. They canachieve the plumb line quickly and accurately and for up to 40 tonnes SWLthey tend to be well suited for shipboard operations. The main drawbackfor ship-mounted cranes is that the level of shipboard maintenance isincreased, usually for the engineering department. They also need skilledlabour to handle this increased maintenance workload (Figure 1.11).
In this day and age, flexibility in shipping must be considered essentialand such example cranes can be gear shifted into a faster mode of operation
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 19
Fig. 1.11 Example of a Deck 25 tonne SWL crane aboard the general cargovessel Scandia Spirit. The vessel carries two deck cranes, both mounted on
the port side of the vessel.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:18 PM Page 19
for handling containers up to 36 tonnes or other similar light general cargoparcels (Figure 1.12).
20 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 1.12 The ‘Sir John’ general-purpose cargo vessel lies starboard side to inthe Port of Barcelona. Fitted with two heavy-duty deck cranes both situated on
the starboard side of the vessel.
In the main, shipboard cranes are in a fixed location, often located offsetcentre, to one side of the vessel; offset centre cranes having the benefit of anextended outreach for the crane jib. The drawback here is that the vessel is then conditioned to berth crane side to, at each docking, unless workinginto barges.
Cranes are generally operated with specialized wires having a non-rotational, non-twist property, sometimes referred to as ‘wirex’. The lay ofthe wire being similar to a multi-plate design, wove around a central core inopposition to the directional lay of the core; wires being tested in the nor-mal manner as any other flexible steel wire construction. Despite these anti-twist properties, most incorporate a swivel arrangement over and abovethe hooking arrangement.
Where cranes are employed in tandem, they tend to be used in conjunc-tion with a bridle or spreader arrangement to engage the total load volume.When lifting close to the crane capacity, such additional items need to beincluded in the total weight load for the purpose of calculation of the SWL(Figures 1.13 & 2.22).
Note: Some bridle arrangements are often constructed out of steel section and in them-selves can add considerable weight to the final load lifted.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:19 PM Page 20
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 21
Fig. 1.13 The two deck cranes of the ‘Dania’ a general cargo/heavy-lift/containeroption vessel seen lying starboard side to, in Cadiz, Spain. The aft crane isseen in the elevated position while the forward crane is in its stowed position
(SWL � 35 tonnes).
Fig. 1.14 The ‘Norvik’ general cargo vessel pictured in the Port of Limassol,Cyprus. The ship has turned her deck cranes outboard to allow access for the
suctions of the grain elevators to discharge a bulk cargo of grain.
Most cranes operate within limits of slew, and with height-luffing limita-tions. This is not to say that 360° rotational cranes are not available. Virtuallyall cranes are manufactured to operate through a complete circular arc butlimit switches are usually set with shipboard cranes to avoid the jib foulingwith associated structures. Safe operational arcs are normally depicted onthe ships rigging plan and limit switches are set accordingly (Figure 1.14).
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:19 PM Page 21
22 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Crane advantage over derricks Crane disadvantage over derricks
Simple operation. Comparatively high installation cost.
Single-man operation, derricks are Increased deck space required, more labour intensive. especially for ‘gantry’ type cranes.
Clear deck operational views. Design is more complex, leaving
Clear deck space of rigging. more to go wrong.
Versatility with heavy loads, and not Specialist maintenance required.
required to de-rig. Hydraulics and electrics.
The SWL of cranes is generally less 360° slew and working arc when than that of specialist derrick rigs.compared with limited operating areas for derricks.
Able to plumb any point quickly making a faster load/discharge operation.
Enclosed cabin for operator, where as the majority of derrick operators are exposed, offering greater operator protection and comfort.
Cranes are acceptably safer to operate because of their simplicity,where derrick rigs can be overly complicated in rigging and operation.
Cranes can easily service two hatches, or twin hatches in the fore and aft direction because of their 360° slew ability. Derrick rigs are usually designed to service a specific space.
Note: There are exceptions though. Some derrick designs with double-acting floating head rigs can work opposing hatches.
Operator cabs are usually positioned with aerial viewing and providecrane drivers with clear views of the lifting and hoist/ground areas.Topping lift arrangements generally passing overhead and behind thecabin space tend not to interfere with the driver’s overall aspects. The hoistand topping lift wires are accommodated on winch barrels found in thebase of the crane beneath the cab position.
Ship’s cranes are versatile and have become increasingly popular sincetheir conception. This is because of advanced designs having increased liftcapacity and flexible features. They are manufactured in prefabricated steel
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:19 PM Page 22
which incorporate strength section members capable of accepting heavierloads, while at the same time retaining the ability to handle the more regularlighter load.
Gantry cranes (shipboard)Gantry cranes are extensively found shoreside in the ‘container terminals’and these will be described in a later chapter. The use of gantries aboardships has reduced dramatically on new tonnage because of the extensivefacilities found at the terminal ports.
Where gantry rigs do operate, they tend to be ‘Tracked Gantry Rigs’ whichtend to travel the length of the cargo deck in order to service each cargohold. They also use the rig for moving the hatch covers which are usually‘pontoon covers’ that can be lifted and moved to suit the working plan ofthe vessel when in port.
The gantry structure tends to be a dominant feature and is subject to exten-sive maintenance attention. However, some small cargo coaster type vesselsalso use a specific mobile gantry for the sole purpose of lifting off and moving the hatch covers (examples are shown in Figures 1.15 and 1.16).
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 23
Fig. 1.15 Example of a mobile tracked gantry crane in operation on theships foredeck. Suitable for a vessel with all aft accommodation.
Gantry operationsSome shipboard gantry cranes are designed solely to remove and stowpontoon hatch covers while others are suitably employed with outreachcapability for working containers to the quayside as well as having the flexi-bility to remove pontoon covers (Figure 1.17).
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:19 PM Page 23
24 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 1.16 A low lying tracked gantry crane operates down the hatch coamingto remove hatch lids from a small coasting vessel carrying bulk cargoes. Single-man operation drives the gantry in a fore and aft direction once the hatch lid is
lifted clear of the hatch track.
Fig. 1.17 Dominant gantry crane mounted above the deck and tracked to movefore and aft. Has an SWL of 25 tonnes and outreach extending to 35 m, either side.
Single-man overhead operation.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:19 PM Page 24
General cargoes – slinging arrangementsAlthough the majority of cargoes are carried in containers or unitized inone way or another, some cargoes and certainly ship’s stores are required to be ‘slung’ with associated lifting gear. Many bagged cargoes employed‘canvas slings’ but handling bagged cargoes proved costly in the moderncommercial world and few bagged cargoes are used these days; productsbeing preferred to be shipped in bulk and bagged ashore if required at thedistribution stage.
It should be realised that general cargo ships have declined considerablyin number, with the main capacity going into the container or Ro-Ro trades.However, some items like pre-slung packaged timber and palletizationhave gone some way to bridge the ever widening gap between general andcontainerized cargoes.
Car slingsSingle ‘private’ vehicles are still sometimes loaded and these are crated, con-tainerized or require the customized ‘car sling’ for open stow. However, wherecars (and trucks) are carried in quantity, then ‘Pure Car Carriers’ (PCCs) or‘Pure Car Truck Carriers’ (PCTCs) are normally engaged (Figure 1.18).
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 25
Wire bridle slings Steel bridle
Lifting ring
Canvas wheel slings
Sling supports
Fig. 1.18 Car sling.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:19 PM Page 25
Rope slingsRope slings are probably the most versatile of slinging arrangementsemployed in the movement of general cargo parcels. They are made from10–12 m of 25–30 mm natural fibre rope. Employed for stropping boxes,crates, bales and case goods of varying sizes (Figures 1.19 and 1.20).
The board and canvas slings tend to be specialized for bagged cargo orsacks. With the lack of bagged cargoes being shipped these days, they have
26 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 1.19 Roped cargo sling arrangements.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:19 PM Page 26
dropped away from general use, except in the smaller third world ports;most bagged cargoes now being containerized or shipped on pre-stow pallets.
Multi-legged slingsThe permitted working load of a multi-leg sling, for any angle between thesling legs, up to a limit of 90°, is calculated by using the following factors:
2 leg slings 1.253 leg slings 1.60 times the SWL of the single leg4 leg slings 2.00
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 27
}
Variable effectivelength
Single partspliced
Double partspliced endless
Double partgrommet
(open heart thimbles at both ends)
Fig. 1.20 Wire rope slings. Reproduced with kind permission from Bruntons (Musselburgh), Scotland.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:19 PM Page 27
where the angle between the sling legs has limitations and angles of 90° orless are too restrictive, a permissible working load for angle between 90°and 120° can be calculated as follows:
2 leg slings 1.003 leg slings 1.25 times the SWL of the single leg4 leg slings 1.60
PalletizationPrior to the massive expansion in the container trade ‘palletization’ becameextremely popular as it speeded up the loading and discharging time ofgeneral cargo ships. This meant that the time in port was reduced, togetherwith associated Port and Harbour fees, a fact that was not wasted on ship-pers and vessel operators. Pre-packed loaded pallets are still widely usedaround commercial ports and are packed in uniform blocks to minimizebroken stowage. Typical cargoes suitable for loading to pallets are cartons,small boxes, crates, sacks and small drums (Figure 1.21).
28 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Lifting shackle
Wire slings
Spreader
Binding
Steel lifting bar
Wood pallet
Fig. 1.21 Loaded pallet and pallet transporter.
}Note: In the case of three-legged slings the included angle is that angle between any twoadjacent legs. In the case of a four-legged sling, the included angle is that angle betweenany two diagonally opposing legs.
Palletization has distinct advantages when compared with open stow,general cargo, break bulk-handling methods:
1. less handling of cargo2. less cargo damage (no hook use and limited pilferage)3. faster loading discharge times.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:19 PM Page 28
Vessels were designed specifically for the purpose of handling pallets andwere usually fitted with large open hatchways which allowed spot landingby crane. The ship’s design was often multi-deck and fitted with side ele-vators, shell doors or roll systems to move cargoes into squared-off hatchcorners; Tween deck heights being such as to allow access and use of ‘forklift trucks’.
Pallet transporters, battery or manually operated, are useful for ‘stuffing’containers where the container floor will generally not have the capacity tosupport a fork lift truck and its load.
Use of fork lift trucksThe use of pallets and case goods often requires the use of ‘fork lift’ trucks,either on the quayside or inside the ship’s cargo hatches. They have thecapability to move cargo parcels out from underdecks into the hatch squareto facilitate easy lifting during discharge. Similarly, they can stow heavyindividual parcels into a tight stow into hatch corner spaces. It is appreci-ated that ‘bull wires’ could be employed for such movements, but riggingand operation of bull wires takes excessive time while the fork lift truck canbe effective very quickly. The main disadvantage of fork lift truck use is thatthe vehicle requires manoeuvring space inside the hatch and, as the hatchis loaded, available space becomes restricted (Figure 1.22).
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 29
Fig. 1.22 A fork lift truck operates case goods, stacked timber parcels and palletized drums on the quayside for general cargo vessels.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:19 PM Page 29
Ground handling the large loadFork lift trucks are manufactured in different sizes and are classed byweight. Ship’s Officers are advised that the truck itself is a heavy load andwill be fitted with a counter weight which provides stability to the workingvehicle when transporting loads at its front end. It would be normal prac-tice to separate the counter weight from the truck when lifting it into aship’s hold, especially so if the total combined weight was close to, orexceeded, the SWL of the lifting gear. Once on board the ship the counterweight could then be reunited with the fork lift truck for normal operation(Figure 1.24).
30 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 1.23 Ground handling of large loads, like containers, can also be achieved byusing the larger, high capacity ‘fork lift’ trucks on the quay side. Expansion forks of
extended length are used for wide loads up to about 12 tonnes.
The use of fork lift trucks is a skilled job and requires experienced drivers.Possible problems may be encountered if decks are greasy or wet whichcould cause loss of traction and subsequent loss of control of the truckwhen in operation. Spreading sawdust on the deck as an absorbent canusually resolve this situation and keep operations ongoing.
Cargo Officers should exercise caution when working with these trucksaboard the vessel. Although the field of view for the driver is generallygood, some cargoes could obscure the total vision and cause blind spots.The nature of the work is such that the number of men inside the hatchshould be limited, thereby reducing the possibility of accidents.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:19 PM Page 30
Fork lift truck – alternate usesProbably the most versatile transporters for a variety of cargo parcels thatthe industry has ever used. The basic fork lift can convert to a mini-crane,drum handler or clamp squeeze tool to suit package requirements. Themain forks can be side shifted to work awkward spaces and working cap-acity can start from 2 tonnes upwards. Height of operations is dependenton the model engaged (Figure 1.24).
General principles of the handling, stowage and carriage of cargoes 31
48�� 80��
(a)
(d) Fitted to handle unit loads by squeeze clamps.
(b)
(c) As a mini crane fitted with extending crane jib
(e) Fitted to handle drums
Fig. 1.24 Fork lift trucks.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:19 PM Page 31
Side loading practiceSeveral ships have been constructed with side loading facilities for specificcommodities, i.e. paper and forestry products, on the Baltic trades. Water-tight hull openings work in conjunction with internal elevators to movecargoes to differing deck levels. These openings, shell doors as such, mayfunction as a loading ramp or platform depending on cargo and designa-tion, fork lift trucks being engaged on board the vessel to position cargoparcels (Figure 1.25).
32 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
� �
� �
� �
� �
�
�
� � � � ��
Top cover
Wire for door
Quay maximum height
Quay maximum height
Flap cover
Deck
Deck
Elevator
Elevator
Outer elevator
HoldDeck
conveyor
Bulkheaddoor
Elevatorplatform
Quay
Quay
The sidemover
Elevator
Quay
Side door openHydraulic lifting gear Side door open
Sliding/tilting frame
Sliding/tiltingframe
Lifting platform
Hoisting gear
Guiding columnelevator
Guiding columnGuidingcolumn
Flap
Side door tower
Electric winch
(a)
(b)
Fig. 1.25 Side loading methods. Reproduced with kind permission fromTransmarine, Specialists in Marine Logistics, Equipment, Systems and Services
Worldwide.
Chap-01.qxd 3/3/05 3:19 PM Page 32
Chapter 2
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes
IntroductionWith the many changing trends of cargo transportation, it would be expectedthat the design and structure of cargo holds would change to meet theneeds of modern shipping. This is clearly evident with container tonnageand the vehicle decks of the Roll-on, Roll-off (Ro-Ro) vessels. However, thechanges in the carriage of general cargoes have been comparatively small.This is possible because most merchandise will suit the more popular con-tainer or similar unit load movement.
Hold structures have tended to go towards square corners to reduce broken stowage (BS), and suit palletization, pre-slung loads and the use ofthe fork lift truck inside the holds. Stowage by such vehicles are aided byflush decks in way of the turn of the bilge, as opposed to the angle turn inthe sides of the holds of older tonnage.
Some specialist cargoes, like ‘steel coils’, still suit conventional holds andclearly would not be compatible inside containers, because of the shapeand weight of each item. As with large case goods or castings, which tendto transport better by means of conventional stowage in the more conven-tional type vessel. Such merchandise is clearly edging towards heavy-lifttype loads and these heavier loads are covered in detail here, alongside thedesignated heavy-lift ship and project cargoes.
The objective of this chapter is to provide an overall picture of an indus-try sector which is an essential part of cargo handling and general shippingpractice. It does not have such a high profile as the container or Ro-Romovement, but it is, nevertheless, an indispensable arm to the practice ofshipping.
Hatchwork and rigging (definitions andterminology)(employed with heavy-lifts and cargo operations)
Backstays – additional strength stays applied to the opposing side of a mast structure when making a heavy lift. These stays are not usually kept
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:22 PM Page 33
permanently rigged and are only set as per the rigging plan when a heavylift is about to be made.
Bearers – substantial baulks of timber, used to accept the weight of a heavyload on a steel deck. The bearers are laid for two reasons:
1. To spread the load weight over a greater area of deck.2. To prevent steel loads slipping on the steel deck plate.
Breaking strength – defined by the stress necessary to break a material in ten-sion or compression. The stress factor is usually obtained by testing a sam-ple to destruction.
Bridle – a lifting arrangement that is secured to a heavy load to provide astable hoist operation when the load is lifted. Bridles may be fitted with aspreader to ensure that the legs of the bridle are kept wide spread so as notto damage the lift and provide a balanced hoist operation.
Bulldog grip (wire rope grips) – screw clamps designed to join two parts ofwire together to form a temporary eye or secure a wire end.
Bull wire – (i) a single wire, often used in conjunction with a ‘lead block’rigged to move a load sideways off the line of plumb. An example of sucha usage is found in dragging cargo loads from the sides of a hold into thehold centre. (ii) a wire used on a single span topping lift, swinging derrick,to hoist or lower the derrick to the desired position. The bull wire beingsecured to a ‘union plate’ to work in conjunction with the chain preventorand the down haul of the topping lift span.
Cradle – a lifting base manufactured usually in wood or steel, or a combin-ation of both, employed to accept and support a heavy load. It would nor-mally be employed with heavy lifting slings and shackles to each corner.
Double gear – an expression used when winches are employed in conjunc-tion with making a heavy lift. The purchase and topping lift winchestogether with any guy winches are locked into ‘double gear’ to slow thelifting operation down to a manageable safe speed.
Double up – a term used with a derrick which allows a load greater than thesafe working load (SWL) of the runner wire but less than the SWL of thederrick, to be lifted safely. It is achieved by means of a longer wire being usedin conjunction with a floating block. This effectively provides a double wiresupport and turns a single whip runner wire, into a ‘gun tackle’.
Jumbo Derrick – colloquial term to describe a conventional heavy-lift derrick.
Kilindo rope – a multi-strand rope having non-rotating properties and is atype employed for crane wires.
Lateral drag – the term describes the action of a load on a derrick or crane dur-ing the procedure of loading or discharging, where the suspended weight iscaused to move in a horizontal direction, as opposed to the expected vertical
34 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:22 PM Page 34
direction. The action is often prominent when the ship is discharging a load.As the load is passed ashore the ship has been caused to heel over towardsthe quayside. As the load is landed, the weight comes off the derrick and theship returns to the upright causing the derrick head to move off the line ofplumb. This change of plumb line causes the lifting purchase to ‘drag’ theweight sideways, e.g. lateral drag.
Lead block – a single sheave block secured in such a position as to change thedirection of a weight-bearing wire. Snatch blocks are often used for lightworking engagement.
Lifting beam – a strength member, usually constructed in steel suspendedfrom the lifting purchase of a heavy-lift derrick when engaged in making along or wide load lift. Lifting beams may accommodate ‘yokes’ at each endto facilitate the securing of the wire slings shackled to the load.
Limit switch – a crane feature to prevent the jib outreach from workingbeyond its operational limitations.
Load density plan – a ships plan which indicates the deck load capacity ofcargo space areas of the ship. The Ship’s Chief Officer would consult thisplan to ensure that the space is not being overloaded by very dense, heavycargoes.
Maximum angle of heel – a numerical figure usually calculated by a Ship’sChief Officer in order to obtain the maximum angle that a ship would heelwhen making a heavy lift, to the maximum outreach of the derrick or crane,prior to the load being landed.
Overhauling – (i) an expression used to describe the correct movement of ablock and tackle arrangement, as with the lifting purchase of a heavy-liftderrick. The term indicates that all sheaves in the block are rotating freelyand the wire parts of the purchase are moving without restriction. (ii) thisterm can also be used to describe a maintenance activity as when strippingdown a cargo block for inspection and re-greasing. The block would be‘overhauled’. (Note: the term overhauling is also used to express a speedmovement of one ship overtaking another.)
Plumb line – this is specifically a cord with a ‘plumb-bob’ attached to it.However, it is often used around heavy-lift operations as a term to express‘the line of plumb’ where the line of action is the same as the line of weight,namely the ‘line of plumb’.
Preventor – a general term to describe a strength, weight bearing wire, foundin a ‘Union Purchase’ Rig on the outboard side of each of the two derricks.Also used to act as support for a mast structure when heavy lifting is engaged.Preventor Backstays generally being rigged to the mast in accord with theships rigging plan to support work of a conventional ‘Jumbo’ Derrick.
Proof load – that tonnage value that a derrick or crane is tested to. The valueis equal to the SWL of the derrick/crane � an additional percentage weight
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 35
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:22 PM Page 35
allowance, e.g. derricks less than 20-tonne SWL proof load is 25% in excess;derricks 20–50-tonne SWL proof load equals �5 tonnes in excess of SWL;derricks over 50-tonne SWL proof load equals 10% in excess of SWL.
Purchase – a term given to blocks and rope (Wire or Fibre) when rovetogether. Sometimes referred to as a ‘block and tackle’. Two multi-sheaveblocks are rove with flexible steel wire rope (FSWR) found in common use asthe lifting purchase suspended from the spider band of a heavy-lift derrick.
Ramshorn Hook – a heavy duty, double lifting hook, capable of acceptingslings on either side. These are extensively in use where heavy-lift opera-tions are ongoing.
Register of ships lifting appliances and cargo handling gear – the ships’ certificateand approvals record for all cargo handling and lifting apparatus aboardthe vessel.
Saucer – alternative name given to a collar arrangement set above the liftinghook. The function of the saucer is to permit steadying lines to be shackledto it in order to provide stability to the load, during hoisting and slewingoperations. They can be fixed or swivel fitted. (Note: The term is alsoemployed when carrying ‘grain cargoes’ where the upper level of the graincargo is trimmed into a ‘saucer’ shape.)
Steadying lines – cordage of up to about 24 mm in size, secured in adequatelengths to the load being lifted in order to provide stability and a steadyinginfluence to the load when in transit from quay to ship or ship to barge.Larger, heavier loads may use steadying tackles for the same purpose. How-ever, these are more often secured to a collar/saucer arrangement, abovethe lifting hook, as opposed to being secured to the load itself. Tackles arerove with FSWR, not fibre cordage.
Stuelcken mast and derrick – trade name for a heavy-lift derrick and support-ing mast structure. The patent for the design is held by Blohm & Voss A.G.of Hamburg, Germany. This type of heavy lifting gear was extremely popu-lar during the late 1960s and the 1970s with numerous ships being fittedwith one form or other of Stuelcken arrangement.
Tabernacle – a built bearing arrangement situated at deck level to accept theheel of a heavy-lift derrick. The tabernacle allows freedom of movement inazimuth and slewing from Port to Starboard.
Cargo vessel
Modern trend, cargo hold constructionThe more modern vessel, probably operating with cranes, may be fittedwith twin hatch tops to facilitate ease of operation from both ends of a hold,
36 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:22 PM Page 36
while the construction of the hold tends to be spacious to accept a variety oflong cargoes. Double hold space with or without temporary athwartshipsbulkheads which can section the hold depending on the nature of the cargo,provide flexibility to accommodate a variety of cargo types. Figure 2.1(a)shows the conventional ship design of a general cargo vessel. Figure 2.1(b)shows a half profile of the athwartships bulkhead.
Square corner construction lends to reducing BS especially with contain-ers, pallets, vehicles or case goods. Flush ‘bilge plate access’ is generally afeature of this type of design. Where steel bilge covers (previously limber
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 37
Steering flat BridgeHatch tops
Tween decks Foc’stle deck
Fore peaktank
Bow thrust roomChain locker
Double bottom tanks
Lower cargo holds
Collision bulkhead
Engine room
Propeller shaftRudder
Aft peak tank
Accommodationblock
Half beam
Hatch coamingUpper deckGussetplate
Tween deck space
Pillar
Lower cargo hold space
Tank top ceiling
KeelFloor
IntercostalsMargin plate
Tank sidebracket,
(Turn of bilge)
Frame
Shell plate
(a)
(b)
Fig. 2.1 Conventional ship design. (a) general cargo vessel; (b) athwartship – half profile.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:22 PM Page 37
boards) are countersunk into the deck so as not to obstruct cargo parcelsbeing manoeuvred towards a tight side or corner stow (Figure 2.2).
The conventional hatch (tween deck and lower hold (L/H))An example of the conventional hatch in a general cargo ship is shown inFigure 2.3. This type of hatch was previously covered by wooden hatchboards or slabs but these have been superseded by steel hatch covers.Operated by mechanical means (single pull chain types) or folding ‘M types’(hydraulic operation).
Hatch covers
Direct pull (Macgregor) weather deck hatch coversFigure 2.4 shows a direct pull weather deck hatch cover operation. In thisdiagram, all hatch top wedges and side locking cleats removed and thetracks are seen to be clear. The bull wire and check wire would be shackled
38 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Hatch top
Gussetplate
Frames
Double bottom tanks Intercostal
Large single or doublelower hold (No tween)
Square corner constructionto reduce broken stowage
Bilge bay
Floor(Solid or bracket)
Duct keel–option
Tanksidebracket
Hatch coaming
Fig. 2.2 Modern trend, cargo hold construction.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 38
Fig. 2.3 General cargo seen at the after end of the L/H, while the pontoontween deck covers are sited stacked in the fore end of the tween deck. Exposeddunnage lies at the bottom of the hold where cargo has been discharged and cargo battens can be seen at the sides of the hold. Safety guard wires andstanchions are rigged around the tween deck in compliance with safety
regulations.
Opening bull wireTrailing edge
Check wire
Hatch coaming
Stowage bay for hatch top sections
Eccentric wheels lowered to track by manual levers or hydraulics.
Stowage bay wheels with interconnecting chain.
Raising and lowering of the eccentric wheelsby use of portable hand operated jacks or hand levers.
Fig. 2.4 Direct pull weather deck hatch cover. Inset reproduced with kindpermission from MacGregor and Co.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 39
to the securing lug of the trailing edge of the hatch top. (Note: The bull wireand check wire change function depending on whether opening or closingthe hatch cover.) The eccentric wheels are turned down and the ‘stowagebay’ is sighted to be clear. The locking pins at the end of the hatch would be removed as the weight is taken on the bull wire to open the hatch. Oncethe hatch lids are open and stowed vertical into the stowage bay, the sec-tions would be locked into the vertical position by lock bars or clamps, toprevent accidental roll back.
Weather deck hatch coversSteel weather deck hatch covers now dominate virtually all sectors of gen-eral, bulk and container shipping. Conventional wooden hatch covers havebeen eclipsed by the steel designs which are much stronger as well as beingeasier and quicker to operate. The advantages far outweigh the disadvan-tages in that continuity of strength of the ship is maintained throughout itsoverall length. Better watertight integrity is achieved and they are laboursaving, in that one man could open five hatches in the time it would take tostrip a single conventional wooden hatch. The disadvantages are that theyare initially more expensive to install, and carry a requirement for more levels of skilled maintenance.
Once cleated down, a hard rubber seal is created around the hatch topperimeter providing a watertight seal, on virtually all types of covers.Hydraulically operated covers cause a pressure to generate the seal, whilemechanical cleating (dogs) provide an additional securing to the cargo spacebelow. The engineering department of the ship usually cater to the mainten-ance of the hydraulic operations and the draw back is that a hydraulic leakmay occur due to say a burst pipe, which could cause subsequent damageto cargo.
Extreme caution should be exercised when opening and closing steelcovers, and adequate training should be given to operators who areexpected to engage in the opening and closing of what are very heavy steelsections. Check wires and respective safety pins should always be appliedif appropriate, when operating direct pull types. Hydraulic folding ‘Mtypes’ incorporate hydraulic actuators with a non-return capacity whichprevents accidental collapse of the hatch tops during opening or closing.Whichever type is employed, they are invariably track mounted and suchtracks must be seen to be clear of debris or obstruction prior to operation(Figure 2.5).
Strong flat steel covers lend to heavy lifts and general deck cargo parcelsand have proved their capability with the strengthened pontoons which arefound in the container vessels. The pontoons having specialized fittings toaccept the deck stowage of containers over and above the cargo holdspaces. Similarly, specialized heavy-lift vessels have adopted strengthenedopen steel decks in order to prosecute their own particular trade sector(Figure 2.6).
40 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 40
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 41
Fig. 2.5 Folding hydraulic operated, steel hatch covers, seen in the verticalopen position. Securing cleating seen in position prevents accidental roll back.
Fig. 2.6 Rack and pinion horizontal stacking steel hatch covers seen in thehatch open position. The drive chain running the length of the hatch tracks.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 41
An alternative arrangement is possible when space is not available out-board of the hatches for the deck mounted closing pedestal, e.g. betweentwin hatches. With this alternative the closing arm operates above coaminglevel. A wheel ramp is necessary to assist in the initial self-closing action ofthe covers (Figure 2.7).
Folding (hydraulic operated) hatch coversThe more modern method of operating steel hatch covers is by hydraulics,opening the sections in folding pairs, either single, double or triple pair sec-tions (Figures 2.8 and 2.9).
Multi-folding weather deck hatch covers (MacGregor type)There are several manufacturers of steel hatch covers and they all generallyachieve the same function of sealing the hatchways quickly. Operationally,
42 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Crane pillar
Wire pendant
Hinged sheave
Hauling eyeplate
Panel 1
Panel 2
Panel 3
Wheel ramp
Closing arm
To crane
Stowing arm
Fig. 2.7 Alternative weather deck hatch cover. Direct pull type. Reproducedwith kind permission from MacGregor.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 42
one man could close up five or six hatches very quickly by switching on thehydraulic pumps, releasing the locking bars to the stowed sections andoperating the control levers designated to each set of covers.
The main disadvantage of hydraulic operations is that the possibility of aburst pipe is always possible, with subsequent cargo damage due to hydraulicoil spillage.
Single pull fixed chain hatch coversThese are automated covers with self drive by built in electric motors (seeinset, Figure 2.10). All operations for open and closing the hatch are by pushbutton control. Inclusive of raising the lowering of the covers and operationof the cleating. If desired, these covers can be supplied with sufficient
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 43
Two or three pairsInternal cylinderLink mechanism
Fig. 2.8 Folding (hydraulic operated) hatch covers. Reproduced with kind per-mission from MacGregor.
One pairExternal cylinder
Folding
Fig. 2.9 Single pair hatch cover. Hydraulic operated by single external cylinder.Reproduced with kind permission from MacGregor.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 43
44C
argo
Wo
rk for M
aritime O
peratio
ns
Single Pull Fixed Chain Hatch Covers
Container loading
Push-button controlAll operations are push-button controlled, no man-power being required
Fig. 2.10 Single pull fixed chain hatch cover. Reproduced with kind permission from MacGregor.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 44
strength and the necessary container location sockets to permit the load ontop of deck-mounted containers.
Tween deck ‘M-type’ hydraulic-folding hatch coversThese covers provide a flush and strong deck surface which is ideal for theworking of fork lift trucks inside tween deck spaces. Hydraulically oper-ated and user-friendly (Figure 2.11).
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 452.
87m
sto
wag
e he
ight
8.5
m d
eck
open
ing
19.2 m clear opening
7.8 m clear opening
23.2 m deck opening
Hatch open showing typicaloverall dimensions to suitthree rows of three 20 ftcontainers stowed throughthe hatch.N.B.: All dimensions given aretypical and vary accordingto individual installations.Emergency operation canbe arrangedfor all installations
Drag link
Wheel
Trailing pair
Hinges
Leading pair
Flexible hoses orElectric supply withquick release coupling
Trailing pair
Leading pairDrag link
DisconnectedFixing bolts
Cylinder
Link mechanism
Fig. 2.11 Tween deck ‘M type’ hydraulic folding hatch covers. Reproduced with kind permission from MacGregor.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 45
Operation of steel hatch covers (tween decks)Folding hatch covers are operated in pairs by hydraulic cylinders whichactuate link mechanisms working from 0° to 180°. One, two or three pairsof cover panels can be linked and stowed at the same end of the hatch ifrequired.
To open the hatch, the leading pair of covers is first operated, immediatelypulling the remaining pair(s) into a rolling position on the recessed side tracksand tow the hatch end. Once the leading pair is raised the trailing pair(s)can follow into vertical stowage positions where they are secured to eachother. The operational sequence is reversed when closing the hatch covers.
Tween deck hatch covers are not required to be watertight and unlessspecifically requested they would have no additional cleating arrangements.
46 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 2.12 Two bulk carrying ‘feeder’ coasting vessels lie port side to,alongside the grain elevator in Barcelona. The lead ship is seen dischargingwith partially opened steel hatches, operated by its own mini-gantry crane. The
one astern has folding weather deck hatches in the closed-up position.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 46
Partial openingAs with many types of steel covers partial opening is a feature and can beachieved comparatively quickly by the operation of quick release ‘drag links’(Figure 2.12).
Loading and discharging heavy liftsIt is normal sea going practice for the Chief Officer of the vessel to super-vise the movement of heavy lifts, both in and out of the vessel. This is not,however, to say that the Mate of the ship will not delegate specific functionsto the more Junior Cargo Officer or to the stevedore supervisor.
Prior to commencing the lift, the derrick and associated lifting gear needsto be prepared. Many vessels are now fitted with the large ‘Stulken-type’derricks, or specialized Hallen or Velle derricks as opposed to the moreconventional ‘Jumbo’ Derrick. Manufacturers’ instructions and reference tothe ship’s rigging plan should always be consulted regarding the prepar-ations of setting up the lifting gear, especially when officers are unfamiliarwith the style of rig.
Where a load is outside the SWL of a ship’s gear, either a floating crane ora specialized heavy-lift vessel would be employed.
Preparation time for the derrick can vary depending on the type, but a period of up to 2 h would not be unusual. Man-management of the rig-ging crew and advance planning with regard to the number of lifts and in what order they are to be made, in relation to the port of discharge and order of reception of cargo parcels, would be the expected norm.
Stability detailIt must be anticipated that the vessel will go to an angle of heel when mak-ing the lift with the derrick extended. This angle of heel should be calculatedand the loss of metacentric height (‘GM’) ascertained prior to commencingthe lift. Clearly, any loss of positive stability should be kept to a minimumand to this end any frees surface effects in the ship’s tanks should be elim-inated or reduced wherever possible.
OperationAdequate manpower should be available in the form of competent winchdrivers and the supervising controller. Winches should be set into double
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 47
Note: If loading a weight by means of a floating crane, Chief Officers must check that theport of discharge has equivalent lifting apparatus, on the basis that the ship’s gear willnot be viable for discharge.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 47
gear for slow operation and steadying lines of appropriate size should besecured to points on the load to allow position adjustments to be made.
Heavy-lift cargoesWhen loading or discharging heavy-lifts Deck Officers should be aware ofthe following precautions and procedures:
1. The stability of the vessel should be adequate and the maximum angleof heel should be acceptable. All free surface effects (FSE) should beeliminated by either ‘pressing up’ or ‘emptying’ tanks.
2. If a conventional ‘Jumbo’ Derrick is employed, then the rigging planshould be referred to with regard to the positioning of ‘PreventerBackstays’ to support any mast structure.
3. A careful check on the condition of the derrick and associated gearshould be made before commencing the lift. Particular attention shouldbe paid to the SWL of shackles, blocks and wires.
4. Ensure all the ship’s moorings are taut and that men are standing by totend as necessary. Fenders should be pre-rigged and the gangway liftedclear of the quayside.
5. All cargo winches affecting the load should be placed in ‘double gear’.6. The deck area where the load is to be landed should be clear of obstruc-
tions, and heavy bearers laid to accept and spread the deck weight.7. The ship’s deck capacity plans should be checked to ensure that the
deck space is capable of supporting the load.8. The winch drivers and controller should be seen to be competent, and
all non-essential personnel should be clear of the lifting area.9. Any ship’s side rails in the way of the load should be lowered or
removed and any barges secured to the ship’s side should be cast off.10. Steadying lines should be secured to the load itself and to the collar of
the floating block if fitted.11. All relevant heads of departments should be advised before commen-
cing the lift.12. Use the designated lifting points and take the weight slowly. Stop, and
inspect all round once the load clears the deck, before allowing the liftto continue.
Examples of slinging arrangements – heavy liftsWeight and bulk often go together and many of the maritime heavy lifts arenot only heavy in their own right but are often extremely bulky by way ofhaving a large volume. Numerous methods have been employed over theyears in order to conduct lifting operations in a safe manner. Many types ofload beams and bridle arrangements have been seen in practice as success-ful in spreading the overall weight and bringing added stability to the loadmovement during a load/discharge activity (Figures 2.13–2.16).
48 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 48
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 49
Large beamspreaderseparates slings
Bridle
Ramshorn Hook
Lifting purchase
Spreader
Heavy case
Fig. 2.13 Heavy-lift slinging arrangement.
Fig. 2.14 Use of heavy duty lifting beams. Two Huisman shipboard cranes(each at 275-tonne SWL) hoist the new ferry load Fiorello, by means of two
heavy duty lifting beams, aboard the Mammoet vessel ‘Transporter’.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 49
50 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 2.15 Typical lifting beam employed for long heavy-lift load in the form of a locomotive.
Fig. 2.16 A nuclear waste flask (weighs up to 120 tonnes) is loaded to acustomized low load transporter by means of individual heavy duty strops and
shackles.
The conventional heavy lift: ‘Jumbo’ DerrickIn Figure 2.17, a 75-tonne SWL Jumbo Derrick is stowed against the supporting Samson Post structure. The head of the derrick is clamped inthe upright position against the upper steel platform. The topping lift isanchored to the underside of the table platform set across the two posts
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 50
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 51
(Note: The Samson Post structure also supports four conventional 10-tonneSWL conventional heavy Derricks). The terminology and basic work-ing design of a conventional heavy-lift shipboard derrick found up to 150-tonne SWL is shown in Figure 2.18 and for the Jumbo Derrick heavy liftin Figure 2.19.
Fig. 2.17 The conventional heavy lift – a ‘Jumbo’ Derrick.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 51
52 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Conventional Heavy Lift (Jumbo) Derricks
Topping lift span tackleSpider band
Tumbler
Tabernacle
Winch
Mast andhoundsband withpreventorback stays
Towinch
Ramshorn Hook
Lifting purchase
Lead sheave
Lead block
Heel ofDerrick
Hatchway
Power guy lead towinch from Port guy
Stb’d power guypennant anddouble purchase
Terminology and basic working design of a conventional heavy-lift, shipboardderrick found upto about 150 tonne SWL
Fig. 2.18 Heavy-lift (conventional) derrick arrangement.
Tandem liftingIt is not unusual these days to encounter specialized vessels, fitted withheavy lift, dual capacity speed cranes. Such ships have the ability to workconventional loads but have the flexibility to load containers or projectheavy-lift cargoes Figure 2.20.
Stuelcken derricks
The Stuelcken mast – cargo gear systemThe Heavy Lift, Stuelcken systems are noticeable by the prominent angledsupport mast structure positioned either side of the ship’s centre line. The main boom is usually socket mounted and fitted into a tabernacle onthe centre line. This positioning allows the derrick to work two hatches forward and aft and does not restrict heavy loads to a single space, as witha conventional derrick.
The Stuelcken Posts, set athwartships, provide not only leads for the top-ping lifts and guy arrangement but also support smaller 5- and 10-tonne
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 52
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 53
derricks with their associated rigging. The posts are of such a wide diam-eter that they accommodate an internal staircase to provide access to theoperator’s cab, usually set high up on the post to allow overall vision of theoperation.
Lifting purchase winchTopping lift winch
Ships side
Hatchcoaming
H/L Derrick
Passage ofload
Starboard guy winchPort guy winch
Load
Portpowerguy
Starboardpower guy
For’dmast house
Fig. 2.19 Conventional Heavy-lift ‘Jumbo’ Derrick arrangement.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 53
54 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 2.20 The ‘Transporter’ of the Mammoet Shipping Company is seenengaged in the lifting of a ferry vessel destined for the New York Waterwaysystem. The lift is being made by means of two heavy-duty ships ‘Huisman’cranes, each of 275-tonne SWL. The tandem lift takes place using lifting beams
having a capacity of up to 250-tonne SWL.
The rigging and winch arrangement is such that four winches control thetopping lift and guy arrangement while two additional winches control themain lifting purchase. Endless wires pay out/wind on, to the winch bar-rels, by operation of a one-man, six-notch controller.
Various designs have been developed over the years and modificationshave been added. The ‘Double Pendulum’ model, which serves two hatches,operates with a floating head which is allowed to tilt in the fore and aft linewhen serving respective cargo spaces. A ‘Rams Horn Hook’ with a change-able double collar fitting being secured across the two pendulum liftingtackles. The system operates with an emergency cut-off which stops winchesand applies electro-magnetic locking brakes (Figure 2.21).
Stuelcken derrick rigs are constructed with numerous anti-friction bear-ings which produce only about 2% friction throughout a lifting operation.These bearings are extremely durable and do not require maintenance forabout 4 years, making them an attractive option to operators.
The standard wires for the rig are 40 mm and the barrels of winches areusually spiral grooved to safeguard their condition and endurance. Thelength of the span tackles are variable and will be dependent on the lengthof the boom (Figures 2.22 and 2.23).
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 54
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 55
Ramshorn Hookwith safety tongues
Lower blocks
Pendulum tackles fromfloating head
Cross piececollar
Steel bolts
Fig. 2.21 Cargo gear system – double pendulum model.
Type: Double pendulumCapacity: 300-tonne SWLDerrick length: 29.5 mOutreach: 10.0 m(beyond the ship’s side)Operation up to: 12.5° list �2.0° trimClassification:Lloyd’s Register of ShippingAdditional Equipment:�4 sets of mast cranes for handling of light cargo�1 set of lifting beams (300-tonne SWL) consisting of main traverse with spindle device and cross beams.
Fig. 2.22 Double pendulum model.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 55
56 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Type: Pivot type
Capacity: 250-tonne SWLDerrick length: 30 mOutreach: beyond portside 14.15 m beyond starboardside 10.0 mOperation up to: 5° list �2° trim
Designed for three slewing ranges of each 100°.Change of slewing range without load. Total slewingrange 260°.
Classification: Germanischer LloydAdditional equipment:
� Each Pivot type equipped with two log/lumber type derricks of each 35-tonne SWL.
Fig. 2.23 Stuelcken masts and cargo lifting arrangement.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 56
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 57
Although Stuelcken rigs still remain operational, their use has dimin-ished with the improved designs of heavy-lift vessels, which previouslytended to dominate the ‘Project’ cargo section of the industry.
Heavy-lift floating craneConventional heavy cargo loads, which are scheduled for carriage by sea, areoften required to be loaded by means of a floating crane. When the load is toogreat to be handled by the ship’s own lifting gear, the floating crane option is usually the next immediate choice. Most major ports around the worldhave this facility as an alternative option for heavy specialist work. The typeof activity is two-fold, because, if loaded by this means at the port of depar-ture, the same load must be discharged at its destination by similar or equi-valent methods. (Ship’s Chief Officers need to ascertain that if the load isabove the ships lifting gear capability, that the discharge port has means oflifting the load out.)
A Ship’s Cargo Officer needs to ensure that the heavy load is accessibleand that the floating crane facility is booked in advance in order to makethe scheduled lift. Booking of a special crane would normally be carried outvia the ship’s agents, leaving a ship’s personnel very much in the hands ofexternal parties; the Port Authority often controls the movement of all com-mercial and specialist traffic in and around the harbour.
The ‘floating crane’ should not be confused with the specialist ‘cranebarge’. Floating cranes differ in that they may not be self-propelled and mayrequire the assistance of tugs to manoeuvre alongside the ocean transport,prior to engaging in the lift(s). The construction of these conventional cranesis such that the crane is mounted on a pontoon barge with open deck spaceto accommodate the cargo parcel, the pontoon barge being a tank systemthat can be trimmed to suit the necessity of the operation if the case requires.
The main disadvantage against the more modern, floating sheer legs, is that generally speaking the outreach of the crane’s jib is limited in its arcof operation. Also, the lift capacity can be restrictive on weight when com-pared with the heavier and larger units which tend to operate extensivelyin the offshore/shipyard arenas.
When booking the facility, agents need to be made aware of the weight ofthe load and its overall size; also its respective position on board the vessel,together with its accessibility. Hire costs of the unit are usually quite highand with this in mind, any delays incurred by the ship not being ready todischarge or accept a scheduled load on arrival of the crane, could becomea costly exercise.
The crane/sheer leg barge (self-propelled)Derrick/crane barges tend to work extensively in the offshore sector of themarine industry but their mobility under own propulsion, together withthruster operations, provide flexibility to many heavy-lift options. Some
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 57
builds incorporate dynamic positioning and depending on overall size,have lifting capacity up to and including 6000 tonnes with main crane jiboperations (Figure 2.24).
Heavy-lift ships and project cargoesThe need for heavy-lift ships developed alongside the immense size of theloads required within the development of the offshore industry. Its originsprobably come from the idea of the ‘floating dry dock’ which has been aroundfor many years before the offshore expansion. The principle differencebetween the floating dock and the heavy-lift ship is that one is always self-propelled and acts as a regular means of transportation, while the floatingdock is usually annexed to a shipyard and if it is required to move position,such a move would normally be handled by tugs.
They both have operational tank systems which allow them to workemploying the same Archimedes principle of flotation. Submerging them-selves to allow a load to float in, or over, prior to de-ballasting and liftingthe load clear of the water line. The Heavy-Lift Ship generally does not submerge its loading deck more than to a calculated depth, but enough toallow ‘float over’ methods to operate (Figures 2.25–2.28).
Float over loading methods must therefore be capable of accommodatingthe draught drawn by the load when waterborne, the actual load usually
58 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 2.24 The Smit ‘Cyclone’ floating sheer leg barge, engages in a general cargo heavy-lift operation on the vessels offshore side.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 58
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 59
Fig. 2.25 The steel deck of the ‘Baltic Eider’ fitted to receive containersoverall. Seen in a part-loaded condition passing through light ice in the
Baltic Sea.
Fig. 2.26 The steel deck space of the ‘Sea Teal’ a heavy-lift transport. The tankballast system, allows the deck to be submerged to allow a Float-On, Float-Off,
system to take place for heavy-lift or project-cargoes.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 59
60 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 2.27 The heavy-lift vessel ‘Super Servant 3’ seen loaded with the cranebarge AL-Baraka 1, lies at anchor awaiting to discharge its load by Float-off
methods.
being rafted and towed or pushed by tugs to a position over the transportsdeck. Once in position over the load deck, the de-ballast operation of theheavy-lift vessel can take place allowing the deck to rise and so raising theload clear of the surface. The load, complete with raft (if employed), is thentransported under the vessel’s own power.
Elements for consideration for heavy-lift transports:1. Overall size-dimensions of the load2. Weight of the load3. Weight of lifting accessories4. SWL of Lifting elements5. Weather conditions6. Positive stability of transporting vessel7. Density of water in load and discharge ports8. Ballast arrangements for trim and list of vessel9. Passage plan of transport route
10. Fuel burn on route11. Speed and ETA of passage12. Loadline zone requirements not infringed13. Method of discharge14. Facilities of discharge Port
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 60
15. Manpower requirements for loading/shipping/and discharging16. Documentation for the load17. Specialist handling personnel18. Communication facilities to accommodate loading/discharge19. Securing arrangements for load on route20. Load management on voyage.
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 61
Fig. 2.28 Stern view of the heavy-lift vessel ‘Super Servant 3’ with the cranebarge load seen in the Arabian Gulf area.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 61
Large heavy loads tend to accrue logistical problems from the time of con-struction to that moment in time when the load arrives at its final destin-ation. The shipping element of the load’s journey is just one stage duringthe transportation. Cargo surveyors, safety experts, company officials andtroubleshooters of various kinds tend to move alongside the passage of theload up to that time of final delivery.
Planning for project cargo transportIt would be natural for the layman to assume that the heavy load justmoves on its own with the help of a police escort, but this is clearly not thecase for the extreme load, or that larger-than-large plant (Figure 2.29).Planning of the delivery must be known prior to the load being built. A company may be able to build for the customer but if the load cannot be transported safely, because of weight or size, then the actual buildingbecomes a ‘white elephant’, in more ways than one.
Also costs for the transportation could be considerable and these wouldexpect to influence financial agreements and be included at the contractstage.
62 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 2.29 Project type cargoes. The Smit ‘Giant 4’ heavy-lift transport engageswith a 6500-tonne lift, designated for the ‘Visund Field’ offshore. Giant 4, is a24 000 dwt submersible heavy duty transport barge. The operation was
conducted by a Load-out/Float-off arrangement in June 1997.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 62
Transportation – planning considerations, project cargoes
Measurement of the loadNot only weight measurement of the cargo, but its overall length, breadthand depth will be required. If the load is structured to float during the load-ing or discharging period, then the draught at which flotation occurstogether with the freeboard measurement; the centre of gravity (C of G) ofthe load mass; and if applicable, the centre of buoyancy; density of water atthe loading point; and density of the water at the point of discharge, mustbe calculated. Tidal considerations at the load and discharge positionsshould also be calculated for the designated periods.
Transport vehicle-considerationsCapability of the carrier to carry out the task……
In the case of a ship, is the vessel capable of accepting the load? What isthe displacement and physical size of the vessel and its deck load densitycapability? What is the metacentric height (‘GM’), and what will be the new‘GM’ with the load added? Further consideration must be given for thegeneral assessment of the ship’s stability throughout all stages of the pas-sage; endurance of the vessel; and the effect of burning bunker oil and con-suming water; ballast movement and the ability to trim or list the vessel forthe purpose of loading/discharging; number of crew; experience of themaster; Charter rates; and not least the availability of the vessel.
Shoreside administration for heavy-lift operationsEvery heavy-lift operation will pass through various degrees of adminis-tration prior to the practical lift taking place. The manufacturers/shipperswill be required to provide clear information as to dimensions, weight, lift-ing and securing points, and the position of the C of G before the load canbe accepted by the ship; while the ship may be required to give details of itscrane capability, inclusive of outreach and load capacity.
The loading operation itself as to whether it will be from the quayside, orfrom a barge, must also be discussed, together with the detail of use of ship’sgear or floating crane. Weather conditions and mooring arrangements mayalso be featured at this time. Once loading is proposed, the stability dataand the maximum angle of heel that will be attained would need to be cal-culated. Ballast arrangements pertinent to the operation may well need tobe adjusted prior to contemplating the actual lift.
The ship would no doubt be consulted on voyage and carriage details, asto the securing of the load, the deck capacity to accommodate the load, andthe stability criteria. The ship would also require assurances regarding theport of discharge and the capabilities of said port. If the load is beyond thecapacity of a ship’s lifting gear, then the discharge port must have accessi-bility to a floating crane facility and that this facility will be available at therequired time.
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 63
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 63
Where road transport is involved in delivering the load to the quayside,road width and load capability would need to be assessed. A 500-tonne loadon the back of a low-loader may well cause landslip or subsidence of a road-side, which must be clear of obstructions like bridges and rail crossings.Wide loads or special bulky loads may require police escort for movementon public highways to and from loading/discharge ports.
Once loaded, the weight will need to be secured and to this end a rigginggang is often employed. However, prudent overseeing by Ship’s Officers is expected on this particular exercise. Bearing in mind that the rigginggang are not sailing with the ship, and once the ship lets her moorings go, any movement of the load will be down to the ship’s crew, to effect re-securing.
Customs clearance would also be required as per any other cargo parcel and this would be obtained through the usual channels when themanifest is presented, to clear the vessel inwards. Export licences, being the responsibility of the shipper, together with any special details where thecargo is of a hazardous nature, covered by special clearances, e.g. armaments.
Movement logistics of the large loadClearly, the task of transporting ‘project’ cargoes does not lend itself easily tothe use of public roads. Fortunately, the building sites for such items are oftenlocated by coastlines and generally do not encroach on public highways.For example, shipyards build and transport modules or installations withintheir own perimeters and transport within those same perimeters. However,occasionally, that one-off project requires a specialized route. Timing is criticalat all stages of the journey to ensure minimal disruption to the general public,and police escort must be anticipated door to door (Figures 2.30 and 2.31).
For the transport of heavy loads (ground handling equipment), furtherreference should be made to the IMO publication on ‘The Safe Transport ofDangerous Cargoes and Related Activities in Port Areas’.
Voyage planningThe movement of project cargoes is, by the very nature of the task, gener-ally carried out at a slow speed. This is especially so as in the examplesshown as extreme lifts on pages 62/65. Tug assistance is often employedand the operation must be conducted at a safe speed for the circumstances, themovement between the loading port of departure, towards the dischargeposition, being carried out under correct navigation signals appropriate toeach phase of the passage.
As with any passage/voyage plan, the principles of ‘passage planning’would need to be observed, but clearly specialist conditions apply over andabove those imposed on a conventional ship at sea. Passage planning invol-ves the following phases:
64 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 64
Appraisal – the gathering of relevant charts, publications, informations andrelevant datas to enable the construction of a charted voyage plan.
Planning – the actual construction of the plan to highlight the proposedroute. To provide details of way points, bunkering stations, navigation haz-ards, margins of safety, currents and tidal informations, monitoring points,contingency plans, traffic focal points, pilotage arrangements, underkeelclearances, etc.
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 65
Fig. 2.30 Mobile transport platform employed for ground handling of steelinstallation. This section of the movement plan must be considered prior to the
build stage.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 65
Execution – the movement of the transport to follow the plan through to itscompletion. The positive execution of the plan by the vessel.
Monitoring – the confirmation that the vessel is proceeding as per the des-ignated plan. Position monitoring is taking place and the movement of thevessel is proceeding through the various stages of the voyage.
66 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 2.31 Multi-wheel heavy load transports. Manufactured by the ScheuerleCompany of Germany. The mobile platforms provide multi-axle transport forthe large heavy load and are regularly inter-connected for the project loadcarrying up to 10 000 tonnes. Variations for smaller loads range from the
15-tonne low-bed trailers to platform trailers of up to 1000 tonnes.
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 66
Voyage plan acceptanceOnce the plan is constructed, it would warrant close inspection by the ProjectManager and the Ship’s Master. Such a plan would need to incorporate aconsiderable number of special features prior to being considered accept-able to relevant parties. Passage plans are made up to ensure ‘berth toberth’ movement is achieved safely and a plan for movement of a projectcargo would expect to include the following special features:
Risk assessment Completed on the basis of the initial plan (passageplans are flexible and circumstances may make a deviation from the pro-posal to take a necessary action when on route).
Communications Methods: VHF channels; Secondary methods:Advisory contacts, Coastguard, VTS, Hydrographic Office, MeteorologicalOffice, Agents, Medical contingency. Most towing operations and projectmovements would normally be accompanied by a navigation warning toadvise shipping likely to be affected. Such warnings could be effected byCoast Radio Stations, Port and Harbour controls, and/or the HydrographicOffice of the countries involved.
Loading procedures Methods: Various examples: Lift-On/Lift-Off,Float-On/Float-Off, etc. Tug assistance, marine pilots, rigging and liftingpersonnel as required. Tidal conditions, weather conditions monitored.
Securing procedures Personnel and associated equipment, Surveyor/Project Manager inspection. Contractors: riggers, lashings, welders.
Risk assessment – Tolerable.
Safety assessment LSA/manpower, Navigation equipment test.Engine test. Weather forecast 48 h, long-range forecast.
Route planning Weather, ports of call, mooring facilities, UKC, widthof channel. Position Monitoring methods: communications to shore toinclude progress reports, Navigation hazards, Command Authority, canalpassage or bridge obstructions. Traffic focal points. Seasonal weather con-siderations.
Contingencies Endurance, bunkers, manpower, emergency communica-tion contacts. Weather, mechanical failure, steering failure, tug assistance. Useof anchors, safe anchorages. Special signals. Support services (shore based).
Schedule Timing to effect move, speed of move relevant to each move-ment phase. Charter Party, delivery date, ‘penalty clauses’. Sailing plan,monitoring and tracking operations, progress reports.
Risk assessment – Per phase of voyage.
Hatchwork and heavy-lift cargoes 67
Note: A passage plan is equally meant to highlight the areas where the vessel should notgo, a particular important aspect to vessels engaged with ‘project cargoes’. The load mayrestrict passage through canals, under bridges or through areas of reduced underkeelclearance (UKC).
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 67
Discharge procedure Methods: Ground handling equipment, second-ary transport. Specialist personnel and equipment. Quayside facilities andtidal considerations. Risk assessment.
Personnel requirements Surveyors, specialist handlers, various contractors.
Insurance – Shoreside administration.
Documentation/Customs clearances Reception, delivery commu-nications, Export licences.
Ancillary units Tugs, Lifting units, equipment, consumables.
Specialist equipment Ice regions.
Accommodations Airports, hotels, local transport facilities, labour force.
Security Piracy, road transport, in port, at sea, communications. Police,military, security codes affecting contingencies.
Costs Market assessment, Political considerations.
68 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-02.qxd 3/3/05 4:23 PM Page 68
Chapter 3
Stowage properties of general cargoes
IntroductionGeneral cargo is a term which covers a great variety of goods. Those goodsmay be in bags, cases, crates, drums or barrels, or they may be kept togetherin bales. They could be individual parcels, castings or machinery parts, earth-enware or confectionary. They all come under the collective term of ‘generalcargo’.
The Chief Officer is usually that person designated on board the vesselwho is responsible for the handling and safe stowage of all cargoes loadedaboard the ship. He is responsible for receiving the cargoes, and makingsure that the holds are clean and ready to accept stowage and shipping in asafe manner. He is ultimately responsible for the carriage ventilation anddelivery in good condition of all of the vessel’s cargo.
In order to carry goods safely, the vessel must be seaworthy and the cargospaces must be in such a condition as not to damage cargo parcels by shipssweat, taint or cause any other harmful factor. To this end the Chief Officerwould cause a cargo plan to be constructed to ensure that separation of cargoesare easily identifiable and that no contamination of products could take placeduring the course of the voyage. The Chief Officer’s prime areas of duty liewith the well-being and stability of the vessel together with the safe carriage ofthe cargo. Clearly, with the excessive weights involved with cargo parcels, thepositive stability affecting the vessel’s safe voyage could be impaired.
A correct order of loading with the capability of an effective discharge,often to several ports, must be achieved to comply with the safe execution ofthe voyage and also to stay within regulatory conditions, i.e. loadline require-ments. This chapter is directly related to the details affecting stowage ofparticular cargoes and the associated idiosyncrasies, affecting the correctstow and carriage requirements to permit a lawful and successful venture.
Preparation of cargo spacesThe Chief Officer is generally that person aboard who is responsible for thepreparation of the ship’s holds to receive cargo. The preparations of the
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 69
cargo compartments will usually be the same for all non-containerized gen-eral cargo parcels with additional specific items being carried out for spe-cialized cargoes.
1. Holds and tween deck spaces should be thoroughly swept down toremove all traces of the previous cargo. The amount of cleaning willdepend on the type of the previous cargo and the nature of the nextcargo to be carried. On occasions the hold will need to be washed (saltwater wash) in order to remove heavy dust or glutinous residues, butthe hold is only washed after the sweepings and wastes have beenremoved.
2. Bilge bays and suctions should be cleaned out and tested, while the holdis being swept down. Tween deck scuppers should also be tested androse boxes should be sighted and clear. All non-return valves in the bilgelines should be seen to be free and operating normally.
70 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Note: If the previous cargo was a bulk cargo, then any plugs at the bilge deck angleshould be removed to allow correct drainage.
3. Check that all limber boards or bilge bay covers are in good conditionand provide a snug fit. If bilges are contaminated, say from the previouscargo, and have noticeable odours, these should be sweetened and disinfected.
4. The spar ceiling (sometimes referred to as cargo battens) should beexamined and replaced where necessary. In specific cases, like with anintended ‘coal cargo’, the spar ceiling should be totally removed fromthe compartment prior to loading.
5. All tween deck hatch coverings should be inspected for overall generalcondition and correct fitting. Tween deck guard rails, chains and stan-chions should be fitted and seen to be in a good secure order.
6. Any soiled dunnage should be removed and, if appropriate, clean dunnage laid to suit the intended cargo to be loaded.
7. Checks should be made on the hold lighting, fan machinery, ventilationsystems and the total flood fire detection/operation aspects.
8. Conduct a final inspection to ensure that the hold is ready to load. Somecargoes, like foodstuffs, may require the compartments to be inspectedby a surveyor, prior to commencement of loading.
Duties of the Junior Cargo Officer (dry cargo vessels)Cargo Officers will have a variety of duties before, during and after cargooperations begin. He/she should be aware that monitoring the cargo move-ments and ensuring parcels remain in good condition is protecting the owners’ interests. Extensive ship keeping activities also go along with load-ing and discharging the vessel’s cargo.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 70
Prior to cargo operation1. Check that the designated compartments are clean and ready to receive
cargo.2. Check that the drainage and bilge suctions are working effectively.3. Ensure that cargo battens (spar ceiling) is in position and not damaged
(some cargoes require cargo battens to be removed).4. Make sure the relevant hatch covers are open and properly secured in
the stowed position.5. Check the rigging of derricks and/or the cranes are operating correctly.6. Check that the hatch lighting’s are in good order.7. Order engineers to bring power to deck winches.8. Inspect all lifting appliances to ensure that they are in good order.9. Inspect and ensure all means of access to the compartments are safe.
10. Guard rails and safety barriers should be seen to be in place.11. Ensure all necessary fire-fighting arrangements are in place.12. Check that the ship’s moorings are taught.13. Note the draughts fore and aft.14. Check that the gangway is rigged in a safe aspect.
During cargo transfer1. Note all starting and stopping times of cargo operations for reference
into the log book.2. Note the movement of cargo parcels into respective compartments for
entry onto the stowage plan.3. Refuse damaged cargo and inform the Chief Officer of the action.4. Monitor the weather conditions throughout operations.5. Note any damage to the ship or the cargo-handling gear and inform the
Chief Officer accordingly.6. Maintain a security watch on all cargo parcels and prevent pilferage.7. Tally in all special and valuable cargoes and provide lock-up stow if
required.8. Maintain an effective watch on the gangway and the vessels moorings.9. Ensure that appropriate dunnage, separation and securing of cargo
takes place.10. Monitor all fire prevention measures.11. Check the movement of passengers’ baggage (passenger-carrying
vessels).12. Make sure all hazardous or dangerous cargoes have correct docu-
mentation and are given correct stowage relevant to their class(International Maritime Dangerous Goods (IMDG) Code).
13. Inspect compartments and the transit warehouse at regular intervals toensure cargo movement is regular.
14. Inform Chief Officer prior to loading heavy lifts.15. After discharge operations, search the space to prevent parcels being
overcarried.
Stowage properties of general cargoes 71
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 71
16. Ensure that the local by-laws are adhered to, throughout.17. Note the draughts on the completion of loading/discharging.
After cargo operations1. Close up hatches and lock and secure access points.2. Inform engineering department to shut down power to deck winches.3. Secure all lifting appliances against potential damage or misuse.4. Enter the days working notes into the deck log book.5. Inform the Chief Officer that the deck is secure and the current draughts.
MiscellaneousThe Chief Officer would ensure that the cargo stowage plan is kept updatedwhen the vessel is in a loading situation. The officer’s workbooks and tallysheets would be used at this stage. He would also at some time order the dens-ity of the dock water to be ascertained by means of the hydrometer. Cargoloaded/discharged, being then ascertained by means of the deadweight scale.
72 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Stowage planS.S./M.V. --------------------
LOADED AT ---------------------------------------------------------------
VOYAGE ---------
Draught
No. 6
Bales CottonCaskstallow
Bagscoffee
Tinsfruit83 tonnes
meal
1370 bagsbones
1433 bags wheat
812 tonnes
Bulkwheat
987 tonnes
wethides
356 tonnesfrozen beef 249 tonnes wheat
RosarioRosario
247 bales cottonSantos
Caskslard
Casesmeat
106 tonnescotton
Santos
103 tonneslinters
305 tonneschilled beef
BA
178 tonneslinseed
expellers
Bagscoffee
22t
No. 5 No. 4 No. 3 No. 2 No. 1
FOR'D Cardiff
Glasgow
Liverpool
AFT
7.82 m[25'8"]
Optionalcardiff/lpool
Optionallpool/glasgow
8.07 m[26'6"]
500 dryhides
"KIPLING".
FOR ------------------------United Kingdom SAILED --------------------------
RIO GRANDE 1/9/60
ROSARIO, BUENOS ARIES, RIO GRANDE, SANTOS & RIO
16
Ros
250Bales
Cotton Cotton Coffee CoffeeExpeller
seedBonemeal
'Tallow
300Bales
500Bales
492Bales
40 TWool
70 C/SHorsehair
Hides30 BalesHorsehair
15 THidesLintersCotton
Wet
1750Bags
600Casks
1212Bags
2500Bags
Rio G ROS BA
BA BA BA
BA
BABA
RosRog
Rio Rio
BA
RIO GRIO
Upper 'tween deck
Lower 'tween deck
60 tonnesquebracho
extract
4237 pieces
6463006
Timber
164 tonnesdriedblood
276 tonneschilled beef
138 tonnestimber
Tinnedmeat
479casesmeat
Tinsfruit
200 b/swool
Caskstallow
45-tonnes
fruit
Horsehair(wings)
CornedbeefMeatTimber
482Hinds
540Hinds
1690 casesTinned fruit
485Fores
816Fores
766 Fores40 Hinds 1012 Fores
TinnedmeatExtract
Driedblood
310Hinds
1479C/S
650Bags
3125Bags
2365Pieces
2864Cases
2000 Casesfruit
900 CasesOx tongue
1735 Casesfruit
349Casks
2500Casks
2167Cases
4500Bags
406Casks
Lard76 tonnes
60tCanned
meat95 tonnes
tinnedmeat
BA
BA BA
243carcases
lamb
43bags
657cases
763 pieces timberRIO G
2112carcases
lamb
BA
LardCorned
beef
RosRio G ROS
Tallow
Sarros
OFFAL
Fig. 3.1 Example of open stow, general cargo plan.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 72
Stowage properties of general cargoes 73
Port of Colour No. 1 No. 2 No. 3 No. 4 On Portdischarge code Hold Hold Hold Hold deck total
1st
2nd
3rd
4th
5th
6th
Total
Draughts:
Forward ----------------------------------------------Aft ----------------------------------------------Mean ----------------------------------------------Density correction ------------------------------------ Scale D/WS.W. draught ------------------------------------ tonnes
Cargo ----------------------------Fuel ----------------------------Fresh water ----------------------------Ballast ----------------------------Stores ----------------------------
Total D/weight �Scale D/weight �
DifferenceTonnes
Deadweight particulars
Cargo distribution summary (tonnes)
The cargo stowage planThe function of the ‘stowage plan’ is to identify the various cargo parcels byquantity, destination and nature of goods (Figure 3.1).
It permits the Chief Officer to assess the number of stevedore gangs forrespective compartments and the times associated with cargo operations.Additionally, it shows the location of special cargoes like ‘heavy lifts’ or‘hazardous goods’, valuables and the lock-up stow goods.
Ventilation and fire-fighting procedures can be influenced by the dispos-ition or respective cargoes, while the owners/Charterers are provided withnotification of available space between discharge ports, useful for divertingthe vessel for further cargo.
Stowage plans provide the following relevant details in addition to thepictorial cargo distribution plan:
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 73
The above information with the ship’s name and port(s) of loading,together with date of sailing, are all included on the plan. Fuel, ballast andfresh water are usually depicted in alternative colours to colour codes asused for discharge ports.
Tanker stowage plan (profile � pipeline) (Chapter 5)Particularly useful with product tankers where the disposition of grades ofcargo can be clearly illustrated. The plan can ensure that adjacent tanks arenot likely to generate contamination.
The pipeline system is often employed in conjunction with the plan toensure that correct lines are operational with the correct grade of product.Quantities and type of each product can be easily identified, but clearly thisplan is not as detailed as with say an open stow general cargo vessel carry-ing many different types of cargoes.
Roll-on, Roll-off stowage plans (plan view) (Chapter 7)These are generally computer generated and like other stowage plans helpsto identify individual units. This is specifically required for any units carry-ing dangerous/hazardous products. It also permits the order of dischargeto be pre-arranged. Modern loadicators are usually involved with the plan-ning of cargo stowage with Roll-on, Roll-off (Ro-Ro) vessels. They permitknown weights aboard the vessel to be pre-programmed and the centre of gravity of each unit, with its respective stowage space, can be entered toprovide the ships overall metacentric height (GM), very quickly.
Container stowage plans (elevation � cross section) (Chapter 8)Container stowage plans are a proven way of tracking specific units duringthe sea passage. The plan identifies each unit and allows shippers to esti-mate arrival times and the whereabouts of their goods during every stageof shipment. It is also an effective security aspect for knowing which unit iswhere and tracing what goods are in what particular unit.
Pre-load plansProvides a provisional distribution plan for the intended cargo parcels.They may be accompanied by capacity space set against cargo capacity toreflect unused space. They can determine access points or detail pipelinearrangements prior to commencing cargo operations. They are generallyused on all types of vessels.
Steel cargoesProbably the most physically dangerous, of all cargoes, is steelwork. Steelcargoes tend to come in all shapes and sizes, from the biggest ‘casting’ tothe long steel ‘H’ girders used extensively in the construction industry.Long and heavy loads are difficult to control and the slightest contact withsurrounding structures could generate extensive damage or injury to per-sonnel. The fact that in most cases they are rigid and heavy, makes handling
74 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 74
safely extremely difficult. One of the exceptions to this, amongst the steelcargoes, is the loading and carriage of bulk scrap metal. Also a dangerouscargo but for different reasons. It is loaded/discharged by heavy grabs thatgenerally cause some fall out between quayside and shipside.
Steel coilsAnother form of steel cargo is heavy steel coils. The round shape makes thiscargo a high risk to shifting in a seaway, especially if it is not properlysecured. In the event of the cargo shifting, the ship could expect to take ona list which, if considered dangerous, could necessitate the vessel alteringcourse to a port of refuge. The prime purpose for this would be to dischargeand then to re-secure cargo, a costly business.
Steel coils are normally stowed in a double tier with the bottom coils onathwartships dunnage and wedged against athwartships movement, eachcoil being hard-up against the next (Figures 3.2 and 3.3). The objective is to
Stowage properties of general cargoes 75
Wood chock
Wooden wedgesbetween deck and first tier of coils
Tank top of lower hold flooredwith dunnage
Double bottom structure
Fig. 3.2 Secure stowage of steel coils.
Fig. 3.3 Steel coil loading Diamond bulker design with complete double hull isable to stow two tiers of heavy steel coils (each up to 25 tonnes) across the hatch.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 75
form a large immovable stow with any void spaces between coils chockedoff with dunnage. End of stows would be fenced with timber battens and‘locking coils’ together with the top tier of coils would most certainly belashed with steel wire rope lashings. With such a heavy cargo, the shipcould be expected to reach her loadline marks quickly leaving some con-siderable broken stowage with this type of cargo.
The turn of the bilge is protected by vertical dunnage and the second tier ofcoils is then placed on top. As the second tier is filled, it should be recognizedthat the stow will have ‘key’ locking coils and these should be lashed intoposition by steel wire lashings, while remaining accessible. It is also worthnoting that the size and weight of individual coils is not always uniform and,as such, differences create small gaps between the cargo stow. These gaps,where substantial, should be ‘chocked’ with baulks of timber, while wedgescan be used to prevent movement between smaller gaps (Figure 3.4).
Cargo Officers should be wary when working this cargo as the method oflifting during the loading process will usually be by a standard crane withadequate safe working load. However, when discharging, the odd coil maybe of a heavier variety and cause the lifting gear to be overloaded (somecoils go up to 10 tonnes).
The main concern for any Ship’s Master with coils within his cargo is thatthey are correctly secured and to this end it is not unusual to hire a rigging
76 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Bottle screw
Bulldog wire rope grips
Flexible steel wire rope
WedgesWedges
Cho
cks
betw
een
shel
l pla
tean
d up
per
tier
of s
teel
coi
ls
Dunnage
Fig. 3.4 Securing of steel coils.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 76
Stowage properties of general cargoes 77
Magnetic power control
Beam extension
Expandinglifting beam
ElectromagnetsSteel plate cargo
Hoist wires
Fig. 3.5 Operating principle of Telescopic Magnetic Lifting Beam.
gang during the period of loading. The ship’s stability must also be takeninto consideration with such a heavy cargo and as such, coils tend to bealways loaded in lower holds, as opposed to tween deck spaces. Such aloading pattern would tend to generate a favourable ‘GM’.
The quantity of cargo is usually restrictive, because its overall weightwill soon bring the vessel to her loadline marks. Geographically, the load-ing port will dictate which loadline zones the vessel must route through toreach her port of discharge and as such, the passage plan should reflect aroute that would minimize the ship’s rolling pattern wherever possible.
Steel plateSteel plates come in a variety of sizes from very long to heavy bundles of about2 m in length. Various methods are employed to handle this commodityfrom plate clamps on chain slings to electromagnetic expanding beams(Figure 3.5). The weight and overall size tend to make this an awkward anddangerous cargo to load or discharge and once stowed requires chainsecurings.
Being heavy it is usually given bottom stow and floored with dunnage toaccommodate any overstowing. Large plates may incur damage to the ves-sel and/or other cargoes during movement and careful handling should bethe order of the day.
Modern-handling techniques where steel plate is a regular cargo, tend toemploy gantry cranes working with electromagnetic, expandable beams.These are similar to steel stockyard cranes and are now seen in Port Terminalsworking in a similar manner to container gantry cranes, e.g. at the Port ofImmingham, UK.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 77
Bagged cargoesThere are many examples of bagged cargoes: fishmeal, grain, beans, cocoa,etc. to name but a few. They may be packed in paper bags like cement, orHessian sacks, as employed for grain or bean products, loading takingplace either in containers or on pallet slings. Size of bags tends to varydepending on the product, and are seen as a regular type of package forgeneral cargo vessels.
However, handling bagged cargo is expensive by today’s standards andmany of the products lend more easily and more economically to bulk car-riage or container stow. Where bags are stowed they should be on doubledunnage, stacked either bag on bag or stowed half bag as shown in Figure 3.6.
78 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Double dunnageHalf bag stow Bag on bag stow
Fig. 3.6 Examples of bagged stowage.
When receiving bagged cargo the bags should be seen to be clean and nottorn. Neither should they be bled in order to get a few extra bags into thecompartment. Such an action would only increase the sweepings after dis-charge and lead to increased cargo claims.
Slings should be made up, in or close to, the square of the hatch. If theyare made up in the wings, then bags are liable to tear as the load is draggedto the centre. Stevedores should not use hooks with paper bags and bagsshould not be hoisted directly by hooked lifting appliances.
Shippers frequently provide additional unused bags to allow for residualsweepings. This allows for all bags being discharged ashore, even tornbags, to ensure that a complete tally is achieved.
Bags containing oil seeds of any type must be stowed in a cool place asthese are liable to spontaneous combustion.
Examples of products for bag stowage:
Bone meal – other than keeping dry, no special stowage precautions arerequired.
Cattle food – should be kept dry and away from strong smelling goods.
Cement – paper bags require care in handling. Stow in a dry place and notmore than fifteen (15) bags high. Alternative carriage in bulk in speciallydesigned ships for the task. Bilges should be rendered sift proof and com-partments must be thoroughly clean to avoid contamination which wouldrender cement useless as a binding agent.
Chemicals – prior to loading check the IMDG Code and provide suitable stow.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 78
Cocoa – stow away from heat and from other cargoes which are liable totaint.
Coffee – requires plenty of ventilation and susceptible to damage fromstrong smelling goods.
Copra – dried coconut flesh. Liable to heat and spontaneous combustion. Itcould taint other cargoes and cause oxygen deficiency in the compartment.Requires good surface ventilation.
Dried blood – used as a fertilizer and must be stowed away from any cargoesliable to taint (similar stow for bones).
Expeller seed – must be shipped dry. It is extremely high risk to spontaneouscombustion and must not be stowed close to bulkheads, especially hotbulkheads.
Fishmeal – gives off an offensive odour and requires good ventilation. Thiscargo is liable to spontaneous combustion and requires continuous moni-toring of bags and surrounding air temperatures. Bags should not beloaded in a wet or damp condition, or if they are over 35°C or � 5°C aboveambient temperature whichever is higher.
Flour – easily tainted. The stow must be kept dry and clear of smelly goods.
Potatoes – loaded in paper sacks. Require a cool, well-ventilated stow.
Quebracho extract – this is a resin extract used in the tanning industry. Bagsare known to stick together and should be separated on loading by woodshavings.
Rice – see next page.
Salt – requires a dry stowage area.
Soda ash – should be stowed away from ironwork and foodstuffs, and mustbe kept dry.
Sugar – also carried as bulk cargo. Bagged green sugar exudes a lot ofsyrup. Stowage should be kept clear of the ship’s side as the bags are susceptible to tearing as the cargo settles. Dry refined sugar and wet orgreen sugar must not be stowed together. Cover steelwork with brownpaper for bulk sugar and keep dry.
RiceRice is considered as a ‘grain’ cargo and would need to meet the require-ments of the Grain Regulations affecting stowage. A ship’s condition for-mat would be required to show the cargo distribution and a curve ofstatical stability for the condition would need to be constructed.
Rice cargoes are now usually carried in bulk. This eliminates the costs ofhandling bags for the shipping phase. It is more economical and commonto bag rice products at the distribution stage.
Stowage properties of general cargoes 79
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 79
Rice contains a considerable amount of water and is liable to sweat. Itmust be well ventilated and not allowed to become moist or it will start torot and give off a pungent smell which could affect other rice cargoes in thevicinity. It is also known to give off carbonic acid gas (a weak acid formedwhen carbon dioxide (CO2) is dissolved in water).
Ventilators should generally be trimmed back to wind, althoughmatured grain rice will require less ventilation than new grain rice. In anyevent, a void space between the deck head of the compartment and the sur-face of the stow should be left bearing in mind the possibility of cargomovement and the necessity to employ shifting boards. Surface ventilationshould be ongoing to remove warm air currents rising from the bulk stow.
Prior to loading rice, the compartments should be thoroughly cleaned,bilges sweetened and made sift free. A lime coating is recommended,together with a cement wash. Their condition must be such to pass surveyinspection. The hold ceiling should be stain free and covered by a tarpaulinor separation cloth. To this end an adequate supply of matting and separ-ation cloths are to be recommended.
If compartments are only partly filled, then bagged rice with suitableseparation cloths may be used to secure the stow. Bags for rice are usuallyof a breathable man-made, interwoven fabric. A ship loading rice wouldneed a Certificate of Authorization, or alternatively the master would needto show that the vessel can comply with the carriage regulations to the sat-isfaction of an Maritime and Coastguard Agency (MCA) Surveyor.
Modern loading methods usually employ chutes, while pneumatic suc-tion systems are often engaged for the discharge process. Working capacityof distribution and suction units is up to about 15 000 tonne/h (stowage factorfor rice in bags � 1.39 m3/tonne, or bulk stow � 1.20 m3/tonnes). Note: Seeadditional reference in Chapter 4.
Bale goodsVarious types of goods are carried in bales, either in open stow or con-tainerized. Bales in open stow are normally laid on thick single dunnage ofat least 50 mm in depth. Bales are expected to be clean with all bands intact.Any stained or oil marked bales should be rejected at the time of loading.All bales should be protected against ships sweat and the upper level ofcargo should be covered with matting or waterproof paper to prevent mois-ture from the deck head dripping onto the cargo surface.
Examples of bale cargoes:
Carpets – a valuable cargo which must be kept dry. Hooks should not beused. More commonly carried in containers these days.
Cotton/cotton waste – bales of cotton are highly inflammable and stringentfire precautions should be adopted when loading this cargo. A strict no-smoking policy should be observed. If the bales have been in contact withoil or are damp they are liable to the effects of spontaneous combustion.Generally, a dry stowage area is recommended.
80 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 80
Esparto grass – these and products like hay and straw bales are high risk tospontaneous combustion especially if wet and loosely packed. Poorly com-pressed bales should be rejected. If carried on deck these bales should becovered by tarpaulins, or other protective coverage.
Fibres – such as jute, hemp, sisal, coir, flax or kapok are all easily com-bustible. A strict no-smoking policy should be observed at all stages of con-tact. Bales must be kept away from oil and should not be stowed in thesame compartment as coal or other inflammable substances or other cargoes liable to spontaneous combustion.
Oakum – this is hemp fibres impregnated with pine tar or pitch. It is highlyinflammable and strict no-smoking procedures should be adopted. It is alsoliable to spontaneous combustion.
Rubber – if packed in bales these give an unstable platform on which tooverstow other cargoes, other than more bales of rubber. Crêpe rubbertends to become compressed and sticks to adjacent bales and talcum pow-der should be dusted over the bales to prevent this stickiness betweenbales. Polythene sheeting with ventilation holes is also used and is now inmore common use for the same purpose. Up-to-date methods tend to wrapthe whole bales separately in polythene to eliminate the sticking element.
Tobacco – usually stowed in bales in open stow. It is liable to taint other cargoes and is also susceptible to taint from other cargoes in close proxim-ity. The stowage compartment should be dry and kept well ventilated orthere is a risk of mildew forming.
Wood pulp – must be kept dry. If it is allowed to get wet it will swell andcould cause serious damage to the steel boundaries of the compartment.Notice metacentre (M) 1051 recommends that care should be taken to ensurethat no water is allowed to enter the compartment. To this end all air pipesand ventilators should be sealed against the accidental ingress of water.
Wool – can be shipped in either scoured or unscoured condition. The twotypes should not be stowed together. Bales should be well dunnaged andprovided with good ventilation. Slipe and pie wools are liable to spontan-eous combustion and should, if possible, be stowed in accessible parts ofthe hold.
Loading, stowage and identification of cargo parcelsIn order to ensure correct handling and stowage of goods, cargoes tend tobe labelled and marked with instructions on the side of respective packages(Figure 3.7). Cargo is shipped all over the globe and not all countries of dis-charge are English speaking – to this end labels are of a pictorial display.Cargo Officers can monitor from the labelling that instructions are com-plied with and that stowage practice is as per shippers’ instructions.
Stowage properties of general cargoes 81
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 81
Stowage of wineWine was often carried in barrels, and in some cases still is. However, bulkroad tankers, and even designated wine carriers, are engaged in the shipmentof large quantities of wine in bulk. Where barrels are transported they shouldbe stowed on the side (bilge), with the ‘bung’ uppermost (Figure 3.8(a)).The stow should not be greater than eight (8) high and the first height levelshould be laid on a bed to keep the bilge free. ‘Quoins’, a type of wedgearrangement, are used to support the barrels and prevent them from moving(Figure 3.8(b)).
Barrels are heavy, with a capacity of 36 imperial gallons (164 l) and nor-mally require two men to handle and stow in a fore and aft direction. Modernaluminium casks have, to some extent, replaced the old wooden barrels butsome companies still use the old-fashioned wood barrels for their product.
Barrels are given underdeck stowage and would not generally be takenas deck cargo.
Where wine is not shipped in bulk-holding tanks or barrels the morepopular method in this day and age is to pre-bottle the commodity andexport in cartons usually in a container. Distinct advantages are associatedwith this method, in that pilferage is reduced with the bottled wine underlock and key. Containers are easily packed and sealed under customs con-trols. Mixed commodities, like spirits or beer, can also be packed into thesame container. Once sealed, transport and shipping via a container ter-minal is usually trouble free.
82 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fragile. Handlewith care
This way up
Heavy weights this end
Sling here Keep cool. Stow awayfrom boilers
Use no hooks
Fig. 3.7 Example labels provide instructions to stevedores for correct stowagepractice.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 82
Barrels are used more these days to allow wines to mature, rather than astransport vessels. They are awkward to handle and have difficulties instowage. The art of the ‘cooper’ is also becoming scarce and if barrels aredamaged in transit it becomes expensive to effect repairs.
Occasionally, barrels are still employed but with specialist commoditiesor shipped from one wine cellar to another where surplus casks are avail-able or required.
Stowage properties of general cargoes 83
Chime Bung Quarter hoop
Staves
Bilge hoopBilgeQuarter
Head
Chime hoop
Dunnage forms ‘beds’(b)
(a)
Quoins
Fig. 3.8 Wine barrels.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 83
84C
argo
Wo
rk for M
aritime O
peratio
nsProfile
Plan Cargo tanks
Fig. 3.9 Profile and tank disposition of ‘Carlos Fischer’. Reproduced with kind permission from Motor Ship.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 84
Bulk fluid productsSome products like wine and fruit juices have generated the construction of specialized transports, specifically for the carriage. An example of this isseen with the ‘Carlos Fischer’ fitted with free standing, stainless steel tanksfor the purpose of shipping bulk ‘orange juice’ (Figure 3.9).
The ship is 42 500 dwt (deadweight tonnage), and is engaged in shippingconcentrated orange juice from estates in Brazil. It is double hulled but notclassed as a tanker, having four holds each with four vertical cylindricalfruit juice tanks. Cargo piping running through the holds is led to mani-folds in lockers in the deckhouse.
Case goodsCase goods lend particularly to a general cargo open stow but can be con-tainerized depending on size. Heavy cases should always be given bottomstow with the lighter cases on top. If the contents of the case are pilferable,then they should be loaded into a lock-up stow and tallied in and tallied out.
Slinging of case goods will be directly related to their weight and may befitted with identified lifting points. Care should be taken that such liftingpoints are attached to the load and not just to the package (Figure 3.10).
Stowage properties of general cargoes 85
Fig. 3.10 Example of case goods/general cargo being loaded/discharged.
Specific case goods, i.e. glass, may have special stowage requirements.This would probably be marked as ‘Fragile’ or ‘This way up’ and requireside, end on stowage. Crated cars or boats would expect to be loaded on levelground, and generally other crated goods would be treated as case goodsdepending on the nature of the contents.
Fork lift truck operations are often employed with the movement andstowage of heavy case goods both in the warehouse, on the quayside andaboard the vessel. However, the use of fork lift trucks inside the hold tendsto be restrictive with case goods because they are so bulky. The fork lift
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 85
truck needs open deck space to allow manoeuvring and as large casesquickly start to fill the manoeuvring space, landing becomes the only methodto continue loading.
The loading and carriage of drumsCargo in drums is not unusual and can be varied by way of chemicals, oils,paints, dyes, even sheep dip. Drums may differ in size, but a 50-gallondrum is probably the most common size for oils and is often used for ownship’s stores of lubricating or diesel oil.
They are often taken as deck stow. In such an event, they would be pro-tected by nets or a timber built compound to keep the stow tight, dependingon the number of drums carried. Where upper decks are covered, this maynecessitate a catwalk being built over the drums in order to provide acces-sibility to all parts of the vessel when at sea. In any event, drum cargoes areplaced on single dunnage and are invariably secured by wire lashings, withor without nets, to prevent movement of the cargo when at sea.
Concern with such cargo may arise with the obvious problem of a leak-ing drum. If such an occurrence did take place, the action would depend onthe contents of the drum, the associated effects on other cargoes, the poten-tial fire risk and the ability to get at the affected drum(s). To this end, wherecorrosives are carried in large numbers, it may be better to stow the drumsin smaller batches to allow accessibility to damaged units, as opposed to atotal block stow of many drums together. Such a block stow may prove dif-ficult, if not impossible, to get at the affected drums when in transit.
When substances with a flash point below 23°C (73°F) are carried belowdecks, adequate ventilation will have to be given to prevent the build up of any dangerous concentrations of inflammable vapours. Low flash pointcargoes having a wide flammable range are extremely hazardous. Anysuch cargoes, that are likely to present a health hazard or increased fire riskto the vessel, should initially be checked against the advice offered by theIMDG Code (see Chapter 9) and any precautions followed accordingly.
Underdeck stowage of drummed commodities often tend to run a highfire risk with or without explosion risk. The compartment should be wellventilated and any gases or fumes should not be allowed to build up intodangerous concentrations. Prudent use of cargo hold fans should be exer-cised while on the voyage to ensure a continued safe atmosphere within thecompartment and a no-smoking policy must be observed at all times.
Casks are manufactured in aluminium and are used extensively for ‘beer’.They are comparatively light and may be full or empty. They require a com-pact stow and are often netted to prevent movement when in open stow.
A cargo of ingots – Copper, lead or tin ingots are all very heavy concentratedcargo parcels and require bottom stow, similar to the iron cargoes of cast-ings, iron billets and long steelwork.
Lighter goods may be stowed on top of ingots but a secure separationbetween cargoes is desired. Ingots cannot be stowed high and are difficult
86 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 86
to work on top of the cargo without a dunnage floor. Ingots are often baledand banded, but are sometimes shipped as single-bar elements being floorstacked. Ingots can be considered a valuable cargo and are usually tallied inand tallied out at discharge.
Cable reels – large wooden reels with power cable rove around a central coreare carried as general cargo. They are stowed in the upright position, on afirm deck and should be secured against any pitching or rolling of the ves-sel when in a seaway. They can be quite, large, 3–4 m in diameter, and con-sequently may be considered as a heavy load, especially if the cablecontains a steel construction element.
Designated ‘Cable Ships’ with telegraph cable tend to load the cable directlyinto specially constructed cylindrical tanks in specialized cable holds. Suchcables should not be confused with the Cable Reels discussed as general cargo.
Paper cargoes – paper may be carried in many forms from waste paper tonewsprint. The compartment, in whatever form the paper is to be carried,must be in a dry condition and well ventilated. Newsprint is carried in rollswhich are normally stowed on their ends to avoid distortion, preferably ondouble dunnage.
A ship’s steelwork would normally be protected with waterproof paper toprevent ships sweat from damaging the rolls. Hooks should not be used dur-ing the loading or discharge periods. On occasions, like in tween decks, therolls may be stowed on their sides. If this is done, they should be chocked offto prevent friction burns and movement when the vessel is at sea.
Rolls of paper should be sighted as being unmarked by oil or other simi-lar stains on loading. Once on board, the cargo should be kept clean and notallowed to become contaminated by any form of oil or water.
Dried fruits – these include: apricots, currents, dates, figs, prunes, raisinsand sultanas. May be shipped in cases, cartons, small boxes or even baskets.However carried, they must be stowed away from cargoes which are liableto taint. Dried fruits tend to give off a strong smell and generally may containdrugs and insects which could contaminate other cargoes, especially food-stuffs. The fruit itself is liable to taint from other strong odorous cargoesand stowage should be kept separate in cool well-ventilated compartments.Tween deck stowage is preferred, but if stowed in lower holds adequateventilation must be available throughout the course of the voyage. If in openstow, good layers of dunnage are recommended to assist air flow and thecargo should not be overstowed.
Garlic and onions – shipped in bags, cases or crates and these give off a pun-gent odour and must be stowed clear of other cargoes liable to taint. It isessential that onions and garlic are provided with good ventilation, similarto fresh fruit. Considerable moisture will be given off onions and adequatedrainage facilities would be expected.
Fresh fruit – apples, apricots, pears, peaches, grapefruit, grapes, lemons andoranges can be carried quite successfully in non-refrigerated compartments,
Stowage properties of general cargoes 87
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 87
the proviso being that adequate dunnage is used along with good ventila-tion. In the event that mechanical ventilation is not used then hatchesshould be opened (weather permitting). Fruit, especially green fruit, givesoff a lot of gas and extreme care should be exercised before entering anycompartment stowed with fresh fruit. Following the discharge of fruit theholds should be well aired and deodorized.
Cargo monitoring and tallyingTallying – all cargoes are tallied on board the vessel and for monitoring the cargo parcels in this manner, specialized ‘tally-clerks’ are employed. Theseclerks tend to reflect the shipper’s interest, while others so engaged by theship may represent the owner’s or ship’s operator’s interests. Cargo parcelsare not only tallied into the ship but also tallied out at the port of discharge.
Tally counts are important, especially in the case of valuable effects, or shortquantities being delivered to the ship. Cargo claims draw on tally informa-tion to substantiate quality and quantity as and when disputes evolvebetween the ship and the shipper, bearing in mind that the ship’s personnelare there to protect the shipowner’s or Charterer’s interest.
Mate’s Receipts tend to be the supporting document which denotes thequantity, marks, description and the apparent condition of goods receivedon board. It is usually signed by the Ship’s Chief Officer, hence the name‘Mate’s Receipt’.
88 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
CARGO shipped on Board “____________________________”
In good condition excepting where otherwise stated
Port of Shipment_________________________Date__________________
Destination _________________Hatch No___________ ex________
NB Ships Tally Clerk to record all visible damage
MARKS PACKAGES SEPARATENUMBERS
TOTAL
Ships tally Clerk _______________________________
Fig. 3.11 Tally clerk’s account.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 88
It is important that the details of the cargo are correctly stated on the Mate’sReceipts as it is from these that the ‘Bills of Lading’ (B/L) could be prepared.The Bills of Lading are sent to the various consignees, who will in turn pres-ent them to the master before the cargo is handed over. The Bills of Ladingare the consignee’s title to the goods stated and he therefore can expect toreceive those goods as described. In the event of the goods not being in thesame condition as stated on the B/L, by way of quantity or quality, then theshipper could make a claim against the ship for any discrepancy.
Ship’s Officers should bear in mind that they are temporary custodiansof goods which belong to a third party. As such, they must endeavour to keep them in the same condition as that in which they were receivedaboard the vessel. As far as possible damaged cargo or damaged packagesshould be rejected for shipping.
Cargo sweat and ventilationA great number of cargo claims are made for merchandise which has beendamaged in transit. Much of this damage is caused by either ‘ships sweat’or ‘cargo sweat’ and could be effectively reduced by prudent ventilation ofcargo spaces.
Sweat is formed when water vapour in the air condenses out into waterdroplets once the air is cooled below its dew point. The water droplets may bedeposited onto the ship’s structure or onto the cargo. In the former, it is knownas ‘ships sweat’ and this may run or subsequently drip onto the cargo. Whenthe water droplets form on cargo this is known as ‘cargo sweat’ and will occurwhen the temperature of the cargo is cold and the incoming air is warm.
To avoid sweat and its damaging effects it is imperative that ‘wet anddry’ bulb temperatures of the air entering and the air contained within thecargo compartment, are taken at frequent intervals. If the temperatures ofthe external air is less than the dew point of the air already inside the space,sweating could well occur. Such conditions give rise to ‘ships sweat’ and iscommonly found on voyages from warm climates towards colder destin-ations. Similarly, if the temperature of the air in the cargo compartment (orthe cargo) is lower than the dew point of incoming air, sweating couldagain occur, giving rise to ‘cargo sweat’. This would be expected on voy-ages from cold places towards destinations in warmer climates.
If cargo sweat is being experienced or likely to occur, ventilation from theoutside air should be stopped until more favourable conditions are obtained.However, it should be noted that indiscriminate ventilation often doesmore harm than no ventilation whatsoever. It is also of concern that vari-ation in the angles of ventilators away from the wind can cause very differ-ent rates of air flow within the compartment. The angle at which the ship’scourse makes with the wind also affects the general flow of air to cargocompartments. In general, the greatest air flow occurs when the lee ventila-tors are trimmed on the wind and the weather ventilators are trimmedaway from the wind. This is known as through ventilation (Figure 3.12).
Stowage properties of general cargoes 89
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 89
Forced ventilation – if the dew point temperature in the cargo compartmentcan be retained below the temperature of the ships structure, i.e. decks,sides, bulkheads and the cargo, there would be no risk of sweat forming.Such a condition cannot always be achieved without some form of mechan-ical (forced) ventilation from fans or blowers.
There are several excellent systems on the commercial market whichhave the ability to circulate and dry the air inside the cargo holds. Systemsvary but often employ ‘baffle’ plates fitted in the hold and tween decks sothat air can be prevented from entering from the outside when conditionsare unfavourable. Systems re-circulating the compartment’s air can alsooperate in conjunction with dehumidifying equipment to achieve satisfac-tory conditions pertinent to relevant cargo.
Cargo battens (spar ceiling) – the purpose of the wooden cargo battens, whichcan be fitted horizontally or vertically, is to keep the cargo off the ship’sinner steel hull. This arrangement produces an air gap of about 230 mmbetween the steelwork and the cargo surface, and subsequently reduces therisk of cargo sweat damaging cargo parcels. It is normal practice with somebulk cargoes, when carried in holds fitted with spar ceiling, to remove thewood battens to reduce the damage incurred to the wood, prior to loading,e.g. coal (Figure 3.13).
Dunnage – timber slats of a thickness of about 35/40 mm which are ordered inbundles by the Ship’s Chief Officer. The purpose of dunnage, which can belaid either singularly or in a criss-cross double dunnage pattern, is to pro-vide an air gap to the underside of the cargo. This allows ventilationaround all sides of the cargo stow. This is again to effectively reduce the risk
90 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Wind
Fig. 3.12 Showing air circulation with lee ventilators on the wind and weathervents off. This is through ventilation.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 90
of sweat damage to cargo. Dunnage should be in a clean condition and notoily or greasy as this could cause contamination to sensitive cargoes.
Tank top ceiling – a wood sheathing which covers the steelwork of the tanktop, in way of the hatchway in the lower hold. This timber flooring not onlyprotects the tank tops but also lends to a non-skid surface in the hold. Itgenerally assists drainage of any moisture in the space and can be used inconjunction with a single-dunnage layer.
Contamination – cargoes which taint easily, e.g. tea, flour, tobacco, etc.should be kept well away from strong smelling cargoes. If a pungent cargohas been carried previously, i.e. cloves or cinnamon for example, the com-partment should be deodorized before loading the next cargo.
Dirty cargoes should never be carried in the same compartment as cleancargoes. A general comparison of dirty cargoes would include such com-modities as oils, paints or animal products, whereas clean cargoes wouldcover the likes of foodstuffs or fabrics. Obviously some notable exceptionsin each of the two classes are to be found.
Separation of cargoes – it is often a requirement when separate parcels of thesame cargo are carried together that a degree of separation between theunits is essential. Depending on the type of goods being shipped will reflectthe type of separation method employed. Examples of separation materialsinclude colour wash, tarpaulins, burlap, paper sheeting, dunnage, chalkmarks, rope yarns or polythene sheets.
The idea of separation is to ensure that the cargo parcels, although maybelooking the same, are not allowed to become inadvertently mixed.
Stowage properties of general cargoes 91
Fig. 3.13 Cargo battens fitted horizontally to allow separation of the cargo fromthe ship’s inner steel hull.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 91
Optional cargo – optional cargo is cargo which is destined for discharge ateither one, two or even more ports. Consequently, it should be stowed insuch a position as to be readily available for discharge, once the designatedport is declared.
Overcarried cargo – if cargo meant for discharge is not discharged it is said to be overcarried to the next port. Such an event causes inconvenience,extra cost and additional paperwork. To this end hatches are searched oncompletion of discharge to ensure that all the designated cargo for the portof discharge has indeed left the ship – a method of checking against thecargo plan and the cargo manifest and comparing figures with the tally-clerks. It must be said, however, that this is not foolproof, especially if pres-sures are being applied to finish cargo operations and sail, and possiblydeparting before the holds have been properly examined for overcarriedcargo pieces.
Pilferage – certain cargoes always attract thieves. Notable items includespirits, beer, tobacco or high value small items. To reduce losses such car-goes should be tallied in and tallied out. Lock-up stow should be providedthroughout the voyage from the onset of loading to the time of discharge.Shore watchmen and security personnel should be used whenever it ispractical and good watch-keeping practice should be the order of the day.
Deep tank useMany vessels are fitted with ‘deep tanks’ – employed as ballast tanks or forthe carriage of specialized liquid cargoes such as vegetable oils – i.e. coconutoil, bean oil, cotton seed oil, linseed oil, palm oil or mineral oils. Other cargoes include ‘tallow’ or bulk commodities like grain, molasses or latex.
The specialization of such cargoes often require rigid temperature control of the cargo and to this end most cargo deep tanks are fitted with‘heating coils’ which may or may not be blanked off as the circumstancesdictate (Figure 3.14).
92 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Note: Some vessels with a shaft tunnel may be fitted with additional deep tanks aft, in aposition either side of the shaft tunnel, but these are not common.
Note: All precautions for the entry into an enclosed space must be taken prior to carry-ing out maintenance inside ‘deep tanks’ under a permit to work scheme.
Preparation of deep tanksThe need for absolute cleanliness with deep tanks is paramount and CargoOfficers are advised that they are virtually always subject to supervisionand survey prior to loading example cargoes. Claims for contamination ofthese cargoes are high and meticulous cleaning of the tank itself and thepipelines employed for loading and discharging must be a matter of course.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 92
Stowage properties of general cargoes 93
Upper tween deck
Lower tween deck
Starboarddeep tank
Portdeep tank
Heating coils Centre linebulkhead Hat box
2.3.4. 1.
Hat box
Fig. 3.14 Deep tank storage.
To enable the Classification Surveyor to certify that the tank has water-tight integrity and is clean, Chief Officers should, depending on the previ-ous cargo, ensure that:
● After the carriage of a general cargo, the tank is swept down completelyand any waste removed.
● In the event of a liquid cargo (assuming of a non-hazardous nature),puddle any residual fluids to the suction and allow the tank to dry.
● If the tank is uncoated (they are often coated in epoxy covering), thebulkhead’s decks and deck head should be inspected for rust spots.These should be scraped and wire brushed, and all traces of corrosionremoved.
● Heating coils should be rigged and tested. These coils may be ‘side coils’or ‘bottom coils’, or a combination of both.
● Hat boxes should be cleaned out and the suctions should be tested.● The tank should be filled with clean ballast and the tank lid pressure
should be tested (tanks are to be tested to a head of water equal to themaximum to which the tank will be subjected but not less than 2.44 mabove the crown of the tank).
● The tank should be emptied to just above the heating coils, a cleansingagent added and the residual water heated by means of the coils. A washdown using a hose and submersible pump then to be carried out.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 93
● After cleaning, the heating element should be turned off and the tanksluiced down with fresh water, pumped dry and allowed to dry, with anyresidual puddles being mopped up.
● Finally, bilge suctions need to be cleaned and blanked off.
94 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Deep tank cargoesVegetable oils – when shipped in bulk, the tank must be thoroughly cleanedand all traces of previous cargoes must be removed. Tank suctions will beblanked off, and the overall condition will be inspected by a Cargo Surveyor.The tank itself would be tested for oil tightness prior to loading. Heatingcoils will probably be in operation depending on the required shippingtemperature. Some oils solidify at 0°C, others like palm oil or palm nut oil,solidify at between 32°C and 39°C, cotton seed oil and kapok seed oil solid-ify at about 10–13°C. Chief Officers could expect to be supplied with rele-vant shipping criteria for the oil.
Care must be taken that the heating is not too fierce or applied too quicklyas the cargo could scorch. Such an occurrence would be noticeable by somediscolouration of the oil, which could result in a cargo claim being filed.
Contamination is avoided by use of shoreside cargo pumps when dis-charging, while monitoring on passage is conducted by taking ullages andtemperatures at least twice per day for oils kept in the liquid state.
Following discharge of the cargo, the tank would probably be steamcleaned and washed with a caustic soda type solution to ensure cleanliness.Latex – is the ‘sap’ from rubber trees which rapidly solidifies when exposed toair. It is retained in liquid form by added chemicals, usually ammonia, andshipped in bulk. Note: Ammonia attacks brass and copper metalwork andlatex tanks should not have such metals as part of their construction.
Prior to loading latex, the tank would be tested and inspected to be thor-oughly clean. All steelwork would be coated with hot paraffin wax. The heat-ing coils would be removed as they are not needed for the carriage. Ventilators,air pipes and sounding pipes are all sealed to prevent ammonia loss due toevaporation. Fire extinguishing pipes if fitted should also be plugged. Gasrelief valves are fitted to ease any pressure build up inside the tank.
Discharge of the cargo is carried out by shoreside pumps and the tankwould then be washed down with water to remove all traces of ammonia.The wax coating is often left in place unless the tank is to be used immedi-ately for another cargo.
Molasses – a syrup obtained from the manufacturing process of sugar.Carried in deep tanks similar to vegetable oils, with heating coils operationalto retain the cargo in a liquid state. It is discharged by shoreside pumps andthe tanks would be scrubbed and washed down with plenty of water as soon
Note: Personnel so involved should be provided with protective clothing and footwear,together with goggle eye protection. Breathing apparatus may also be a requirement. A risk assessment would be carried out prior to commencing the above task.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 94
after discharge as is practical. Most contamination claims develop from dirtypipelines. Note: Specially designated vessels are employed for the carriageof molasses so the use of deep tanks has diminished with this type of cargo.
RancidityThe possibility of products turning rancid is always present, especiallywith fatty oils and fats which contain strong flavours and odours. Theseelements become developed by being exposed to light, moisture and air,and move towards a condition we know as rancidity. A by-product follow-ing excessive exposure and subsequent chemical reaction is the productionof fatty acids. These then decompose and form other compounds which aredramatically increased by temperature rise. Such action means that lessrefined, pure oil is recoverable.
Stowage properties of general cargoes 95
Note: Fats are considered as products which are solid at ordinary temperatures, e.g.15°C. Fatty oils are those which are liquid at that temperature. The difference betweenfats and fatty oils is that fatty oils are more chemically reactive than fats.
Handling precautions – Hides must only be handled with gloves as there is a high riskof contracting anthrax which could prove fatal. Neither should stevedores use hooks in thehandling, because of damage to the product. In the case of dry hides these are often brittleand any person being scratched or cut should receive immediate hospital treatment.
The stowage of hides must be away from dry goods and ironwork. Theyhave a pungent odour and should be stowed well away from other goodsthat are liable to spoil. They should not be overstowed.
Ballasting and Ballast ManagementAs cargo is loaded it is general practice for most types of vessels to de-ballast. Some tanks are retained for the purpose of trimming the shipand adjusting the stability conditions, but overall if the ballast was kept onboard, the ship could well be seen to be overloaded.
In future it is expected that participating governments to the Inter-national Maritime Organization (IMO) convention will have to restrict dis-charge of ballast water because of the impurities it may contain. To this end
Hides – may be shipped in either a wet or dry condition, either in bundlesor in casks, or even loose. They are often carried in deep tanks, usuallybecause there is not enough of them to fill a tween deck or lower holdspace. Another factor that is against stowage in a tween deck is that wethides require adequate drainage which would be difficult to achieve inexposed stow. Pickling and/or brine fluid can expect to find its way to thebilges which will necessitate pumping probably twice daily at the begin-ning of a voyage with hides in the cargo.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 95
a Ballast Management (Record) Book would need to be kept, indicatingwhich tanks are filled/emptied, the position of the Ballast Movement anddetails of quantities and any treatment, e.g. ultraviolet light which the watermay be submitted to.
StabilityWhen loading/discharging the cargo, due regard must be taken of theship’s condition of stability at every stage and position of the voyage. A rea-sonable ‘GM’ must be appropriate throughout the passage and loadlinezones must not be infringed. Most modern vessels would engage the flexi-bility of a ‘loadicator’ (computer program) for working relevant stabilitycriteria. Associated software of this nature would also provide bending,and shear force stresses incurred and take account of total weights of stores,bunkers, fresh water and ballast contents to provide example conditions.
96 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Note: Free surface moments have a negative effect on the ship’s GM, especially whenloading or discharging heavy-lift cargoes which may cause the vessel to heel. To this endslack tanks should be avoided if at all possible, when working cargo (see also examples inChapter 10).
LoadlinesShip’s Cargo Officers must take care that the vessel is not overloadedbeyond the appropriate loadline. Overloading endangers the safety of thevessel and would incur the risk of a heavy fine against the Ship’s Master.When loading certain cargoes, especially bulk cargoes like bulk ore and oilthe vessel is liable to become hogged or more probably adopt a saggedposition. If the vessel is sagging the apparent mean draught will be lessthan the actual mean draught. This situation does not permit overloading.
The various loadlines (Figure 3.15) are shown and they are assigned to the vessel following a loadline survey by an Assigning Authority, e.g.Lloyds Register.
‘S’ The summer loadline mark is calculated from the loadline rulesand is dependent on many factors including the ship’s length,type of vessel and the number of superstructures, the amount ofsheer, minimum bow height and so on.
‘W’ The Winter mark is 1/48th of the summer load draught below ‘S’.‘T’ The Tropical mark is 1/48th of the summer load draught above ‘S’.‘F’ The Fresh mark is an equal amount of �/4T millimetres above
‘S’ where � represents the displacement in metric tonnes at thesummer load draught and T represents the metric tonnes per cen-timetre immersion at the above. In any case where the displace-ment cannot be ascertained, F is the same level as T.
TF The Tropical Fresh mark, relative to ‘T’ is found in the same man-ner as that of ‘F’ relative to ‘S’.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 96
WNA The Winter North Atlantic mark is employed by vessels notexceeding 100 m in length when in certain areas of the NorthAtlantic Ocean, during the winter period. When it is assigned it ispositioned 50 mm below the Winter ‘W’ mark.
Timber loadlinesCertain vessels are assigned Timber Freeboards when they meet certain addi-tional conditions. One of these conditions must be that the vessel must havea forecastle of at least 0.07 extent of the ship’s length and of not less than astandard height (1.8 m for a vessel 75 m long or less in length and 2.3 m for avessel 125 m or more in length, with intermediate heights for intermediatelengths) (Figure 3.16). A poop deck or raised quarter deck is also required ifthe length of the vessel is less than 100 m. All lines are of 25 mm wide.
LS is derived from the appropriate tables contained in the loadline rules.LW is one-thirty-sixth (1/36th) of the summer timber load draught
below LS.LT is one-forty-eighth (1/48th) of the summer timber load draught
above LS.LF and Lumber Tropical Fresh (LTF)are both calculated in a similar
way to F and TF except that the displacement used in the formula is that ofthe vessel at her summer timber load draught. If this cannot be ascertainedthese marks will be one-forty-eighth (1/48th) of LS draught above LSand LT, respectively. LWNA is at the same level as the WNA mark.
Stowage properties of general cargoes 97
Deck line
300 mm
540 mm
230 mm
230 mm25 mm
450 mm
All lines are 25 mm in thickness.
FreeboardTF
FFWA
T
S
WWNA
Fig. 3.15 Loadline marks. Should the ship carry a lumber loadline this wouldbe positioned aft of the Plimsoll Mark and identity marks be prefixed with an‘L’, e.g. LTF � Lumber Tropical Fresh. LR: Lloyds Register; TF: Tropical Fresh; T: tropical; F: Fresh; S: Summer; W: Winter; WNA: Winter North Atlantic; FWA:
Fresh Water Allowance.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 97
98 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Ships with timber loadlines and carrying timber deck cargo in accordance with the M.S.(Loadlines) (Deck Cargo) Regulations 1989 must observe the applicable loadline that shewould use if she were not marked with timber loadlines, i.e. Lumber Summer (LS) in theSummer Zone. However, if the timber is not carried in accord with the regulations theordinary loadlines should be employed.Note: The Dock Water Allowance (DWA) would be applied for vessels which are load-ing in waters other than sea water of 1.025.
LTF
LT
LS
LW
LWNA
LF
230 mm
230 mm
450 mm
540 mm aft
Fig. 3.16 Timber loadlines. The letters denoting the assigning authority LRshould be approximately 115 mm in height and 75 mm in width.
Deadweight scaleOnce cargo has been loaded the ship’s draughts would normally be ascer-tained and it would be the Chief Officer’s practice to employ the dead-weight scale (part of the ship’s stability documentation) to ascertain theship’s final displacement. The known figures of fuel, stores and fresh watercan then be applied to provide a check against total cargo loaded from thescaled deadweight figure (Figure 3.17).
Offence to overloadCargo Officers should be aware that it is an offence to overload a vesselbeyond her legal marks and attempt to proceed to sea. The owner, or master,will be liable on summary conviction to a fine not exceeding the Statutorymaximum of (£5000) or on conviction on indictment, to an unlimited fine.The ship may also be detained until it has been surveyed and marked. Thecontravention will also carry, in addition to the stated fine, a further £1000per centimetre of the amount of overload.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 98
Restrictions to loadingThe Loadline Regulations provide various zones around the world’socean/sea areas. These zones reflect permanent and seasonal areas whichare depicted on a chart which accompanies the regulations. There are threepermanent zones, namely a summer zone in each hemisphere of the globe anda tropical zone across the equatorial belt – while the ship is passing throughthese zones the appropriate loadline would be used.
A ship cannot load deeper than her summer loadline in the summerzone, neither can a vessel load deeper than her tropical mark when in the tropical zone. There are five (5) ‘Winter Seasonal Areas’, usually foundconfined by land masses and include: the Black Sea, the Baltic Sea, theMediterranean, the Sea of Japan and the special ‘Winter’ area in the NorthAtlantic, applicable for ships 100 m or less in length.
Cargo Officers will frequently find themselves loading in dock water ofless density than sea water and such a situation would warrant use of theDWA formula which would permit a vessel to load beyond her marks,knowing that the vessel will rise to the permitted loadline once entering thesea water of the respective zone or seasonal area.
Stowage properties of general cargoes 99
Deadweight(tonnes)
Freeboard(m)
Draught(m)
Displacement(tonnes)
Tonnesper cm
1200016000
15000
14000
13000
12000
11000
10000
11000
10000
9000
Load
Light 0 9
10
6
5
4
39
8
7
6
3
2
8000
7000
6000
5000
400013
17
18
19
190
180
170
160
12010.7
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.4
1000
M.C.T.1 cm
tonnes(m)
Km(m)
Draught
Draught
Fig. 3.17 Deadweight scales.
Chap-03.qxd 3/3/05 2:52 PM Page 99
Chapter 4
Bulk cargoes
IntroductionThe demand for raw materials continues to sustain a major sector of theshipping industry. Bulk products are shipped all over the world from theirpoint of origin to that position of demand. The ‘bulkers’ transport every-thing from grain and coal to chemicals and iron ore. The bulk tradesinvolve vast tonnage movement of any one commodity and such move-ment can present its own hazards and problems associated with the cargo.
Designs of ship’s holds have evolved to maximize capacity while at thesame time generating a safer method of carriage. The Maritime SafetyCommittee of the International Maritime Organization (IMO) has adoptedamendments to Chapter XII Safety of Life at Sea (SOLAS) (AdditionalSafety Measures for Bulk Carriers) which came into force in July 2004,affecting all bulk carriers regardless of their date of construction. Theseamendments include the fitting of dry space, water level detectors andalarm monitors, as well as means of draining and pumping, and dry spacebilges located forward of the ‘collision bulkhead’.
Further recommendations for bulk carriers over 150 m in length to require‘double-hulls’ has been agreed (but not yet ratified). Effectively, the double-hull, bulk carrier would seem to be the future for bulk cargoes. How thesecargoes are loaded, managed and discharged in the types of vessels involvedis as follows.
References for bulk cargoesInternational Code for the Safe Carriage of Grain in Bulk.International Code for the Construction and Equipment of Ships Carrying
Dangerous Chemicals in Bulk (IBC Code).Code of Practice for the Safe Loading and Unloading of Bulk Cargoes (BLU
Code).Code of Safe Practice for Solid Bulk Cargoes (BC Code).Resolutions of the 1977 SOLAS Conference, regarding the Inspection and
Surveys of Bulk Carrier vessels.MSC/Circ. 908 (June 1999), Appendix C, Uniform Method of Measurement of
the Density of Bulk Cargoes.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 100
Bulk cargoes 101
● MSC/Circ. 646 (June 1994) Recommendations for the Fitting of Hull StressMonitoring Systems ((also MGN) 108 M).
Definitions and terminology employed with bulk cargoesAngle of repose – the natural angle between the cone slope and the horizon-tal plane when bulk cargo is emptied onto this plane in ideal conditions. A value is quoted for specific types of cargoes, results being obtained fromuse of a ‘tilting box’. The angle of repose value is used as a means of regis-tering the likelihood of a cargo shift during the voyage.
An angle of repose of 35° is taken as being the dividing line for bulkcargoes of lesser or greater shifting hazard and cargoes having angles ofrepose of more or less than the figure are considered separately (Figure 4.1).
Fig. 4.1 Angle of repose.
Bulk density – is the weight of solids, air and water per unit volume. It includes the moisture of the cargo and the voids whether filled with airor water.
Cargoes which may liquefy – means cargoes which are subject to moisturemigration and subsequent liquefaction if shipped with a moisture contentin excess of the transportable moisture limit.
Combination carriers (OBO or O/O) – a ship whose design is similar to a con-ventional bulk carrier but is equipped with pipelines, pumps and inert gasplant so as to enable the carriage of oil cargoes in designated spaces.
Concentrates – these are the materials that have been derived from a naturalore by physical or chemical refinement, or purification processes. They areusually in small granular or powder form (Figure 4.2).
Conveyor system – means the entire system for delivering cargo from theshore stockpile or receiving point to the ship.
Flow moisture point – is that percentage of moisture content, when a flowstate develops.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 101
102 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Flow state – is a state which occurs when a mass of granular material is sat-urated with liquid to such an extent that it loses its internal shear strengthand behaves as if the whole mass was in liquid form.
Incompatible materials – are those materials which may react dangerouslywhen mixed and are subject to recommendations for segregation.
Moisture content – is that percentage proportion of the total mass which iswater, ice or other liquid.
Moisture migration – is the movement of moisture contained in the bulkstow, when as a result of settling and consolidation, in conjunction withvibration and the ship’s movement, water is progressively displaced. Partor all of the bulk cargo may develop a flow state.
Pour – means the quantity of cargo poured through one hatch opening asone step in the loading plan, i.e. from the time the spout is positioned overa hatch opening until it is moved to another hatch opening.
Transportable moisture limit – the maximum moisture content of a cargo thatmay liquefy at a level which is considered safe for carriage in ships otherthan those ships which, because of design features of specialized fittings,may carry cargo with a moisture content over and above this limit.
Fig. 4.2 An overhead view of a general cargo vessel engaged in the dischargeof concentrates by means of a free-standing crane using a mechanical grab.The ships own deck cranes are turned outboard to allow easy access for the
shoreside crane operation.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 102
Bulk cargoes 103
Trimming – a manual or mechanically achieved adjustment to the surfacelevel of the form/shape of a bulk stow in a cargo space. It may consist ofaltering the distribution or changing the surface angle to the point, perhapsof levelling some or all of the cargo, following loading.
Code of Safe Working Practice for Bulk Cargoes(now known as the Bulk Cargo (BC) Code)The IMO have produced several editions of the code since its conception in1965. It is meant as a guide and recommendation to governments andshipowners for the carriage of bulk cargoes of various types.
Recommendations are made about the stowage of the cargoes andinclude suggested maximum weights to be allocated to lower holds asfound from the formula:
0.9 � LBD
where L represents the length of the lower hold; B represents the averagebreadth of the lower hold and D represents the ships summer load draught.
The height of the cargo pile peak should not exceed:
1.1 � D � SF (m3/ tonnes) metres
where SF represents stowage factor.
Legislative, unified requirements (UR) for bulkcarriersWater ingress alarms – are required under SOLAS XII Regulation 12. Suchalarms must be fitted to all cargo holds and be audible and visual alarms tothe navigation bridge.
Existing bulk carriers are also required to have, in addition to the waterlevel alarms stated above, permanent access for close-up inspection and theuse of green sea loads on deck for the design of hatches and deck fittings.Such measures are expected to ensure that a well-maintained single-hull bulkcarrier will remain satisfactory for the remainder of its lifetime.
New bulk carriers – The 2004 Design and Equipment meeting of the MSC confirmedthe requirement that all bulk carriers would be of ‘double-hull’ construction (May 2004).Note: The distance between the inner and outer hulls being 1000 mm. (Consultation isstill ongoing).
They will probably also require: harmonized class notation and standarddesign-loading conditions together with ‘double-side shell’, water ingressalarms to cargo holds and forward spaces; increased strength and integrityfor the foredeck fittings; free fall lifeboats and immersion suits for all crewmembers (Figures 4.4 and 4.5).
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 103
104 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 4.3 Working bulk cargoes. Mechanical grabs discharging ‘scrap metal’from the cargo hold of a small bulk carrier. The single hull construction shows the athwartships, side framing, positioned vertically below the hatch
coaming.
Deck longitudinalsHatch coaming
Transverse web
Topside tank bottom
Holdframe
Bilge hopper
Lower stool
Tank top
Centre girder
Solid floorSide griders Longitudinals
Bilge hoppertransverse
Corrugated bulkheadat the end of hold
Fig. 4.4 Bulk carrier construction. Note: Framing on bulk carriers is designedas a longitudinal system in topside and double bottom tanks and as a transverse
system at the cargo hold, side shell position.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 104
Bulk cargoes 105
Structural changes will also incorporate the permanent means of accessfor close-up inspection, an amendment to the loadline which will allow thebuilding of stronger and more robust vessels but reduce deadweight capacityby approximate estimates of between 0.5% and 1.5%, depending on size.
Structural standards – as per SOLAS Chapter XII, applying to single-hull sideskin bulk carriers, will also apply to new double-hull, bulk carriers.
Additional equipmentAt the time of writing, drafted amendments to SOLAS, Chapter XII/II, pro-pose that new bulk carriers over 150 m in length and below shall be fitted withloading instrumentation which provides information on the ship’s stability.
Water ingress alarms – are required for vessels with a single cargo hold. Therequirement to fit water level detectors in the lowest part of the cargo spaceis applicable to bulk carriers less than 80 m in length or 100 m in length if built before 1998, to take effect from the first renewal or intermediate survey after July 2004. The alarms will be audible and visual to the navi-gational bridge and will monitor cargo spaces and other spaces forward ofthe collision bulkhead. This regulation does not apply to vessels with double sides up to the freeboard deck.
Additional referenceS.I. 1999 M.S. (Additional Safety Measures for Bulk Carriers) Regulations1999, and MGN 144 (M).
Future builds – double-hulls, bulk carrierconstructionThe double-hull types have inherent strength that allows flexible-loadingpatterns, which will increase the capacity for heavy load density cargoeslike steel coils. The design dispenses with exposed side frames in the holdsand presents a flush side and hold ceiling for cargoes. Such flush featureshave distinct advantages for hold cleaning and cargo working options withbulk commodities (Figures 4.5 and 4.6).
Fig. 4.5 Diamond 53, design – complete double hull in way of cargo holds.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 105
106 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 4.6 Bulk carrier designs and hatch coverings. (a) Conventional design(twin side moving hatch covers). (b) OJ Libaek’s Optimum 2000 (capesize) bulk
carrier design (twin hatch covers).
The double design also provides a perceived safer protection againstwater ingress and is therefore seen as being more environmentally friendlyin comparison with the single-hull types. Tank arrangements permit a large water ballast capacity, in both double bottoms and side tanks, elimi-nating the need to input ballast into cargo spaces, in the event of heavyweather.
Hold preparation for bulk cargoesBulk cargoes are generally loaded in designated ‘bulk carrier’ vessels, butthey can be equally transported in general cargo ship’s alongside othercommodities. However, in such circumstances, specific stowage criteriaand hold preparation would probably be a requirement. In virtually everycase, except where perhaps the same commodity from the previous voyageis being carried, the cargo holds would need to be thoroughly cleaned andmade ready to receive the next cargo.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 106
Bulk cargoes 107
Designated ‘bulk carrier’1. The holds would be swept down and cleared of any residuals from the
previous cargo.2. All rubbish and waste matter must be removed from the cargo space,
before loading of the next cargo can commence.3. The hold bilge system would need to be inspected and checked to ensure
that:– the bilge suctions are operational;– the bilge bays are clean and smelling sweet (not liable to cause cargo
taint).4. All hold lighting arrangements, together with relevant fittings, would be
inspected and seen to be in good order.5. The space, depending on the nature of the previous cargo and the nature
of the next cargo to be carried, would probably require to be washeddown with a salt water wash.
Note: Following a wash down, the space would be expected to be allowed to dry out.Special commodities, like foodstuffs, may require the cargo spaces to be surveyed prior topermission being granted to load the ship’s cargo.
Bulk cargoes
GrainGrain is defined in the IMO Grain Rules as: wheat, maize (corn), rye, oats,barley, rice, pulses or seeds, and whether processed or not, which, whencarried in bulk, has a behaviour characteristic similar to grain in that it isliable to shift transversely across a cargo space of a ship, subject to the nor-mal sea-going motion.
Applicable to the Grain RulesThe following terms mean:
Filled – when applied to a cargo space means that the space is filled and trimmed to feedas much grain into the space as possible, when trimming has taken place under the decksand hatch covers, etc.
Partly filled – is taken to mean that level of bulk material which is less than ‘filled’. Thecargo would always be trimmed level with the ship in an upright condition. Note: A shipmay be limited in the number of ‘partly filled’ spaces that it may be allowed.
Grain must be carried in accordance with the requirements of the fore-mentioned Grain Rules which consist of three parts, namely ‘A’, ‘B’and ‘C’.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 107
108 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Part A Contains 13 rules which refer, among other items, to definitions,trimming, intact stability requirements, longitudinal divisions (shiftingboards), securing and the grain-loading information which is to be sup-plied to the master. This information is to include sufficient data to allowthe master to determine the heeling moments due to a grain shift. Thus,there are tables of grain heeling moments for every compartment, which isfilled or partly filled, tables of maximum permissible heeling moments,details of scantlings of any temporary fittings, loading instructions in noteform and a worked example for the master’s guidance.
Part B Considers the effect on the ship’s stability of a shift of grain. Forthe purpose of the rules, it is assumed that in a filled compartment (definedas a compartment in which, after loading and trimming as required by therules, the bulk grain is at its highest level) the grain can shift into the voidspace which is always considered to exist at the side of hatchways andother longitudinal members of the structure or shifting boards, where theangle of repose of the grain is greater than 30°.
The average depth of these void spaces is given by the formula:
Vd � Vd1 � 0.75(d � 600) mm
where Vd represents the average void depth in mm; Vd1 is the standardvoid depth found from tables; d is the actual girder depth in mm.
The standard void depth depends on the distance from the hatch end orthe hatch side to the boundary of the compartment (Figure 4.7).
Abreast hatchway
Shiftingboards 0.6 mLow
sideHighside
Dotted line shows trimmed grainsurface before heeling
At ends of hatchway
Fig. 4.7 Showing use of shifting boards and assumed formation of voids ifheeled 15°.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 108
Bulk cargoes 109
The assumed transverse heeling moment can now be calculated by taking the product of the length, breadth and half the depth of the void (ifit is triangular over the full breadth) and the horizontal distance of the cen-troid of the void from the centroid of the ‘filled’ compartment:
The total heeling moment � 1.06 � calculated transverse heeling momentfor a full compartment
or
� 1.12 � calculated transverse heeling momentin a partly filled compartment
It will have been noted that the above heeling moments are expressed in m4
units and so it is also termed a volumetric heeling moment.The reduction in GZ in the initial position (�0) is assumed to be:
Total volumetric heeling moment due to grain shift
Stowage factor of the grain � displacement
The reduction in GZ at 40° (�40) � 0.8�0.Superimposing the above reductions in GZ on the vessel’s curve of stati-
cal stability will give a ‘heeling arm’ curve (straight line). The angle atwhich the two curves cross is the angle of heel due to the shift of grain andthis angle must not exceed 12°. Also, the initial metacentric height (GM)(after correction for free surface for liquid in tanks) must not be less than0.30 m (Figure 4.8).
As can be seen in Figure 4.8, the residual area between the original curveof righting levers and the heeling arms up to 40°, or such smaller angle atwhich openings in the hull, superstructures or deckhouse cannot be closedwatertight immersed (this is called 0f – the angle of flooding – at which pro-gressive flooding commences) must not be less than 0.075 metre-radians.
Residual area to be not lessthan 0.075 m-rad
Angle of heel dueto grain shift
Heeling arm curvedue to grain shift
Rightingarm curve
l0° l40°
Fig. 4.8 Heeling arm curve.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 109
110 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
If the vessel has no Document of Authorization, from the contractinggovernments, she can still be permitted to load grain if all filled compart-ments are fitted with centre line divisions extending to the greater of one-eighth maximum breadth of the compartment or 2.4 m. The hatches offilled compartments must be closed with the covers in place. The grain sur-faces in partly filled compartments must be trimmed level and secured,and she must have a GM which is to be the greater of 0.3 m or that foundfrom the formula I of the rules.
Part C Concerned with the strength and fitting of shifting boards,shores, stays and the manner in which heeling moments may be reduced bythe saucering of grain. The handling of bulk and the securing of hatches offilled compartments and the securing of grain in a partly filled compart-ment is also detailed.
When shifting boards are fitted in order to reduce the volumetric heelingmoment, they are to be of a certain minimum strength with a 15 mm hous-ing on bulkheads and are supported by uprights spaced according to thethickness of the shifting boards (e.g. 50 mm thick, shifting boards wouldrequire a maximum spacing of 2.5 m between uprights) (Figure 4.9). Theshores will be heeled on the permanent structure of the ship and be as nearhorizontal as practical but in no case more than 45° to the horizontal. Steelwire rope stays set up horizontally may be fitted in place of wooden shoresbut the wire must be of a size to support a load in the stay support of500 kg/m2.
The shifting boards will extend from deck to deck in a filled tween deckcompartment while in a filled hold they should extend to at least 0.6 m belowthe grain surface after it has been assumed to shift through an angle of 15°.
In a partly filled compartment the shifting boards can be expected toextend from at least one-eighth the maximum breadth of the compartmentabove the surface of the levelled grain to the same distance below.
Shifting boards
Shore Upright
Bridging
Heeled on permanent structure of ship
Fig. 4.9 Strength and fitting of shifting boards.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 110
Bulk cargoes 111
A further method of reducing the heeling moment in a filled compart-ment is to ‘saucer’ the bulk in the square of the hatch and to fill the saucerwith bagged grain or other suitable cargo laid on separation cloths spreadover the bulk grain (Figure 4.12(b)). The depth of the saucer on a vessel over18.3-moulded breadth will be not less than 1.8 m. Bulk grain may be used tofill a saucer provided that it is ‘bundled’ which is to say that after lining thesaucer with acceptable material, athwartships lashings (75 mm polypropy-lene or equivalent are placed on the lining material not more than 2.4 mapart and of sufficient length to draw tight over the surface of the grain inthe saucer. Dunnage 25 mm in thickness and between 150 and 300 mm wide islaid longitudinally over the lashings). The saucer is now filled with bulk grainand the lashing drawn tight over the top of the bulk in the saucer (Figure 4.11).
In a partly filled compartment, where account is not taken of adverseheeling moments due to grain shift, the surface of the bulk grain is to betrimmed level before being overstowed with bagged grain or other cargoexerting at least the same pressure to a height of not less than one-sixteenththe maximum breadth of the free grain surface or 1.2 m whichever is thegreater. The bagged grain, or other suitable cargo, will be stowed on a sep-aration cloth placed overt the bulk grain, or a platform constructed by25 mm boards laid over wooden bearers not more than 1.2 m apart maybeused instead of separation cloths.
Lashings and bottle screw securings must be regularly inspected andreset taught during the voyage.
Fig. 4.10 The bulk carrier ‘Alpha Afovos’ lies port side to the grain silos inBarcelona. The grain elevators seen deployed into the ships hold effecting
discharge.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 111
112 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Measures to reduce the volumetric heeling moment of ‘filled’ and ‘partly filled’ cargo compartments● By use of longitudinal divisions – these are required to be grain tight and
of an approved scantling.● By means of a saucer and bundling bulk – a saucer shape is constructed
of bulk bundles in the hatch square of a filled compartment. The depthof the saucer being established between 1.3 and 1.4 m depth dependenton the ships beam, below the deck line.
● By overstowing in a partly filled compartments – achieved by trimming thesurface level flat and covering with a separation cloth then tightly stowingbagged grain to a depth of one-sixteenth the depth of the free grain stow.
To ensure adequate stability● The angle of heeling of the vessel which arises from the assumed ‘shift of
grain’ must not exceed 12°.● When allowing for the assumed shift of grain, the dynamical stability
remaining, that is the residual resistance to rolling on the listed side, mustbe adequate.
● The initial GM, making full allowance for the free surface effect of allpartially filled tanks must be maintained at 0.3 m or more.
● The ship is to be upright at the time of proceeding to sea.
Fig. 4.11 Discharge of grain/cereals. The suckers from ‘grain elevators’discharge cereals contained in a ships bulk cargo hold from under the rolledback steel hatch covers. Men in the hold actively use the heel ropes to drag the
suctions into areas of cereal concentration.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 112
Bulk cargoes 113
Document of AuthorizationIn order to load grain, a vessel must have a Document of Authorization oran appropriate ‘Exemption Certificate’. The authorization means that thevessel has been surveyed and correct grain-loading information has beensupplied to the ship for use by the Deck Officer responsible.
Grain awarenessWhen a grain cargo is loaded, compartments will contain void spaces belowthe crown of the hatch top. During the voyage the grain will ‘settle’ and thesevoid spaces would be accentuated. In the event that the grain shifts, it willmove into these void spaces to one side or another generating an adverselist to the vessel and directly affecting the stability of the ship by reducingthe resistance to roll and adversely affecting the ‘Range of Stability’.
Measures to reduce the possibility of the grain shifting include the rig-ging of longitudinal shifting boards (Figure 4.12(a)), and overstowing thebulk cargo with bagged grain (Figure 4.12(b)).
(a)
(b)
Tarpaulins Bulk grain
3 tiers bagged grain Timber planks
Flexible steel wire stays
1 m min
Timber support
Grain surface
Timber brace
Shifting boards
Fig. 4.12 Cargo hold. (a) Longitudinal separation and (b) overstowing bulk cargo with bagged cargo.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 113
114 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Trimming of bulk cargoesMany bulk cargoes are trimmed (levelled) at the loading port to provide astable stowage for when the ship is at sea. However, trimming also takesplace during the period of discharge to ensure that the total volume ofcargo is landed (Figure 4.13).
Permissible grain heeling moment tablesThe purpose of the tables is to allow the Ship’s Master to ascertain whetheror not a particular grain stowage condition will achieve the required stabilitycriteria.
The obtained values can then be applied to acquire the approximateangle of heel which would result from a possible shift of the grain cargo.
Actual grain heeling moment � Total volumetric heeling momentSF
SF (bulk) � 1.20/1.67 m3/ tonne
Approximate angle of heel � 12° � Actual heeling moment
Permissible heeling moment
For a ship to be authorized to carry grain, the surveyor will have madecalculations for sample cargoes to show that adequate stability for the ship
Fig. 4.13 A tractor is engaged in the tween deck of a vessel dischargingcereals, to ensure that the suction of the grain elevator has access to all residuals
of the cargo product.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 114
Bulk cargoes 115
exists. Agrain-loading information listing should be made in which the surveyorwould record all the dimensions of the carriage compartments and thenthese would be converted into potential heeling moments for when thespace is filled or partly filled.
The Deck Officer would be expected to make his own calculations beforethe intended voyage to take account of the type of grain being carried andits stowage factor. Account must also be taken for the condition of the shipat all stages of the voyage to ensure adequate stability throughout.
Coal – loading, carriage and discharge
Categories of coalCoal – any coal, including sized grades, small coal, coal duff, coal slurry oranthracite.Coal duff – coal with an upper size of 7 mm.Coal slurry – coal with particles generally under 1 mm in size.Coke – solid residue from the distillation of coal or petroleum.Small coal – sufficient particle material below 7 mm to exhibit a flow statewhen saturated with water.
The characteristics of coalCoal cargoes are liable to spontaneous heating, especially when sufficientoxygen is available to generate combustion. The amount of heating thattakes place will depend on the type of coal being carried, and the ability todisperse that heat with effective ventilation methods. Unfortunately, venti-lation can work against the safe carriage because of supplying unwantedoxygen, while at the same time dispersing the heat concentrations. It is rec-ommended that surface ventilation only is applied to coal cargoes. This canbe applied by raising the hatch tops (weather permitting) to allow surfaceair and released gases to go to atmosphere and not be allowed to build upinside the cargo compartment.
Freshly mined coal absorbs oxygen which, with extrinsic moisture, formsperoxides. These in turn break down to form carbon monoxide and carbondioxide. Heat is produced and this exothermic reaction causes further oxidation and further heat. If this heat is not dissipated, ignition will occur,e.g. spontaneous combustion.
Large coal gives a good ventilation path for air flow towards surface ven-tilation methods, while small coal tends to retain the oxygen content and ismore likely to generate spontaneous combustion.
Preparation of the holds should include the overall cleaning of the holdprior to loading, the testing of the bilge suctions and sealing the bilge baysto prevent coal dust clogging bilge bays. Spar ceiling (cargo battens) shouldalso be removed as these would have a tendency to harbour oxygen pocketsdeep into the heart of the stow. Hold thermometers should be rigged at
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 115
116 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
three different levels, to ensure tight monitoring of the temperatures in thecompartments loaded with coal. Critical temperatures in coal vary, butheating will be accelerated in some varieties of coal from as low as 38°C(100°F). Such temperatures would create a need to keep external hull anddeck surfaces as cool as possible. In the tropics, it may be appropriate tocover decks to lessen the internal heating in the compartment.
Coal firesMost coal fires occur at about the tween deck level which is an area thatrequires more attention to temperature monitoring and to ventilation.
Surface ventilation to holds should be concerned with the removal of gasfor the first 5 days of the voyage, thereafter the ventilators to the lowerholds should be plugged with an exception for about 6 h every 2 days. Gasfrom the holds or tween deck regions may find its way into trunk sections,shaft tunnels, chain lockers, peaks and casings unless bulkheads can bemaintained in a gas-tight condition.
Note: A strict policy of no naked lights and no smoking should be followed and crewshould not be engaged in chipping or painting below decks.
The majority of coal fires are caused by spontaneous combustion. Poorhatch cleaning prior to loading and a lack of temperature monitoring areoften directly linked to the cause. In the event of a coal fire at sea, it shouldbe realized that these are extremely hot fires and if tackled with waterwould generate copious amounts of steam. Unless this can be vented, thecompartments could become pressurized.
If tackled from sea, it is recommended that hatches are battened downand all ventilation to the compartment sealed with the view to starving thefire of oxygen. A Port of Refuge should be sort, where the authorities can beinformed to receive the vessel and dig the fire out by grabs while fire-fightersare stood by to tackle the blaze once exposed.
Loading coalCoal is loaded by either tipping or conveyor belt, bucket system. It is recommended that the first few truck loads are lowered to the holds, thisreduces breakage as does a control rate of the chutes. Loading may takeplace from a single-loading dispenser and, as such, it may become neces-sary to shift the ship to permit all compartments to be loaded. A loadingplan to prevent undue stresses and minimum ship movements would nor-mally be devised. Coal will need to be trimmed as its ‘angle of repose’ isquite high, especially for large coal.
Small coal like ‘mud coal’, ‘slurry’ or ‘duff’ is liable to shift, but shiftingis unlikely in large coal.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 116
Bulk cargoes 117
Reference should be made to the Code of Safe Working Practice (CSWP) forBulk Cargoes prior to loading any of the coal types. Information on dry bulkcargoes is given under the heading of ‘ores and similar cargoes’ and infor-mation on wet bulk cargoes is given under the heading of ‘ore concentrates’.
CokeCoke and similar substances such as ‘coalite’ have had their gas and ben-zole removed and they do not heat spontaneously. No special precautionsare necessary other than to ensure that the coke is cold before loading. If hotcoke is loaded this may generate a fire.
The precautions of loading coalThe IMO divides coal into several categories:
Category A – no riskCategory B – flammable gas riskCategory C – spontaneous heating riskCategory D – both risks.
Although precautions are given to each category, the following general precautions are recommended.
1. Gas-tight bulkheads and decks.2. Spar ceiling (cargo battens) removed.3. Measures taken to prevent gas accumulating in adjacent compartments.4. Intrinsically safe electrical equipment inside compartments.5. Cargo stowed away from high temperature areas and machinery bulk-
heads.6. Gas detection equipment on board.7. Trim cargo level to gain maximum benefits from surface ventilation.8. Cargo/hatch temperatures monitored at regular intervals.9. No naked flame or sparking equipment in or around cargo hatches.
10. No welding, or smoking permitted in the area of cargo hatches.11. Full precautions taken for entry into enclosed compartments carrying
coal.12. Suitable surface ventilation procedures adopted as and when weather
permits.
Note: Certain coal cargoes of small particle content are liable to shift if wet, and experi-ence liquefaction hazards. Reference to the IMO Code of Solid Bulk Cargoes should bemade and appropriate precautions taken.
Iron and steel cargoesSteelwork is carried in various forms, notably as pig iron, steel billets,round bars, pipes, castings, railway iron, ‘H’ girders, steel coils, scrap metalor iron and steel swarf.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 117
It is without doubt one of the most dangerous of cargoes worked and car-ried at sea. Recommendations for stowage have been made by variousMerchant Shipping Notice (MSNs) and Marine Guidance Notice (MGNs)in the past and yet it is still prone to ‘shifting’ in a rough sea condition.
Pig iron – if pig iron or billets are taken, they should be levelled and largequantities should not be carried in tween deck spaces. A preferred stow isto level in lower hold spaces and overstow by other suitable cargoes.
If it has to be carried in tween deck spaces the maximum height to whichit can be stowed should not exceed 0.22 � the height of the tween deck space.
Pig iron should be trimmed and stowed level in both tween deck andhold spaces in either a side to side or fore and aft stow. If it is not effectivelyoverstowed it should be stowed in robust ‘bins’, with suitable shiftingboards to prevent cargo movement. It is recommended that gloss finishedpig iron is always stowed on wood ceiling or dunnage, to reduce steel-to-steel friction.
Round bars and pipes – should preferably be stowed in the lower hold com-partments and levelled off. Securing should be in the form of strong crosswires over the top of the stow and secure ‘toms’ at the sides. Suitable car-goes can overstow this type of steelwork.
Railway iron, ‘H’ girders, long steel on the round – should be stowed in a foreand aft direction, and packed as solidly as possible. If left exposed and notoverstowed, chain lashings should be secured to prevent cargo shift.
Iron and steel swarf – this may heat to dangerous levels while in transit, if theswarf is wet and contaminated with cutting oils. The carriage of ‘swarf’requires that surface temperatures of the cargo are monitored at regularintervals during the loading process and whilst on the voyage. If, duringloading, the temperature of an area is noted as 48°C (120°F), loading shouldbe temporarily suspended until a distinct fall is observed. In the event thata temperature of 38°C is observed on passage, gentle raking the swarf sur-face area in the region of the high temperature, to a depth of about 0.3 mshould cause the temperature to lower. If a temperature of 65°C is noted,the ship is recommended to make for the nearest port.
Scrap metal – similar problems to other steel cargoes in that it is very heavy.It is generally loaded by elevator/conveyor or grabs and usually dis-charged by mechanical grabs. When loading, the first few loads are oftenlowered into the hold to prevent the possibility of excessive damage toship’s structures.
Scrap metal tends to come in all shapes and sizes. As such, wheremechanical grabs are engaged, metal pieces frequently become dislodgedfrom the grab when in transit from the hold to the shore, while dischargingor loading. Deck Officers should ensure that the working area is cordonedoff and personnel on the deck area should wear hard hats and observecargo operations from a safe distance.
118 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 118
Bulk cargoes 119
Steel coils – steel coils are stowed on the round and are frequently carried inthe cargo holds of ‘bulk carriers’ (see Chapter 3). The overall stow is securedby steel wire and bottle screw lashings. The sides of the stow are generallychocked tight, against the ship’s side, if broken stowage is a feature of thecargo.
Steel coils are classed as a heavy cargo, and would be levelled to no morethan two tiers in height. Individually, a coil may weigh up to 10 tonnes, andthey are frequently treated as ‘heavy lifts’. They are prone to shifting, beingstowed on the round, if the vessel encountered rough weather. Passageplans should bear this in mind and chart a ‘Port of Refuge’ in case such acontingency is required.
Ores – mostly of a low stowage factor, which means that when a full cargoof ore is loaded, there will be a large volume of the hold left unused. A lowstowage factor also lends itself to a ‘stiff ship’, unless some of the cargo canbe loaded in the higher regions of the vessel.
Ore should be trimmed if possible and, at the very least, the top of theheap should be knocked off. Modern bulk carrier hold design compensatesin some way towards a cargo which is likely to shift. Other vessel designshave been developed as designated ore carriers, and have effective upperballast compartments to raise the vessel’s centre of gravity, when carryingdedicated heavy ore cargoes. In the event that an ore cargo is only a ‘partcargo’ it should be realized that some ores have a high moisture contentwhich does not always lend to overstowing.
Example ore cargoes: bauxite, chrome, iron, lead and manganese.
Use of mechanical grabsMany types of bulk cargoes are discharged by means of ‘mechanical grabs’,of which there are several variations. The handling of grabs is always pre-carious – especially the larger 5 tonne plus, capacity grabs – because they arenot exactly controlled and may incur structural damage to the vessel.
Cargoes tend to be loaded by chute, tipping or pouring, especially thegrain type cargoes, ores and coals. However, discharging of ores, bulksolids and the coal cargoes tend to employ grabs for discharge purpose.Bucket grabs coming in various sizes ranging from 2 to 10 tonnes, but themore popular range being in the 4–5 tonne bucket (manual labour for bulkcommodity discharge has all but died out) (Figure 4.14).
Cargo Officers are advised that working with heavy grabs requires des-ignated concentration by the crane drivers and even then ship damage isnot unusual. A close check on the operation of grabs throughout load/dis-charge operations is advised and any damage to the ship’s structure bycontact of the grabs should be reported to the Chief Officer of the vessel.Subsequent damage claims can then be made against the stevedores for rele-vant repair costs. Bearing in mind that damage to hatch coamings may ren-der the vessel unseaworthy if the damage prevents the closure of hatchesand cannot be repaired, before the time of sailing.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 119
120 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 4.14 Bucket mechanical grab seen in the open position on the quayside.The crane is configured so that the controlling crane driver can open and shut the grab by means of an operational wire to open and close the bucket
arrangement.
General information on the loading/discharge of steel cargoesSteel cargoes in any form are probably one of, if not, the most dangerouscargoes. Steel comes in many forms, from railway lines to ingots, from bulkscrap to bulldozers, etc. It is invariably always heavy and very often diffi-cult to control because of its size. It is a regular cargo for many ships andhas been known to cause many problems by way of stability, or adverseeffects to the magnetic compass. If steel shifts at sea, due to bad weather, itis unlikely that the crew would have the skills or the facilities to rectify thesituation and the vessel would probably need to seek a ‘Port of Refuge’with the view to corrective stowage, e.g. steel coils, on the round are particularly notorious for moving in bad weather.
During the loading period, an active Cargo Officer can ensure that cor-rect stowage is achieved and even more important that correct securing isput in place. Relevant numbers of chain lashings and strong timber bearersgo well with steel loads, but are often required before the load becomesoverstowed by light goods.
Masters should monitor progress during loading periods without beingseen to interfere with the Cargo Officer’s duties. Specific attention should
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 120
Bulk cargoes 121
be given to the use of rigging gangs being employed as and when required.An awareness of the needs of industrial relations without sacrificing thesafety requirements can be a delicate balance when a load needs 20 secur-ings and dock labour only wants to secure with 10.
Damage to the vessel when loading or discharging heavy steelwork isnot unusual. Heavy lifts by way of bulldozers or locomotives requireadvance planning and a slow operation. They are awkward to manoeuvrebecause of either width, length or both. Heavy rig lifting gear operated byship or shore authorities, even when taking all precautions, very oftenresults in damaged hatch coamings or buckled deck plates. The possibilityof damage to the cargo itself is also a likely occurrence.
‘H’ or ‘T’ section steel girders are difficult to control because of lengthand are normally loaded on the diagonal into a hatchway. Slinging is nor-mally by long-leg chains but high winds when loading can cause excessiveoscillations of the load, especially with deep sections. Steadying lines ofadequate size should be employed before lifting. High winds also poseproblems for the lighter steel boilers. These are large but comparativelylight, being hollow. Size and shape coupled with strong winds tend tocause slewing on the load in way of the hatch coaming.
Steel in any form will always be shipped and it is in the interests of allconcerned to ensure safe handling and stowage. Masters tend to be wary ofthe stability needs and load in lower holds rather than tween decks depend-ing on circumstances and the needs of other cargoes. However, the need forvigilance when securing remains a high priority towards voyage safety.
Bulk cargo examplesConcentrates – are partially washed or concentrated ores. These cargoesare usually powdery in form and liable to have a high moisture content,and subsequently, under certain conditions, have a tendency to behavealmost as a liquid. Special stowage conditions prevail, and sampling musttake place to ascertain the transportable moisture limit as provided by theCSWP for Bulk Cargoes.
They are extremely liable to shifting, and care should be taken whenloading. Some cargoes may appear to be in a relatively dry condition whenloading, but at the same time, contain sufficient moisture to become fluidwith the movement and vibrations of the vessel when at sea.
Nitrates – are considered dangerous cargoes. Before stowing, the Inter-national Maritime Dangerous Goods (IMDG) Code on dangerous goodsshould be consulted.
Phosphates – readily absorb water and should be kept dry. A variety of theseis Guano which is collected from islands in the Pacific. Phosphates shouldbe kept clear of foodstuffs.
Sulphur – is a highly inflammable cargo and all anti-fire precautions shouldbe taken.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 121
It is also very dusty and highly corrosive. The risk of dust explosionswhen clearing holds after carriage is of concern. Fires occurring in sulphurcargoes are smothered by use of more sulphur. Personnel should be issuedwith personnel protection equipment when loading or discharging a sul-phur cargo, i.e. masks and goggles.
Nuts – tend to have a high oil content and they are liable to heat anddeterioration. They should be kept dry. Precautions should be taken toprevent shifting, as per the grain rules.
Copra – is dried coconut flesh mainly from Malaysia. It is liable to sponta-neous heating and is highly inflammable. It is suggested that cargo ther-mometers are rigged to monitor temperatures in the bulk. Tight anti-fireregulations should prevail around the cargo spaces, to include sparkarrester gauze in place on ventilator apertures. The cargo should be keptdry and kept clear of surfaces that are liable to ‘sweat’. Matting is recom-mended to cover the ship’s steelwork for this purpose.
Salt – has a high moisture content which is likely to evaporate and drygoods should not be stowed in close proximity. Prior to loading, the spacesshould be clean and dry. The steelwork may be whitewashed and separa-tion cloths may be used to keep salt off the ship’s structures.
Sugar – vessels have been specifically built for the bulk sugar trade. Theyare of a similar construction to those of the bulk ore carrier. This is not tosay that bulk sugar cannot be carried in any other general type cargo ves-sel. In any event the compartments should be thoroughly cleaned out andthe bilge bays made sugar tight. Bulk sugar must be kept dry. If water isallowed to enter by any means it would solidify the cargo and result in theproduct being condemned.
Main hazards of loading/shipping/dischargingbulk cargoesDry shift of cargo – is caused by a low angle of repose and can be avoided bytrimming level or the use of shifting boards.
Wet shift of cargo – is caused by liquefaction of the cargo possibly due tomoisture migration causing the cargo to act like a liquid, the moisture con-tent of the product probably being below the transportable moisture limit.
Oxidation – the removal of oxygen from the cargo compartment by the typeand nature of the cargo, ventilation being required before entry into thecompartment.
Flammable/explosive gas/dust – the nature of the cargo has a high risk andmay be of a highly inflammable nature, or give off explosive gases. Dustycargoes also run the risk of a dust explosion of the atmosphere inside thecompartment.
122 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 122
Toxic gas or dust – identified toxic effects from products may well requirepersonnel to wear protective clothing and masking/breathing equipmentwhen in proximity of the product.
Corrosive elements (e.g. sulphur) – personnel will require protective clothing,and eye protective wear. High fire risk.
Spontaneous combustion – a self-heating cargo which needs to be monitoredby the use of cargo and hatch thermometers throughout the period of thevoyage. It should be stowed clear of machinery space bulkheads and pro-vided with recommended ventilation where appropriate (e.g. coal surfaceventilation).
Reaction cargoes – products that may react with other cargoes, and as suchmay require separate stowage compartments.
High density cargoes – may cause structural damage to the vessel and posestability problems from the position of stow. Could well affect bending andshear force stress effects on the hull.
Infectious cargoes (e.g. Guano) – exposed personnel would require personalprotection inclusive of respirators.
Structural damage – through excessive bending and shear forces caused bypoor distribution of and/or inadequate trimming of certain cargoes, or sail-ing with partly filled holds or empty holds.
Bulk cargoes 123
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 123
124 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
MARINE GUIDANCE NOTEMGN 108 (M)
Hull Stress Monitoring SystemsNotice to Shipowners, Ship Operators, Charterers and Managers; Ships’Masters, Ships’ Officers, Engineers, Surveyors and Manufacturers of HullStress Monitoring Systems.
1. The International Maritime Organization (IMO) recommends the fittingof hull stress monitoring systems to facilitate the safe operation of shipscarrying dry cargo in bulk. Use of the system will provide the Mastersand Officers of the Ship with real-time information on the motions andglobal stress the ship experiences while navigating, and during loadingand unloading operations. The IMO recommendations are published inthe Maritime Safety Committee Circular, MSC/Circ. 646, which isannexed to this Marine Guidance Note.
2. The Maritime and Coastguard Agency (MCA) supports the IMO’s rec-ommendations, and invites owners to fit hull stress monitoring systemson bulk carriers of 20 000 dwt and above. Consideration should also begiven to fitting such systems to other types of ship.
3. The MCA requests all parties to return information on the reliability ofhull stress monitoring systems, their performance relative to the actualand predicted stress levels, their application to other types and sizes ofships and any other relevant experience gained in the use of such sys-tems. Such information should be returned to the Ship ConstructionDivision Section quoting reference MS070/014/0007. This informationwill be used to inform future deliberations at the IMO, which mayinclude the development of performance standards.
4. The IMO’s recommendations call for the hardware and software of the hullstress monitoring system to be approved by the administration. In thisrespect, the MCA will accept type approval certification of compliancewith MSC/Circ. 646, which has been issued by one of the Nominated
Summary● Recommendation for the fitting of hull stress monitoring systems on
bulk carriers of 20 000 dwt and above.● Arrangements for type approval of hull stress monitoring systems.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 124
Bulk cargoes 125
Bodies, listed in Table A of the Annex to MSN No. M.1645 “Type Approvalof Marine Equipment”, who are authorized to examine, test and certifyequipment. The terms of M.1645 shall apply. The type approval of hullstress monitoring systems will be included in the next revision of M.1645.
5. Since the adoption of MSC/Circ. 646 in 1994, the design of hull stress mon-itoring systems has developed and some of the Nominated Bodies aredeveloping standards for such systems. Such development is beneficialand to be encouraged. Consequently, the MCA will accept type approvalcertification which has been issued by one of the Nominated Bodies inaccordance with its published standards or rules, provided that any devia-tion from MSC/Circ. 646 is recorded on the certificate and notified to theMCA.
6. In designing hull stress monitoring systems, consideration should begiven to the IMO Performance Standards for Shipborne Voyage DataRecorders (VDRs), published as Resolution A.861 (2O). Paragraph 5.4.14of this standard states:
‘5.4.14 Accelerations and hull stressesWhere a ship is fitted with hull stress and response monitoring equip-ment, all the data items that have been pre-selected within that equip-ment should be recorded’
Owners are invited to ensure that hull stress monitoring equipment iscompatible with the VDR fitted and that all monitored data can be trans-mitted to the VDR.
7. Approval of the hardware and software of the hull stress monitoringsystem is the first stage but it is essential that the assigning authority forthe International Loadline Certificate be consulted regarding the instal-lation of the hull stress monitoring system and the determination ofmaximum permissible stresses and accelerations. They will also need tobe consulted over the frequency of system verification, taking accountof the manufacturer’s recommendations.
8. Further information on this note may be obtained from:
Maritime and Coastguard Agency, Spring Place, 105, CommercialRoad, SOUTHAMPTON, UK, SO15 lEG. 01703329100 (Tel), 01703 329204 (Fax)
Additional reading and references for bulk cargoesMGN 144 (M) The Merchant Shipping (Additional Safety Measures forBulk Carriers), Regulations 1999.
S.I. 1999, No. 336, The Merchant Shipping (Carriage of Cargoes), Regulations1999.
Chap-04.qxd 3/3/05 12:25 PM Page 125
Chapter 5
Tanker cargoes
IntroductionAt the present time modern civilization is largely dependent on oil and itsby-products. Vast quantities of liquid products are transported by tankersthroughout the world and, as such they have a high profile in the eyes ofthe general public. However, it should be realized from the outset that notall tankers are in the oil trade. Many transport wine or liquid chemicals, or liquid natural gas (LNG), but generally the tanker vessel is synonymouswith the carriage of bulk oil or oil-based products.
Concern for the environment, associated with tanker traffic, has becomea number one priority in the anti-pollution campaign and rightly so (Figure5.1). The marine industry must respect the environment and the well-beingof the planet in which we all exist. To this end the Maritime Pollution(MARPOL) convention has gone some way to establishing standards of oiloperations around the globe.
Fig. 5.1 A tanker approaches a single buoy mooring (SBM) and prepares to pick up the floating oil pipe with the assistance of local tenders.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:42 AM Page 126
Tanker cargoes 127
The main concern with the demands of a modern society has alwaysbeen the costs of pollution scaled against societies’ needs for oil. Those coun-tries that have it need to go to market to strengthen national economy. Whilethose that are without oil need to import to strengthen their economy. Clearly,an endless circle of world economics. Unfortunately, the tanker accident is not unheard of, e.g. the ‘Amoco Cadiz’, the ‘Torrey Canyon’, the ‘ExxonValdez’ and the ‘Sea Empress’ are hard examples to live with.
Our seafarers must be educated – not only to the public outrage that accom-panies poor seamanship which generates most modern-day accidents, butalso to the ways that prevent such catastrophes happening in the first place.The training of all our seafarers, especially tanker, personnel is an aspect ofthe marine industry which must take precedence within an industry whichcontinues to drill for oil in the deepest and most remote quarters of the earth.
Definitions for use(within the understanding of MARPOL) and tanker operations (gas andchemical)
Administration – the Government of the State under whose authority theship is operating.
Associated piping – the pipeline from the suction point in a cargo tank to theshore connection used for unloading the cargo and includes all the ship’spiping, pumps and filters which are in open connection with the cargounloading line.
Bulk Chemical Code – the Code for the Construction and Equipment of ShipsCarrying Dangerous Chemicals in Bulk (ships must have a Certificate ofFitness for the carriage of dangerous chemicals).
Cargo area – that part of a ship which contains cargo spaces, slop tanks andpump rooms, cofferdams, ballast and void spaces adjacent to cargo tanksand also deck areas throughout the length and breadth of the part of theship over such spaces.
Centre tank – any tank inboard of a longitudinal bulkhead.
Chemical tanker – a ship constructed or adapted primarily to carry a cargo ofnoxious liquid substances (NLS) in bulk and includes an oil tanker as definedby Annex 1 of MARPOL, when carrying a cargo or part cargo of NLS inbulk (see also Tanker).
Clean ballast – ballast carried in a tank which, since it was last used to carrycargo containing a substance in Category A, B, C or D, has been thoroughlycleaned and the residues resulting therefrom have been discharged and thetank emptied in accord with Annex II, of MARPOL.
Cofferdam – an isolating space between two adjacent steel bulkheads ordecks. This space may be a void space or a ballast space.
Combination carrier – a ship designed to carry either oil or solid cargoes in bulk.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:42 AM Page 127
128 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Continuous feeding – defined as the process whereby waste is fed into a com-bustion chamber without human assistance while the incinerator is in normaloperating condition with the combustion chamber operative temperaturebetween 850°C and 1200°C.
Critical structural areas – locations which have been identified from calcula-tions to require monitoring or from service history of the subject ship orfrom similar or sister ships to be sensitive to cracking, buckling or corrosion,which would impair the structural integrity of the ship.
Crude oil – any liquid hydrocarbon mixture occurring naturally in the earthwhether or not treated to render it suitable for transportation and includes:(a) crude oil from which certain distillate fractions may have been removedand (b) crude oil to which certain distillate fractions may have been added.
Dedicated ship – a ship built or converted and specifically fitted and certifiedfor the carriage of: (a) one named product and (b) a restricted number ofproducts each in a tank or group of tanks such that each tank or group of tanksis certified for one named product only or compatible products not requir-ing cargo tank washing for change of cargo.
Domestic trade – a trade solely between ports or terminals within the flagstate of which the ship is entitled to fly, without entering into the territorialwaters of other states.
Discharge – in relation to harmful substances or effluent containing suchsubstances means any release howsoever caused from a ship and includesany escape, disposal, spilling, leaking, pumping, emitting or emptying.
Emission – any release of substance subject to control by the Annex VI, fromships into the atmosphere or sea.
Flammability limits – the conditions defining the state of fuel oxidant mix-ture at which application of an adequately strong external ignition source isonly just capable of producing flammability in a given test apparatus.
Flammable products – are those identified by an ‘F’ in column ‘F’ of the tablein Chapter 19 of the International Gas Code for ships carrying liquefiedgases in bulk (IGC).
Flash point (of an oil) – this is the lowest temperature at which the oil willgive off vapour in quantities that, when mixed with air in certain proportions,are sufficient to create an explosive gas.
Garbage – all kinds of victual, domestic and operational waste, excluding freshfish and parts thereof, generated during the normal operation of the ship andliable to be disposed of continuously or periodically, except those substancesthat are defined or listed in other Annexes to the present convention.
Gas carrier – is a cargo ship constructed or adapted and used for the carriagein bulk of any liquefied gas or other products listed in the table of Chapter19 of the IGC Code.
Good condition – a coating condition with only minor spot rusting.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:42 AM Page 128
Tanker cargoes 129
Harmful substance – any substance that, if introduced into the sea, is liable tocreate hazards to human health, to harm living resources and marine life, todamage amenities or to interfere with legitimate use of the sea, andincludes any substance subject to control by the present convention.
Hold space – is the space enclosed by the ship’s structure in which a cargocontainment system is situated.
Holding tank – a tank used for the collection and storage of sewage.
IBC Code Certificate – refers to an International Certificate of Fitness for theCarriage of Dangerous Chemicals in Bulk, which certifies compliance withthe requirements of the International Bulk Cargo (IBC) Code.
IGC Code – refers to the International Code for the Construction andEquipment of Ships Carrying Liquefied Gases in Bulk.
Ignition point (of an oil) – this is defined by the temperature to which an oilmust be raised before its surface layers will ignite and continue to burn.
Incident – any event involving the actual or probable discharge into the seaof harmful substance, or effluents containing such a substance.
Instantaneous rate of discharge of oil content – the rate of discharge of oil inlitres per hour at any instant divided by the speed of the ship in knots at thesame instant.
International trade – a trade which is not a domestic trade as defined above.
Liquid substances – are those having a vapour pressure not exceeding2.8 kPa/cm2 when at a temperature of 37.8°C.
MARVS – is the maximum allowable relief valve setting of a cargo tank.
Miscible – soluble with water in all proportions at wash water temperatures.
NLS Certificate – an international Pollution Prevention Certificate for theCarriage of Noxious Liquid Substances in Bulk, which certifies compliancewith Annex II, MARPOL.
Noxious liquid substance – any substance referred to in Appendix II of Annex IIof MARPOL. Or, provisionally, assessed under the provisions of Regulation3(4) as falling into Category A, B, C or D.
NOx Technical Code – the Technical Code on Control of Emission of NitrogenOxides from Marine Diesel Engines, adopted by the Conference, Resolution2 as may be amended by the Organization.
Oil – petroleum in any form, including crude oil, fuel oil, sludge oil refuseand refined products (other than petrochemicals which are subject to theprovisions of Annex II).
Oil fuel unit – is the equipment used for the preparation of oil fuel for deliveryto an oil fired boiler, or equipment used for the preparation for delivery ofheated oil to an internal combustion engine and includes any oil pressurepumps, filters and heaters with oil at a pressure of not more than 1.8 bar gauge.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:42 AM Page 129
130 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Oily mixture – a mixture with any oil content.
Oil tanker – a ship constructed or adapted primarily to carry oil in bulk in itscargo spaces and includes combination carriers and any ‘chemical tanker’as defined by Annex II, when it is carrying a cargo or part cargo of oil inbulk (Figure 5.2).
Fig. 5.2 Tanker structure. The ‘Jahre Viking’ at 564 000 dwt is the largest man-made transport in the world. It is seen manoeuvring with tugs off the DubaiDry Dock. The size and sophistication of the modern tanker has changedconsiderably over the decades. World economics have influenced the capacity,while legislation has changed all future construction into the double-hullcategory. This vessel has recently been converted to a floating oil storage unit
to prolong its active life.
Organization – the Inter-Governmental Maritime Consultative Organization.The International Maritime Organization (IMO).
Permissible exposure limit – an exposure limit which is published andenforced by the Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA) asa legal standard. It may be either time weighted average (TWA) exposurelimit (8 h) or a 15-min short-term exposure limit (STEL), or a ceiling (C).
Primary barrier – is the inner element designed to contain the cargo whenthe cargo containment system includes two boundaries.
Product carrier – an oil tanker engaged in the trade of carrying oil, other thancrude oil.
Residue – any NLS which remains for disposal.
Residue/water mixture – residue in which water has been added for any pur-pose (e.g. tank cleaning, ballasting and bilge slops).
Secondary barrier – the liquid resisting outer element of a cargo containmentsystem designated to afford temporary containment of any envisaged
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:42 AM Page 130
Tanker cargoes 131
leakage of liquid cargo through the primary barrier and to prevent the towering of temperature of the ship’s structure to an unsafe level.
Segregated ballast – that ballast water introduced into a tank which is com-pletely separated from the cargo oil and fuel oil system and which is permanently allocated to the carriage of ballast or to the carriage of ballastor cargoes other than oil or noxious substances.
Sewage – (a) drainage and other wastes from any form of toilet, urinals andWC scuppers; (b) drainage from medical premises (dispensary, sick bay,etc.) via wash basins, wash tubs and scuppers located in such premises; (c) drainage from spaces containing living animals and (d) other wastewaters when mixed with drainage as listed above.
Ship – a vessel of any type whatsoever operating in the marine environmentand includes hydrofoil boats, air cushion vehicles, submersibles, floatingcraft and fixed or floating platforms (Figure 5.3).
Fig. 5.3 Tanker approaches a floating storage unit (FSU). The pipeline-bearingboom of the FSU is seen in the vertical ready to be deployed once the tanker
vessel has moored and connected to the stern of the FSU.
Shipboard incinerator – a shipboard facility designed for the primary purposeof incineration.
Slop tank – a tank specifically designated for the collection of tank drainings,tank washings and other oily mixtures.
Sludge oil – sludge from the fuel or lubricating oil separators waste lubricat-ing oil from main or auxiliary machinery, or waste oil from bilge water sep-arators, oil filtering equipment or drip trays.
Oxides of sulphur (SOx) emission control area – an area where the adoption ofspecial mandatory measures for SOx emissions from ships is required toprevent, reduce and control air pollution from SOx and its attendant adverseimpacts on land and sea areas. SOx emission control areas shall includethose listed in Regulation 14 of Annex VI.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:42 AM Page 131
132 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Special area – a sea area where, for recognized technical reasons in relation toits oceanographical and ecological condition and to the particular characterof its traffic, the adoption of special mandatory methods for the preventionof sea pollution by oil is required. Special areas include Mediterranean Sea,Baltic Sea, Black Sea, Red Sea, Gulf Area, Gulf of Aden, North Sea, EnglishChannel and its approaches, The Wider Caribbean Region and Antarctica.
Substantial corrosion – an extent of corrosion such that the assessment of thecorrosion pattern indicates wastage in excess of 75% of the allowable margins, but within acceptable limits.
Suspect areas – are locations showing substantial corrosion and/or are considered by the attending surveyor to be prone to rapid wastage.
Tank – an enclosed space which is formed by the permanent structure of theship and which is designed for the carriage of liquid in bulk.
Tank cover – the protective structure intended to protect the cargo contain-ment system against damage where it protrudes through the weather deckor to ensure the continuity and integrity of the deck structure.
Tank dome – the upward extension of a position of a cargo tank. In the caseof below deck cargo containment system the tank dome protrudes throughthe weather deck or through a tank covering.
Tanker – an oil tanker as defined by the Regulation 1(4) of Annex 1, or achemical tanker as defined in Regulation 1(1) of Annex II of the presentconvention (Figure 5.4).
Length between perpendiculars
FP.AP.
Beam
Double hulll design example for deadweight of 150 000 dwt
Cargo
Ballast
Fig. 5.4 The design of the oil tanker.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:42 AM Page 132
Tanker cargoes 133
Threshold limit value (TLV) – airborne concentrations of substances devised bythe American Conference of Government Industrial Hygienists (ACGIH).Representative of conditions under which it is believed that nearly allworkers may be exposed day after day with no adverse effects. There arethree different types of TLV, TWA, STEL and C. Note: TLVs are advisoryexposure guidelines, not legal standards and are based on evidence fromindustrial experience and research studies.
Time weighted average (TWA) – that average time over a given work period(e.g. 8 h working day) of a person’s exposure to a chemical or an agent. Theaverage is determined by sampling for the containment throughout thetime period and represented by TLV � TWA.
Toxic products – are those identified by a ‘T’ in column ‘F’ in the table ofChapter 19 of the IGC Code.
Ullage – that measured distance between the surface of the liquid in a tankand the underside decking of the tank.
Vapour pressure – the equilibrium pressure of the saturated vapour abovethe liquid expressed in bars absolute, at a specified temperature.
Void space – an enclosed space in the cargo area external to a cargo contain-ment system, other than a hold space, ballast space, fuel oil tank, cargopump or compressor room, or any space in normal use by personnel.
Volatile liquid – a liquid which is so termed is one which has a tendency toevaporate quickly and has a flash point of less than 60°C.
Wing tank – any tank which is adjacent to the side shell plating.
Equipment regulation requirementsTankers now require:
● Cargo tank pressure monitoring systems required under Safety of Life atSea (SOLAS) II-2 Regulation 59/IBC Code, Chapter 8.3.3 to be fitted afterthe first dry docking after 1 July between 1998 and 2002. New build vessels would be similarly equipped.
● Cargo pump bearing temperature monitoring systems must be fitted under SOLAS II-2, Regulations 4 and 5.10.1 at the next dry docking after1 July 2002.
● Cargo pump gas detection/bilge alarm systems are now required underSOLAS II-2, Regulations 4 and 5.10.3/5.10.4 at the next dry docking after1 July 2002.
● High level and overfill alarm system is now required under United StatesCoast Guard (USCG) Regulation 39.
● Emergency escape breathing devices (EEBDs) are now required underSOLAS II-2, Regulation 13.3.4 by the first survey after 1 July 2002.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:42 AM Page 133
134 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Double-hull tanker constructionTankers were generally constructed with either centre tanks and wingtanks dividing the vessel into three athwartships sections, by two longitu-dinal bulkheads, individual tanks being segregated by transverse bulk-heads. Modern construction, which integrates the double hull, has meantthat construction designs have changed and twin tanks are now positionedto either side of a centre line bulkhead (Figure 5.5).
Fig. 5.5 Athwartships cross-section of the modern double-hull tanker seen at a late construction stage prior to assembly.
The maximum length of an oil tank is 20% L (L represents the ship’slength) and there is at least one wash bulkhead if the length of the tankexceeds 10% L or 15 m. It should be appreciated that in a large tanker of 300 mlength and 30 m beam and equivalent depth, each tank would have a capacity for over 20 000 tonnes of oil.
Tanks are usually numbered from forward to aft with pump rooms usu-ally situated aft so that power can be easily linked direct from the engineroom. Pipeline systems providing flexibility in loading/discharging inter-connecting the tanks to the pumping arrangement.
Tanker pipelinesThere are three basic types of pipeline systems:
1. Direct system2. Ring main system3. Free flow system.
Each system has their uses and is designed to fulfil a need in a particulartype of vessel.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:42 AM Page 134
Tanker cargoes 135
The direct systemThis is the simplest type of pipeline system which uses fewer valves thanthe others. It takes oil directly from the tank to the pump and so reducesfriction. This has an affect of increasing the rate of discharge, at the sametime improving the tank suction. It is cheaper to install and maintain thanthe ring main system because there is less pipeline length and with fewervalves less likelihood of malfunction. However, the layout is not as versa-tile as a ring main system and problems in the event of faulty valves orleaking pipelines could prove more difficult to circumvent. Also, the wash-ing is more difficult since there is no circular system and the washings mustbe flushed into the tanks Figure 5.6.
5 4 3 2 1 Tanks
Sea suction
Key for pipeline diagrams
PipelineValve Sea suction
Pump
Bulkhead gate valves
Fig. 5.6 Direct line system. Used mainly on crude and black oil tankers where separation of oil grades is not so important.
The advantages are that:
1. it is easy to operate and less training of personnel is required2. as there are fewer valves it takes less time to set up the valve system
before commencing a cargo operation3. contamination is unlikely, as it is easy to isolate each section.
The disadvantages are that:
1. it is a very inflexible system which makes it difficult to plan for a multi-port discharge
2. block stowage has to be used which makes it difficult to control ‘trim’3. carrying more than three parcels concurrently can be difficult.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:42 AM Page 135
136 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
The ring main systemThis is basically a ring from the pump room around the ship, with crossoverlines at each set of tanks. There are various designs usually involving morethan one ring. It is extensively employed on ‘product tankers’ where thesystem allows many grades of cargo to be carried without contamination.This is a highly versatile system which permits several different combin-ations of pump and line for any particular tank (Figure 5.7).
Tanks
Sea suction
5 4 3 2 1
Manifoldconnections
Fig. 5.7 Ring main system. Pump room aft.
The advantages of the system are that:
1. cargoes can be more easily split into smaller units and placed in variousparts of the ship
2. line washing is more complete3. a greater number of different parcels of cargo can be carried4. trim and stress can be more easily controlled.
The disadvantages are that:
1. because of the more complicated pipeline and valve layout, better train-ing in cargo separation is required
2. contamination is far more likely if valves are incorrectly set3. fairly low pumping rates are achieved4. costs of installation and maintenance are higher because of more pipe-
line and an increased number of valves.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:42 AM Page 136
Tanker cargoes 137
The free flow systemThe ‘free flow system’ employs sluice valves in the tank bulkheads rather thanpipelines. With a stern trim this system can discharge all the cargo from theaftermost tank via direct lines to the pump room. The result is that a very highspeed of discharge can be achieved and as such is suitable for large crude car-riers with a single grade cargo. Tank drainage is also very efficient since thebulkhead valves allow the oil to flow aft easily. There are fewer tanks with thissystem and it has increased numbers of sluice valves the farther aft you go.The increased number of sluices is a feature to handle the increased volumebeing allowed to pass from one tank to another (Figure 5.8).
Tanks 4 3 2 1
Sea suction
Manifoldconnections
Fig. 5.8 The free flow system.
The main advantage is that a very high rate of discharge is possible withfew pipelines and limited losses to friction. The main disadvantage is thatoverflows are possible if the cargo levels in all tanks are not carefully monitored (Figures 5.9, 5.10 and 5.11).
Measurement of liquid cargoesThe volume of oil in a tank is ascertained by measuring the distance from afixed point on the deck to the surface of the oil. The distance is known asthe ‘ullage’ and is usually measured by means of a plastic tape. A set of tablesis supplied to every ship, which indicate for each cargo compartment, thevolume of liquid corresponding to a range of ullage measurements. The
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:42 AM Page 137
Fig. 5.9 Tanker deck arrangement. Typical example of the pipeline (fore deck) arrangement of a medium size oil tanker seen in the sea-going environment.
Fig. 5.10 Manifold and pipeline connections. Upper deck of an oil tankershowing the manifold, Samson Posts positioned to Port and Starboard, fittedwith 5-tonne safe working load (SWL) derricks for lifting hoses to manifold
connections.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 138
Tanker cargoes 139
ullage opening is usually set as near as possible to the centre of the tank sothat for a fixed volume of oil, the ullage is not appreciably affected by con-ditions of trim and list. If a favourable siting is not possible then the effectsof list and trim should be allowed for (Figure 5.12).
Fig. 5.11 Manifold and pipeline connections. Typical 14-inch oil pipe connection to the manifold.
Sighting port
Tank lid over hatch D
Oil levelUllage
Sounding
Depthof tank
Fig. 5.12 Measurement of liquid cargoes.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 139
140 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
The important measure of oil is weight and this must be calculated fromthe volume of oil in each tank. Weight in tonnes is quickly found by multi-plying the volume of oil in cubic metres by the relative density (RD) of theoil. This density is a fraction and may be taken out of petroleum tableswhen the RD of the oil is known.
ExampleTo find the weight of 125 m3 of oil at a RD of 0.98.
Density of oil � 0.98 t/m3
Weight of oil � volume � density� 125 m3 � 0.98 tonnes� 122.5 tonnes
Oil expands when heated and its RD, therefore, decreases with a rise in temperature. In order that the weight may be calculated accurately, it is important that when ullages are taken the RD of the oil should also be known. This may be measured directly, by means of ahydrometer.
The RD of a particular oil may be calculated if the temperature of the oil is taken. The change of RD due to a change of 1°C in temperature is known as the RD coefficient. This lies between 0.0003 and 0.0005 for most grades of oil and may be used to calculate the RD of an oil at any measured temperature if the RD at some standard temperature isknown.
ExamplesA certain oil has an RD of 0.75 at 16°C. Its expansion coefficient is0.00027/°C. Calculate its RD at 26°C.
Temperature difference � 26°C � 16°C � 10°CChange in RD � 10 � 0.00027
� 0.0027RD at 16°C � 0.75RD at 26°C � 0.7473
An oil has an RD 0.75 at 60°F. Its expansion coefficient is 0.00048/°F.Calculate its RD at 80°F.
Temperature difference � 80°F � 60°F � 20°FChange in RD � 20 � 0.00048
� 0.0096RD at 60°F � 0.75RD at 80°F � 0.7404
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 140
Tanker cargoes 141
Tank measurement and ullaging
Use of the Whessoe Tank GaugeThe function of the gauge is to register the ullage of the tank at any giventime, in particular when the liquid level in the tank is changing during theloading and discharge periods. The gauge is designed to record the read-ings not only at the top deck level of the tank but also remotely at a centralcargo control room. A transmitter is fitted on the head of the gauge for justthis purpose.
The unit is totally enclosed and various models manufactured are suit-able for use aboard not only oil tankers, but chemical and gas carriers aswell (Figure 5.13).
15 5
6
Ullagereading
Aft
(a) (b)
Sprocket wheel Guide wire torsion springs
To base ofgauge
Tank toppedestal
Tape
Connector andlock up deviceGuide wires
Float connector
Float Tank space
Cargo liquidlevel
Anchor bar
Tank bottom plate
.
.
.
Fig. 5.13 Whessoe Tank Gauge.
Inside the gauge housing is a calibrated ullage tape, perforated to passover a sprocket wheel and guided to a spring-loaded tape-drum. The tapeextends into the tank and is secured to a float of critical weight. As the liquidrises or falls, the tape is drawn into, or extracted out from, the drum at thegauge head. The tape-drum, being spring loaded, provides a constant ten-sion on the tape, regardless of the amount of tape paid out. A counter win-dow for display is fitted into the gauge head, which allows the ullage to beread on site at the top of the tank.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 141
142 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Tank measurement – radar systemThis is a totally enclosed measuring system which can only be employed if the tank is fully inerted. Systems are generally fitted with oxygen sensorand temperature sensor switches, so if the atmosphere in the tank is hot orflammable the radar will not function.
The main unit of the system is fitted on the deck with an inserted cabletube into the tank holding a transducer. Cable then carries the signal to acontrol unit in the cargo control room where the signal is converted to givea digital read-out for each tank monitored (Figure 5.14).
Transmitterand calibrator
Cables to andfrom control box
Transducer
Radarbeam
Fig. 5.14 The transducer would be fitted as close to the centre of the tank area as was possible. Such siting tends to eliminate errors due to trim and list.
LoadingLoading of tankers takes place at jetties, from FSUs or from SBM. Wherebooms carrying oil-bearing pipes are to be connected, these will be insulatedto prevent stray currents flowing, as from corrosion prevention systemsemployed on both ships and jetties. The flow of current in itself should notbe a problem, but it may give rise to a spark when making or breaking con-nections to the manifold. For this reason, these sections are tested regularlyfor efficient insulation. Lines are often bonded to reduce static electricityeffects which could also give rise to an unwanted source of ignition fromthe fast pumping of liquids (Figure 5.15).
These points are highlighted to illustrate that a high degree of awarenessis required in all tanker operations whether loading, discharging or gasfreeing. Fire precautions are paramount because the risk of fire aboard the tanker is a real hazard and stringent fire precautions must be adoptedthroughout cargo operations of every kind.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 142
Tanker cargoes 143
Loading procedural checklistCompany policy on loading procedures vary and Cargo Officers shouldadhere to the company procedures and take additional reference from theInternational Safety Guide for Oil Tankers and Terminals (ISGOTT):
1. Complete and sign the ship/shore checklist2. Establish an agreed communication network3. Agree the loading plan by both parties and confirm in writing4. Loading and topping off rates agreed5. Emergency stop procedures and signals agreed6. All effected tanks, lines, hoses inspected prior to commencing operations7. Overboard valves sealed8. All tanks and lines fully inerted9. Inert gas (IG) system shut down
10. Pump room isolated and shut down11. Ships lines set for loading12. Off side manifolds shut and blanked off13. All fire fighting and Ships Oil Pollution Emergency Plan (SOPEP)
equipment in place14. Notice of readiness accepted15. First set of tanks and manifold valves open16. Commence loading at a slow rate17. Check and monitor the first tanks to ensure cargo is being received18. Carry out line sample19. Check all around the vessel and overside for leaks
Fig. 5.15 Moorings and floating oil-bearing pipeline seen extending from the FSU ‘Zapro Producer’.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 143
144 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
20. Increase loading rate to full21. Check ullages at half-hourly intervals and monitor flow rate to con-
firm with shoreside figures22. Check valves operate into next set of tanks prior to change over23. Reduce loading rate when topping off final tank24. Order stop in ample time to achieve the planned ullage/line draining25. When the cargo flow has completely stopped close all valves26. After settling time, take ullages, temperatures and samples27. Ensure all log book entries are completed28. Cause an entry to be made into the Oil Record Book.
Note: The loading plan devised by Chief Officers and Shoreside Authorities would takeaccount of the ship’s stability and the possibility of stresses being incurred during allstages of the loading procedure.
Load on topWhen a crude oil tanker completes discharge, a large quantity of oil (upto2000 tonnes) may be left adhering to the bulkheads. The ‘load on top’ prin-ciple is a method designed to gather all this oil and deposit it into a sloptank. Tank cleaning would be carried out in the normal way drawing in seawater from either a ballast tank or directly from the sea suction.
On completion of tank cleaning the slop tank will contain all the tankwashings, made up of a mixture of oil and water (probably in the ratio ofthree parts water to one part oil). This mixture will contain small particlesof oil held in suspension in the water and water droplets will be suspendedin the oil. For this reason the slop tank must be allowed to ‘settle’ for up toabout 2 or 3 days. After this period of time the oil can be expected to befloating on top of the water content.
Once settling out is completed the interface between the oil and thewater levels must be determined (usually carried out by an interface instru-ment). Once the level of water is known, it is now possible to estimate theamount of water which can be discharged. The pumps and pipelines wouldbe cleaned of oil particles and the water in the tank can be pumped out verycarefully as the interface approaches the bottom. The main cargo pump isstopped when the water depth is at about 15–25 cm.
Alternative methods could be to pump the whole of the slop tank con-tents through an oily water separator or the tank can be de-canted from onetank to another.
On arrival at the loading port the new hot oil can be loaded on top of theremaining slops, which would have been quantified prior to commencingloading of the new cargo. During the loaded passage the old and new oilscombine and any further water content sinks to the bottom of the tank.
On arrival at the discharge port, water dips are taken and the water quan-tity calculated. This is then usually pumped direct to a shoreside slop tank.Once pure oil is drawn this can be diverted to main shoreside oil tanks.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 144
Tanker cargoes 145
The main purpose of ‘load on top’ is to reduce the possibility of oil pollu-tion while the vessel is at sea while at the same time as carrying out a fulltank-cleaning programme.
Note: Tank washings containing any persistent oil must not be disposed of into the seainside territorial waters or ‘special areas’.
Loading capacityThe amount of cargo a tanker can lift will depend upon the vessel’s dead-weight when the vessel is floating at her designated loadline. The amountof bunkers, fresh water and stores would be deducted to give the totalweight of cargo on board. The order of loading tanks is of high priority inorder to avoid excessive stresses occurring. Visible damage might not be animmediate result of a poor loading sequence but subsequent damage maybe caused later, when in a seaway, which could be attributable to excessivestresses during loading periods.
Nowadays vessels are equipped with designated ‘loadicators’ or com-puter software programs to establish effective loading plans and showshear forces and bending moments throughout the ships length. Such aidsare beneficial to Ship’s Officers in illustrating immediate problems and per-mitting ample time to effect corrective action.
Although a high rate of loading is usually desirable, this in itself gener-ates a need for tight ship keeping. Moorings will need to be tended regu-larly and an efficient gangway watch should be maintained. Communicationsthroughout the loading period should be effective and continuous withshoreside authorities, with adequate notice being given to the pumping sta-tion prior to ‘topping off’.
Care during transitIt would be normal practice that, through the period of the voyage, regularchecks are made on the tank ullage values and the temperatures of alltanks. Empty tanks and cofferdams, together with pump rooms, should besounded daily to ensure no leakage is apparent. Generally, oil is loaded at a higher temperature than that which will be experienced at sea, as such itwould be expected that the oil will cool and the ullage will increase for thefirst part of the voyage.
Viscous oils like fuel oil or heavy lubricating oil would normally beexpected to be heated for several days before arrival at the port of discharge.Heating will decrease the viscosity and a higher rate of discharge can beanticipated. Overheating should be avoided as this could affect the charac-ter of the product and may strain the structure of the vessel.
Tanks are vented by exhaust ventilators above deck level via masts andSamson Posts. Volatile cargoes such as ‘gasoline’ are vented via pressure reliefvalves which only operate when the tank pressure difference to atmosphere
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 145
146 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
exceeds 0.14 kg/cm2. This prevents an excessive loss of cargo due to evapor-ation. Evaporation of cargo can also be reduced in hot weather by sprayingthe upper decks cool with water.
DischargingFlexible hoses are connected to the ship’s manifold, as at the loading port,and the ship to shore checklist would be completed. Good communicationsbetween the ship and the shore authority is essential. All overboard dis-charges should be checked and if all valves are correct, discharge would becommenced at an initial slow rate. This slow rate is commenced to ensurethat if a sudden rise in back pressure is experienced in the line, the dis-charge can be stopped quickly. Such an experience would probably indicatethat the receiving lines ashore are not clear.
Back pressure should be continually monitored during discharge operationsand the ship, using ship’s pumps, should be ready to stop pumping at shortnotice from a signal from the terminal. The waterline around the ship shouldalso be kept under regular surveillance in the event of leakage occurring.
As with loading operations, the deck scuppers should all be sealed andSOPEP recommendations followed. All fire-fighting equipment should bekept readily available throughout the operation.
BallastingIn order that no oil is allowed to escape into the sea when engaging in bal-last operations, the pumps should be started before the sea valves areopened. If it is intended to ballast by gravity it is still preferable to pump forthe first 10 min or so to ensure that no oil leaks out.
Care should also be taken when topping up ballast tanks since any wateroverflow could be contaminated with oil. Any gas forced out of tanks duringballast operations constitutes a fire risk as equally dangerous as when loading.
All ballast operations should be recorded in the Ballast ManagementRecord Book and any transfers of oil content should be recorded in the OilRecord Book. Log books should take account of all tank operations regard-ing loading, discharging, ballasting or cleaning.
Tank-cleaning methodsThere are generally three methods of cleaning tanks:
1. Bottom flushing with water, petroleum product or chemical solvents2. Water washing (hot or cold) employing tank-washing machinery3. Crude oil washing (COW).
Bottom washingBottom flushing is usually carried out to rid the tank bottoms of previouscargo prior to loading a different, but compatible grade of cargo.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 146
Tanker cargoes 147
It can be effective when carrying refined products in small quantities.Bottom washing with acceptable solvents is sometimes conducted, espe-cially where a tanker is to take say paraffin (kerosene) products after carry-ing leaded gasolines. It should be realized that bottom washing will notremove heavy wax sediments from the bottom of tanks and is used purelyas a means of removing the traces of previous cargo.
Portable or fixed washing machinesUsing a high-pressure pump and heater, sea water, via a tank-cleaning deckline, is applied to wash the tank thoroughly. The dirty slop water is thenstripped back to the slop tank where it is heated to separate the oil from the water.
This is considered an essential method when changing trades from carry-ing crude to the white oil cargoes, or when the tank is required for cleanballast, or if it is to be gas freed.
COWA procedure that is conducted during the discharge and which has positiveadvantages over water-washing methods. New crude oil carriers over 20 000-dwt tonnes must now be fitted and use a COW facility. The method employsa high-pressure jet of crude oil from fixed tank-cleaning equipment. The jetis directed at the structure of the tank and ensures that no slops remain on-board after discharge, every last drop of cargo-going ashore. The advantagesare that tank cleaning at sea is avoided, with less likelihood of accidentalpollution; less tank corrosion is experienced than from water washing;increased carrying capacity is available for the next cargo; full tank drainageis achieved; and time saved gas freeing for dry dock periods.
Some disadvantages of the system include crew workload, which isincreased at the port of discharge; discharge time is increased; it has a highinstallation cost and maintenance costs are increased, while crew need spe-cial training with operational aspects.
Aspects of COWThe operational principle of the COW system is to use dry crude from a fulltank to wash the tanks being discharged. Crude containing water dropletsfrom the bottom of a tank should not be used for washing purposes as thismay introduce water droplets that have become electrostatically chargedand produce an unnecessary source of ignition in the tank atmosphere.
To this end any tank designated for use as COW should be first de-bottomed into the slop tank or bled ashore with the discharge pump.
One of the main cargo pumps is used to supply the COW line with pres-surized crude for washing operations. The line, along the deck, will carrybranch lines to all of the fixed machines. Large and very large crude carrier(VLCC) vessels may have up to six (6) machines per tank.
Safety in operation Tanks must be fully inerted prior to commencingwashing operations and the heater in the tank-washing system must be
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 147
148 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
isolated by blanks. The line would need to be pressurized and tested forleaks prior to commencing washing.
● Operation – Stage One: The limits to cover the top of the cycle would needto be adjusted to be pointing upwards. Where portable drive units areemployed these would have to be initially fitted and limits set accordingly(Figure 5.16(a)).
● Operation – Stage Two: The second stage starts when one-third of the tank is discharged and the washing jet will only be allowed to traveldown to a point where the jet strikes the bulkhead just above the level ofthe oil in the tank. At this stage the machine completes 11⁄2 cycles andmust therefore be adjusted, up again, before the start of the next stage(Figure 5.16(b)).
(a) (b)
(c) (d)
Fig. 5.16 COW cycles. (a) First Cycle Stage One – nozzle elevated for upperlevel wash. (b) Second Cycle Stage Two – one-third of cargo discharged, nozzleprogrammed to wash upper third of tank. (c) Third Cycle Stage Three – two-thirds of the cargo is discharged. Nozzle programmed to wash mid levels of thetank. (d) Fourth Cycle, last stage – machine programmed so that the lower levels
and the last washing cycle coincide with the end of discharge.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 148
Tanker cargoes 149
● Operation – Stage Three: The third stage is where the machine washesfrom where two-thirds of the tank has been discharged and betweenone- and two-thirds of the tanks structure is washed (Figure 5.16(c)).
● Operation – Last Stage: The final stage washes the last third and the bottom of the tank with the jet pointing in the downward position(Figure 5.16(d)).
COW – preparation and activitiesPrior to arrival at the port of discharge:
1. Has the terminal been notified?2. Is oxygen-analysing equipment tested and working satisfactorily?3. Are tanks pressurized with good quality IG (maximum 8% oxygen)?4. Is the tank-washing pipeline isolated from water heater and engine room?5. Are all the hydrant valves on the tank-washing line securely shut?6. Have all tank-cleaning lines been pressurized and leakages made good?
In port:
1. Is the quality of the IG in the tanks satisfactory (8% oxygen or less)?2. Is the pressure on the IG satisfactory?3. Have all discharge procedures been followed and ship-to-shore check-
list completed?
Before washing:
1. Are valves open to machines on selected tanks for washing?2. Are responsible persons positioned around the deck to watch for leaks?3. Are tank ullage gauge floats lifted on respective tanks to be washed?4. Is the IG system in operation?5. Are all tanks closed to the outside atmosphere?6. Have tanks positive IG pressure?
During washing:
1. Are all lines oil tight?2. Are tank-washing machines functioning correctly?3. Is the IG in the tanks being retained at a satisfactory quality?4. Is positive pressure available on the IG system?
After washing:
1. Are all the valves between discharge line and the tank-washing line shutdown?
2. Has the tank-washing main pressure been equalized and the line drained?3. Are all tank-washing machine valves shut?
After departure:
1. Have any tanks due for inspection been purged to below the criticaldilution level prior to introducing fresh air?
2. Has oil been drained from the tank-washing lines before openinghydrants to the deck?
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 149
150 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
The IG systemTanker vessels have an inherent danger from fire and/or explosion and it isdesirable that the atmosphere above an oil cargo or in an empty tank is suchthat it will not support combustion. The recognized method of achievingthis status is to keep these spaces filled with an IG. Such a system servestwo main functions:
1. Use of IG inhibits fire or explosion risk2. It inhibits corrosion inside cargo tanks.
As IG is used to control the atmosphere within the tanks it is useful to knowexactly what composition the gases are, not only from a safety point of viewbut to realize what affect such an atmosphere would have on the construc-tion of the tanks.
Boiler flu gas consists of the following mix (assuming a well-adjustedboiler):
Component Percentage of IG
Nitrogen 83Carbon dioxide (CO2) 13Carbon monoxide 0.3Oxygen 3.5Sulphur dioxide 0.005Nitrogen oxides TracesWater vapour TracesAsh TracesSoot Traces
Flu gases leave the boiler at about 300°C, contaminated with carbondeposits and sulphurous acid gas. The gas then passes through a scrubberwhich washes out the impurities and reduces the temperature to within1°C of the ambient sea temperature.
The clean cooled gas is now moisture laden and passes through a demis-ter where it is dried. It is then fan assisted on passage towards the cargo tankspassing through a deck water seal and then over the top of an oil seal toenter at the top of the tank. It is allowed to circulate and is purged througha pipe which extends from the deck to the bottom of the tank (Figure 5.17).
There is a sampling cock near the deck water seal for monitoring thequality of the IG. Individual tank quality is tested by opening the purgepipe cover and inserting a sample probe.
Excess pressure in the cargo tanks being vented through a pressure vac-uum valve (P/V valve) set at 2 psi, which is then led to a mast riser fittedwith a gauze screen. The excess is then vented to atmosphere as far fromthe deck as practicable.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 150
Tanker cargoes 151
Waste heatgases via
funnel
IGgenerator
Gas booster fan
Boiler
High-pressurecompressor
High-pressuredryer
Deck waterseal
L.P.dryer
To cargo tanks
Vent valve
Storage
Non-returnvalve
Oil seal
Purgepipe
Cargotank
Mast riser
Prsssurevacuum valve
Gascooler
Venturiscrubber
Fig. 5.17 The IG system.
Requirements for IG systemsAdditional reference should be made to the Revised Guidelines for Inert GasSystems adopted by the Maritime Safety Committee, June 1983 (MSC/Circ. 353).
In the case of chemical tankers, reference, Resolution A. 567(14) and A. 473(XIII).
Tankers of 20 000 tonnes deadweight and above, engaged in carrying crudeoil, must be fitted with an IG system:
1. Venting systems in cargo tanks must be designed to operate to ensure thatneither pressure nor vacuum inside the tanks will exceed design parame-ters, for volumes of vapour, air or IG mixtures.
2. Venting of small volumes of vapour, air or IG mixtures, caused by thermalvariations effecting the cargo tank, must pass through ‘P/V valves’.
Large volumes caused by cargo loading, ballasting or during dischargemust not be allowed to exceed design parameters.
A secondary means of allowing full flow relief of vapour, air or IG mixtures,to avoid excess pressure build-up must be incorporated, with a pressuresensing, monitoring arrangement. This equipment must also provide analarm facility activated by over-pressure.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 151
152 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
3. Tankers with double-hull spaces and double-bottom spaces shall be fittedwith connections for air and suitable connections for the supply of IG. Wherehull spaces are fitted to the IG permanent distribution system, means must beprovided to prevent hydrocarbon gases from cargo tanks, entering double-hull spaces (where spaces are not permanently connected to the IG systemappropriate means must be provided to allow connection to the IG main).
4. Suitable portable instruments and/or gas-sampling pipes for measuringflammable vapour concentrations and oxygen must be provided to assessdouble-hull spaces.
5. All tankers operating with a COW system must be fitted with an IG system.6. All tankers fitted with an IG system shall be provided with a closed ullage
system.7. The IG system must be capable of inerting empty cargo tanks by reducing
the oxygen content to a level which will not support combustion. It mustalso maintain the atmosphere inside the tank with an oxygen content of lessthan 8% by volume and at a positive pressure at all times in port or at sea,except when necessary to gas free.
8. The system must be capable of delivering gas to the cargo tanks at a rate of125% of the maximum rate of discharge capacity of the ship, expressed as avolume.
9. The system should be capable of delivering IG with an oxygen content ofnot more than 5% by volume in the IG supply main to cargo tanks.
10. Flue gas isolating valves must be fitted to the IG mains, between the boileruptakes and the flue gas scrubber. Soot blowers will be arranged so as to bedenied operation when the corresponding flue gas valve is open.
11. The ‘scrubber’ and ‘blowers’ must be arranged and located aft of all cargotanks, cargo pump rooms and cofferdams separating these spaces frommachinery spaces of Category ‘A’.
12. Two fuel pumps or one with sufficient spares shall be fitted to the IG generator.13. Suitable shut offs must be provided to each suction and discharge connec-
tion of the blowers. If blowers are to be used for gas freeing they must haveblanking arrangements.
14. An additional water seal or other effective means of preventing gas leakageshall be fitted between the flue gas isolating valves and scrubber, or incorporated in the gas entry to the scrubber, for the purpose of permittingsafe maintenance procedures.
15. A gas-regulating valve must be fitted in the IG supply main, which is auto-matically controlled to close at predetermined limits.(This valve must be located at the forward bulkhead of the foremost gas-safe space.)
16. At least two non-return devices, one of which will be a water seal must befitted to the IG supply main. These devices should be located in the cargoarea, on deck.
17. The water seal must be protected from freezing, and prevent backflow ofhydrocarbon vapours.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 152
Tanker cargoes 153
18. The second device must be fitted forward of the deck water seal and be of anon-return valve type or equivalent, fitted with positive means of closing.
19. Branch piping of the system to supply IG to respective tanks must be fittedwith stop valves or equivalent means of control, for isolating a tank.
20. Arrangements must be provided to connect the system to an external sup-ply of IG.
21. Meters must be fitted in the navigation bridge of combination carriers whichindicate the pressure in slop tanks when isolated from the IG main supply.Meters must also be situated in machinery control rooms for the pressureand oxygen content of IG supplied (where a cargo control room is a featurethese meters would be fitted in such rooms).
22. Automatic shutdown of IG blowers and the gas-regulating valve shall bearranged on predetermined limits.
23. Alarms shall be fitted to the system and indicated in the machinery spaceand the cargo control room. These alarms monitor the following:– Low water pressure or low water flow rate to the flu gas scrubber.– High water level in the flu gas scrubber.– High gas temperature.– Failure of the IG blowers.– Oxygen content in excess of 8% by volume.– Failure of the power supply to the automatic control system, regulating
valve and sensing/monitoring devices.– Low water level in the deck water seal.– Gas pressure less than 100-mm water gauge level.– High gas pressure.– Insufficient fuel oil supply to the IG generator.– Power failure to the IG generator.– Power failure to the automatic control of the IG generator.
Hazards with IG systemsThe IG system aboard any vessel has two inherent hazards:
1. If the cooling water in the scrubber should fail, then uncooled gas at300°C would pass directly to the cargo tank. This is prevented by the fit-ting of two water sensors in the base of the scrubber which, if allowed tobecome uncovered, would generate an alarm signal which shuts the system down and vents the gas to atmosphere. In the event that bothsensors failed two thermometer probes at the outlet of the scrubberwould sense an unacceptable rise in temperature and initiate the sameshutdown procedure.
2. If there was a failure in the P/V valve, at the same time as a rise in thepressure within the cargo tank, it would result in pressure working back-wards towards the boiler with a possible risk of explosion. This is prevented by the water in the deck seal forming a plug in the IG line until
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 153
154 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
a sufficient head is generated to blow out the oil seal and the excess pres-sure vents to the deck. The pressure of water in the water seal is essential;therefore, the two water sensors would sense its absence and shut downthe plant as previously stated.
IG pressure should be maintained at a positive pressure at all times, toavoid air being forced into the cargo spaces. Such a positive pressure is alsoexerted onto the surface of the oil cargo and assists in pushing the oil alongthe suction line towards the cargo pump, and in so doing assists the drain-ing of the tanks. Any excess pressure in the cargo tanks is vented throughthe P/V valve.
IG – voyage cycle● Phase 1 – Vessel departs dry dock with all tanks vented to atmosphere
and partially ballasted. The IG plant is started, empty tanks and ullagespaces purged to atmosphere until oxygen levels are acceptable. IG qual-ity should be monitored and maintained throughout the ballast voyage.
● Phase 2 – Prior to arrival at the loading port the IG plant would be startedand ballast reduced to about 25% of the ships deadweight, ballast beingreplaced by IG. After berthing, the remainder of the seawater ballastwould be discharged and replaced by IG. The IG plant would then beshut down, the deck isolation valve would be closed and the mast riseropened, prior to commencing loading. IG would be displaced throughmast risers. On completion of loading, the IG would be topped up to aworking pressure which would be maintained though the loaded voyage(this would be expected to reduce evaporation and prevent oxygen access).
● Phase 3 – On arrival at the port of discharge, the IG plant would be set tomaximum output with discharge pumps at maximum output. The IGpressure should be monitored carefully and if it approaches a negative,the rate of discharge of the cargo reduces. The mast riser must never beopened to relieve the vacuum during the discharge period.
● Phase 4 – On completion of discharge, the IG system should be shutdown. If and when ballasting takes place the IG and hydrocarbonswould be vented to atmosphere.
● Phase 5 – On departure from the discharge port all tanks must be drainedto the internal slop tank, then purged with IG to reduce the hydrocarbonlevels to below 2%.
● Phase 6 – Tank cleaning can now be permitted with IG in fully inertedtanks. This weakens the hydrocarbon level and the positive pressureprevents pumps draining or drawing atmosphere into the tanks.
● Phase 7 – When all the vessels tanks have been washed and ballastchanged it may be necessary to carry out tank inspections. If this is thecase, all tanks would then have to be purged with IG to remove all tracesof hydrocarbon gas before venting by fans. All tanks would then betested with explosi-meter and oxygen analyser (full procedure forenclosed space entry must be observed before internal inspection).
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 154
Tanker cargoes 155
Advantages and disadvantages of the IG system
Advantages1. A safe tank atmosphere is achieved which is non-explosive2. It allows high-pressure tank washing and reduces tank-cleaning time3. It allows COW4. Reduces corrosion in tanks – with an efficient scrubber in the system5. Improves stripping efficiency and reduces discharge time6. Aids the safe gas freeing of tanks7. It is economical to operate8. It forms a readily available extinguishing agent for other spaces9. Reduces the loss of cargo through evaporation
10. Complies with legislation and reduces insurance premiums.
Disadvantages1. Additional costs for installation2. Maintenance costs are incurred3. Low visibility inside tanks4. With low oxygen content, tank access is denied5. Could lead to contamination of high-grade products6. Moisture and sulphur content corrodes equipment7. An established reverse route for cargo to enter the engine room8. Oxygen content must be monitored and alarm sensed at all times9. Instrumentation failure could affect fail-safe devices putting the ship at
risk through the IG system10. An additional gas generator is required in the system in the absence of
waste heat products from boiler flue gases.
Note: Instrumentation of the system to cover: IG temperature pressure read outs andrecorders. Alarms for: blower failure, high oxygen content alarm, high and low gas pres-sure alarms, high gas temperature, low seawater pressure and low level alarm in thescrubber and the deck water seal, respectively.
Deck water seal operationThe water level in the deck water seal is maintained by constant running ofthe seawater pump and a gooseneck drain system. Under normal IG pres-sure the IG will bubble through the liquid from the bottom of the IG inletpipe and exit under normal operating pressure. In the event of a back pres-sure developing and the water surface experiencing increased pressure,this would force the water level up the IG inlet pipe, sealing this pipeentrance and preventing hydrocarbons entering the scrubber (Figure 5.18).
Tank atmosphereThe Cargo Officer will need to be able to assess the condition of the atmos-phere inside the tank on numerous occasions. To this end, various monitoring
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 155
156 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
IGinlet
Waterinlet
Water outlet
IGoutlet
Fig. 5.18 Deck water seal operation.
equipment is available to carry out ‘gas detection’ and ‘oxygen content’.The officer should be familiar with the type of equipment aboard his/herown vessel and have a degree of understanding how such instrumentationoperates.
Gas detectionIt should be understood from the outset that many accidents and loss of lifehas occurred through lack of knowledge of gas-detection methods and the correct practice concerning this topic. The explosi-meter, of which thereare several trade names available, is used for detecting the presence offlammable gas and/or air mixture.
The explosi-meter The explosi-meter is an instrument which is specif-ically designed for measuring the lower flammable limit (LFL). It will onlyfunction correctly if the filament has an explosive mixture in contact with it. It is contained in a hand-held size box with a battery power supply(Figure 5.19).
When in use, the sample tube is lowered into the tank and a sample of theatmosphere is drawn up into the instrument by several depressions of the rubber aspirator bulb. If the sample contains an explosive mixture theresistance of the catalytic filament will change due to the generated heat.An imbalance of the wheat-stone bridge is detected by the ohmmeterwhich tells the operator that hydrocarbon gas is present in the tank in suf-ficient quantity to support combustion.
Note: Combustibles in the sample are burned on the heated filament,which raises its temperature and increases the resistance in proportion tothe concentration of combustibles in the sample. This then causes theimbalance in the wheat-stone bridge.
However, it should be realized that a zero reading does not necessarilyindicate that there is no hydrocarbon gas present, nor does it mean that nooxygen is present. All it signifies is that the sample taken is either too richor too lean to support combustion. Care must be taken when testing the
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 156
Tanker cargoes 157
atmosphere in enclosed spaces to give consideration for the relative vapourdensity where mixtures of gases are encountered. A test at one particularlevel in a tank should be realized as not necessarily being an equivalentreading for other different levels in the same tank.
The electrical bridge circuit of the instrument is designed so that its balanceis established at the proper operating temperature of the detecting filament.The circuit balance and detector current are adjusted simultaneously byadjustment of the rheostat. The proper relationship between these two factors is maintained by a special ballast lamp in the circuit.
The graduations on the meter are a per cent of the lower explosive limit(LEL) reading between 0% and 100%. A deflection of the meter between 0%and 100% shows how close the atmosphere being tested approaches the min-imum concentration required for explosion. When a test is made with theexplosi-meter, and a deflection to the extreme right-hand side of the scale isnoted and remains there, then the atmosphere under test is explosive.Limitations of explosi-meters – The explosi-meter has been designed todetect the presence of flammable gases and vapours. The instrument willindicate in a general way whether or not the atmosphere is dangerous froma flammability point of view. It is important to realize that such informationobtained from the instrument is appraised by a person skilled in the inter-pretation of the reading, bearing in mind the environment. For example,the atmosphere sample which is indicated as being non-hazardous from
FilterFlashbackarrestors Flow orifice
Detector filament
Meter lamp
Ballastlamp
R2
R4
R6R3
R5
Meter
Aspirator bulb
Check valves
Gasket
BatteriesOn/offswitch
Inlet Outlet
Fig. 5.19 The MSA model 2E explosi-meter (combustible gas detector).
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 157
158 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
the standpoint of fire and explosion, may if inhaled, be toxic to workerswho are exposed to that same atmosphere.
Additionally, a tank that is deemed safe before work is commenced maybe rendered unsafe by future ongoing operations, e.g. stirring or handlingbottom sludge. This would indicate the need for regular testing practices tobe in place in questionable spaces while work is in progress.Explosi-meter special uses – Where the explosi-meter is employed to testan atmosphere which is associated with high boiling point solvents, itshould be borne in mind that the accuracy of the reading may be question-able. The space may be at a higher temperature than the instrument, andtherefore it must be anticipated that some condensation of combustiblevapours would be in the sampling line. As a consequence, the instrumentcould read less than the true vapour concentration.
A way around this would possibly be to warm the sampling line and theinstrument unit to an equivalent temperature as that of the space being tested.
Note: Under no circumstances should such instruments be heated over 65°C (150°F).
Furthermore, some types of instruments are designed to measure com-bustible vapours in air. They are not capable of measuring the percentagevapours in a steam or inert atmosphere, due to the absence of oxygen nec-essary to cause combustion.Care in use – When sampling over liquids, care should be taken that thesampling tube does not come into contact with the liquid itself. A probetube can be used in tests of this character, to prevent liquid being drawninto the sampling tube.
Drager instruments This is an instrument which draws a gas orvapour through an appropriate glass testing tube, each tube being treatedwith a chemical that will react with a particular gas, causing discolourationprogressively down the length of the tube. When measured against a scale,the parts per million (ppm) can be ascertained.
The instrument is used extensively on the chemical carrier trades thoughit does have tubes for use with hydrocarbons, which make it suitable foruse on tankers.
Alarm system detectors An instrument which is taken into a sup-posedly gas-free compartment and used while work is ongoing. If gas isreleased or disturbed in the work place a sensitive element on the instrumenttriggers an audible and visual alarm. Once the alarm has been activatedpersonnel would be expected to evacuate the compartment immediately.
The oxygen analyserIn order for an atmosphere to support human life it must have the oxygencontent of 21%. The oxygen analyser is an instrument that measures theoxygen content of an atmosphere to establish whether entry is possible, butit is also employed for inerted spaces which must be retained under 5%oxygen to affect a safe atmosphere within the tank (Figure 5.20).
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 158
Tanker cargoes 159
R2
R3
R4
R1
BatteryOn/off switch
Fig. 5.20 Oxygen analyser – circuitry principle.
The oxygen sensor will be either an electromagnetic heated filament or anelectrochemical resistor cell. The instrument was designed to measure the oxy-gen content only and will not detect the presence of any other gases. As shownin Figure 5.20, the resistor filaments R3 and R4 are of equal rating. The resistorfilament R3 is surrounded by a magnetic field. The atmosphere sample drawnpast the filament will depend on the permitted current flow through the coiland meter, depending on the amount of oxygen in the sample.
Oxygen analysers are portable instruments which draw a sample of theatmosphere for testing through a sampling hose by means of a rubber aspirator bulb. The principle of operation is a self-generating electrolyticcell in which the electric current is directly proportional to the percentageoxygen in a salt solution connecting to the electrodes. The electrodes areconnected to a micro-ammeter, so that the current read by the meter can becalibrated to indicate directly the percentage oxygen of the sample.
There are variations and different types of instruments available.Manufacturer’s instructions and manuals for use and maintenance shouldtherefore be followed when these instruments are employed.
Chemical reaction measuring deviceGas detection can also be achieved by using a test sample of the atmos-phere to pass over a chemical-impregnated paper or crystal compound.The chemicals subsequently react with specific gases on contact.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 159
160 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
The amount of discolouration occurring in the crystals or on the papercan then be compared against a scale to provide the amount of gas withinthe sample. The operation uses a bellows to draw through a 100 cm3 of sam-ple gas and a variety of tubes can be used to indicate specific gases.Example gases indicated are likely to be, but not limited to carbon monoxide,hydrogen sulphide, hydrocarbon, radon, nitrous oxide. A popular instru-ment is the ‘Drager Tube System’ for gas detecting.
Although well-used in the industry, the system does have drawbacks inthe fact that the tubes required for different gases have a limited shelf life.The bellows can develop leaks and they can be affected by temperatureextremes. Tube insertion must also be carried out the correct way.
Coastal and shuttle tanker operationsNumerous small tanker operations are engaged in coastal regions aroundthe world and employ the services of coastal-sized craft to shuttle cargoparcels between main terminal ports, FSUs and the smaller out of the wayports. Restrictions are often put on direct delivery from the ocean-goingvessels because of the available depth of water in the smaller enclaves andas such the geography imposes draught restrictions on the larger vessels.This particular drawback is also affecting the container trade, with container vessels currently being increased in overall size, the larger vesselsare finding some ports are not available to them because of similar draughtrestrictions (Figure 5.21).
Fig. 5.21 The coastal oil tanker ‘Alacrity’ lies port side to a terminal berth in the UK.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 160
Tanker cargoes 161
Examples of tanker cargoesBitumen – this cargo solidifies at normal temperatures and must be kepthot during transit. Ships are specifically designed for this trade, with large centre tanks and additional heating coils. The centre tanks being used forcargo and the wing tanks for ballast.
Chemicals (various) – precautions for these cargoes as outlined in previoustext. Additional reference to the International Maritime Dangerous Goods(IMDG) Code and respective precautions pertaining to the type of com-modity.
Creosote – this is a very heavy cargo and requires constant heating duringthe voyage.
Crude oil – varies greatly with RD and viscosity. It is not heated unless avery heavy grade, as heating evaporates the lighter fractions. Crude oil hasa high fire risk.
Diesel oil – is an intermediate between fuel oil and gas oil. It is generallyregarded as a dirty oil but its viscosity is such that it does not require heat-ing prior to discharge.
Fuel oil – is a black oil and is graded according to its weight and viscosity. Ithas a low fire risk and generally requires heating prior to discharge.
Gas oil – this is a clean oil and is used for light diesel engines as well as formaking gas. A reasonable level of cleanliness is required before loading thiscargo, which may be used as a transition cargo when a ship is beingchanged from a black oil carrier to a clean oil trade. Fire risk is low and noheating is required.
Gasoline (petrol) – is light and volatile. It has a high fire risk and may easilybe contaminated if loaded into tanks which are not sufficiently clean.
Grain – may be successfully carried in selective tankers since when in a bulkstate it has many of the qualities of a liquid. It requires very careful tankpreparation and tankers would only normally enter the trade if the oil marketwas depressed.
Kerosene (paraffin) – this is a clean oil which is easily discoloured. Precautionsshould be taken to prevent the build-up of static. These may include a slowloading and discharge pattern being employed.
Latex – an occasional cargo carried in tankers and in ships ‘deep tanks’.Usually has added ammonia. The tanks should be exceptionally clean andfitted with pressure relief valves. Steelwork is pre-coated in paraffin waxand heating coils in tanks should be removed. Following discharge thetanks should be washed with water to remove all traces of ammonia.
Liquefied gases – generally carried in specifically designed vessels for thetransport of LNG and liquid propane gas (a liquefied petroleum gas, LPG).
Lubricating oils – these are valuable cargoes and are usually shipped in the smaller product carriers. Good separation is necessary to avoid
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 161
162 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
contamination between grades. Tanks and pipelines must be free of waterbefore loading. Some grades may require heating before discharging.
Molasses – a heavy viscous cargo which is normally carried in designatedtankers specific for the trade. A comprehensive heating system is necessaryand special pumps are provided to handle the thick liquid.
Propane – a gas similar to ‘butane’, see liquefied gases.
Vegetable oils – these are generally carried in small quantities in the deeptanks of cargo ships but some such as ‘linseed oil’ may be carried in tankers.Exceptional cleanliness of the tanks is required prior to loading such a cargo.
Whale oil – whale factory ships are basically tankers carrying fuel oil on theoutward passage and whale oil when homeward bound. Careful cleaning isrequired before carrying whale oil in tanks which previously carried fuel oil(in recent years the practice of whale hunting has been severely restricted).
Wine – can be carried in tankers but they are usually dedicated ships to the trade. Similar vessels sometimes engage in the carriage of fruit juices,especially orange juice. A high degree of cleanliness in the tanks is expected(Ref. page 162).
Product tankersProduct tankers tend to be smaller and more specialized than the large crudeoil carriers and generally lay alongside specialized berths when loadingand discharging, employing specialist product lines to avoid contamina-tion of cargoes (Figures 5.22 and 5.23).
Fig. 5.22 Conventional large oil tanker seen passing through the Dardanelles.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 162
Tanker cargoes 163
Bulk liquid chemical carriers
Phrases and terminology associated with the chemical industryAdiabatic expansion – is an increase in volume without a change in tempera-ture or without any heat transfer taking place.
Anaesthetics – chemicals that affect the nervous system and cause anaesthesia.
Aqueous – a compound within a water-based solution.
Auto-ignition – a chemical reaction of a compound causing combustionwithout a secondary source of ignition.
Boiling point – that temperature at which a liquid’s vapour pressure is equalto the atmospheric pressure.
Catalyst – a substance that will cause a reaction with another substance orone that accelerates or decelerates a reaction.
Fig. 5.23 The product tanker ‘Folesandros’ lies port side to the berth, discharging in Gibraltar.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 163
164 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Critical pressure – that minimum pressure which is required to liquefy a gasat its critical temperature.
Critical temperature – that maximum temperature of a gas at which it can beturned into a liquid by pressurization.
Filling ratio – that percentage volume of a tank which can be safely filledallowing for the expansion of the product.
Freezing point – that temperature at which a substance must be at to changefrom a liquid to a solid state or vice versa.
Hydrolysis – that process of splitting a compound into two parts by the agencyof water. One part being combined with hydrogen, the other with hydroxyl.
Hydroscopic – that ability of a substance to absorb water or moisture fromthe atmosphere.
Inhibitor – a substance which, when introduced to another, will prevent areaction.
Narcosis – a human state of insensibility resembling sleep or unconscious-ness, from which it is difficult to arouse.
Oxidizing agent – an element or compound that is capable of adding oxygento another.
Padding – a procedure of displacing air or unwanted gasses from tanks andpipelines with another compatible substance, e.g. IG, cargo vapour or liquid.
Polymerization – that process which is due to a chemical reaction within asubstance, capable of changing the molecular structure within that substance,i.e. liquid to solid.
Reducing agent – an element or compound that is capable of removing oxygen from a substance.
Reid vapour pressure – is that vapour pressure of a liquid as measured in aReid apparatus at a temperature of 100°F expressed in psi/°A.
Self-reaction – is that ability of a chemical to react without other influencewhich results in polymerization or decomposition.
Sublimation – that process of conversion from a solid to a gas, without melt-ing (an indication that the flash point is well below the freezing point).
Threshold limit value – is that value reflecting the amount of gas, vapour,mist or spray mixture that a person may be daily subjected to, without suf-fering any adverse effects (usually expressed in ppm).
Vapour density – that weight of a specific volume of gas compared to anequal volume of air, in standard conditions of temperature and pressure.
Vapour pressure – that pressure exerted by a vapour above the surface of aliquid at a certain temperature (measured in mm of mercury, mmHg).
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 164
Tanker cargoes 165
Bulk chemical cargoesThe term liquid chemicals within the industry is meant to express thosechemicals in liquid form at an ambient temperature or which can be lique-fied by heating, when carried at pressures up to 0.7 kg/cm2. Above this thechemical pressure would fall into the category of ‘liquefied gases’.
The chemicals carried at sea have a variety of properties. Nearly half ofthe 200 chemicals commonly carried have fire or health hazards no greaterthan petroleum cargoes. Therefore, they can be safely carried by way ofordinary product carriers, though some modification is sometimesrequired to avoid contamination.
Other chemical substances require quality control much more stringentthan petroleum products. Contamination, however slight, cannot beallowed to occur and for this reason tanks are nearly always coated ormade of special materials like stainless steel.
Extreme care must be exercised when loading such cargoes that any sub-stance which could cause a reaction are kept well separated. To ensure qualityand safe carriage, separate pipelines, valves and separate pumps are the normfor specific cargo parcels. Also reactionary chemicals cannot be placed in adja-cent tanks with only a single bulkhead separation. Neither can pipelines car-rying one substance pass through a tank carrying another substance withwhich it may react. Chemical products which react with sea water are car-ried in centre tanks while the wing tanks are employed to act as cofferdams.
Chemical carriers require experienced and specialized trained personnel inorder to conduct their day-to-day operations safely. They also require sophis-ticated cargo-handling and monitoring equipment. The ships must conformin design and construction practice to the IMO ‘Code for the Constructionand Equipment of Ships Carrying Dangerous Chemicals in Bulk’.
The purpose of the ‘code’ is to recommend suitable design criteria, safetymeasures and construction standards for ships carrying dangerous chem-ical substances. Much of the content of the code has been incorporated intothe construction regulations produced by the Classification Societies.
Classification – chemical carriers(Chapter references to the International Code for the Construction andEquipment of Ships Carrying Dangerous Chemicals in Bulk) (IBC)
In general ships carrying chemicals in bulk are classed into three types:
1. A ‘Type 1’ ship is a chemical tanker intended to transport Chapter 17 ofthe IBC Code products with very severe environmental and safety hazardswhich require maximum preventive measures to preclude an escape ofsuch cargo.
2. A ‘Type 2’ ship is a chemical tanker intended to transport Chapter 17 of theIBC Code products with appreciably severe environmental and safetyhazards which require significant preventive measures to preclude anescape of such cargo.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 165
166 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
3. A ‘Type 3’ ship is a chemical tanker intended to transport Chapter 17 ofthe IBC Code products with sufficiently severe environmental and safetyhazards which require a moderate degree of containment to increasesurvival capability in a damaged condition.
Many of the cargoes carried in these ships must be considered as extremelydangerous and, as such, the structure of the ship’s hull is considered in thelight of the potential danger, which might result from damage to the trans-port vessel. Type 3 ships are similar to product tankers in that they have dou-ble hulls but have a greater subdivision requirement. Whereas Types 1 and 2ships must have their cargo tanks located at specific distances inboard toreduce the possibility of impact load directly onto the cargo tank (Figure 5.24).
Type 1 ship
B/15 minimumclearance
Tank
760 mmminimum clearance
Tank
B/5 minimum clearance
(a)
Type 2 ship
Tank
760 mmminimum clearance
(b)
B/15 minimum clearance
Diagrammatic tank plan to beinserted in this area
Tank plan (all types)
Cargo area length
(c)
B/5 minimumclearance
Fig. 5.24 The tank arrangement must be attached to the International Certificate of Fitness, for the carriage of Dangerous Chemicals in Bulk.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 166
Tanker cargoes 167
Parcel tankers – construction featuresShips built specifically as parcel tankers with the intention of carrying a widevariety of cargoes will generally have some tanks of ‘stainless steel’ or tanksclad in stainless steel. For reasons of construction and cost this means havinga double skin. Mild steel tanks may similarly be built with side cofferdams anda double bottom and are usually coated in either epoxy or silicate. Chemicalsof high density like ‘ethylene dibromide’ may have specially constructedtanks or in some cases only carry partly filled cargo tanks (Figure 5.25).
Wing tanks Pump rooms
Center tanks
Deck tanks
Epoxy coated Zinc silicate coated Stainless steel
Fig. 5.25 Diagram of a parcel tanker.
Similarly, cargoes with higher vapour pressures may generate a need fortanks to be constructed to withstand higher pressures than say the conven-tional tanker – particularly relevant where the boiling point of the morevolatile cargoes is raised and the risk of loss is increased.
The IBC Code specifies requirements for safety equipment to monitorvapour detection, fire protection, ventilation in cargo-handling spaces,gauging and tank filling. Once all criteria is met the Marine Authority(Maritime and Coastguard Agency (MCA) in the UK) will issue, on appli-cation an MCA/IMO Certificate of Fitness for the Carriage of DangerousCargoes in Bulk.
Vapour linesIn general, each tank will have its own vapour line fitted with P/V valves butgrouped tanks may have a common line. Since some vapours from specific
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 167
168 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
cargoes are highly toxic or flammable, the lines are led well over accommo-dation and are expected to release vapour as near as possible in a verticaldirection. Some vessels carry provision to return vapour expelled duringthe loading process to the shoreside tank. Examples are when the cargo ishighly toxic or the chemicals react dangerously with air.
Main hazards associated with chemicals to humansThe substances carried in chemical tankers present certain hazards to oper-ations of transport and to the crews of the ships. The main hazards fall intoone of a combination of the following:
1. danger to health – toxicity and irritant characteristics of the substance orvapour
2. water pollution aspect – human toxicity of the substance in the solution3. reactionary activity with water or other chemicals4. fire and/or explosion hazard.
Cargo information – required before loading1. The Cargo Officer must be informed of the correct chemical name of
the cargo to enable the appropriate safety data sheet to be consulted inthe Tanker Safety Guide (Chemicals).
2. The quantity of cargo and respective weight.3. Clearance on quality control must be confirmed. Contamination, usually
measured in ppm so tanks and pipelines must be assured to be clean.4. The specific gravity value of the commodity must be advised to allow an
estimate of the volume to be occupied for the intended weight of cargo.5. Incompatibility with other cargoes or specifically other chemicals must
be notified. Correct stowage must be achieved so that incompatible cargoes are not stowed in adjacent compartments.
6. Temperature of the cargo: (a) at the loading stage and (b) during the carriage stage. This criterion is required because temperature of thecommodity will affect the volume of the total cargo loaded, while theexpected carriage temperature will indicate whether heating of the cargowill be required.
7. The tank-coating compatibility must be suitable for the respective cargo.8. Any corrosive properties of the chemical. This information would also
be relevant to the tank-coating aspect and provide possible concernsfor incurring damage to shipboard fittings.
9. Electrostatic properties can be acquired by some chemicals. With this inmind the principles applicable to hydrocarbons should be applied.
10. Data on the possibility of fire or explosion – 50% of chemicals carriedare derived from hydrocarbons and the risk of fire or explosion is simi-lar to the carriage for hydrocarbons.
11. The level of toxicity of the chemical. If high-toxic vapours are a charac-teristic of the cargo then enclosed ventilation may be a requirement.
12. Health hazards of any particular parcel of cargo.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 168
Tanker cargoes 169
13. Reactivity with water, air or other commodities.14. What emergency procedures must be applicable in the event of contact
or spillage.
The chemical data sheets of respective cargoes usually provide all of theabove along with additional essential information for the safe handling andcarriage of the commodity.
The protection of personnelThe hazards of the chemical trade have long been recognized and the needfor personal protection of individuals engaged on such ships must be con-sidered as the highest of priorities. A chemical cargo can be corrosive anddestroy human tissue on contact. It can also be poisonous and can enter thebody by several methods. It may be toxic and if inhaled damage the brain,the nervous system or the body’s vital organs. Additionally, the chemicalmay give off a flammable gas giving a high risk of fire and explosion.
The IMO (IBC) Code requires that personnel involved in cargo oper-ations aboard chemical carriers be provided with suitable protection byway of clothing and equipment, which will give total coverage of the skinin a manner that no part of the body is left exposed (i.e. chemical suits).
Protective equipmentProtective equipment to include:
1. full protective suit manufactured in a resistant material with tight-fit-ting cuff and ankle design
2. protective helmet3. suitable boots4. suitable gloves5. a face shield or goggle protection6. a large apron.
Where the product has inhalation problems for individuals then the aboveequipment would be supplemented by breathing apparatus (B/A).
Where toxic cargoes are carried, SOLAS requires that the ship should carrya minimum of three (3) additional complete sets of safety equipment, overand above the SOLAS ‘74 requirements.
Safety equipment setSafety equipment set shall comprise:
1. a self-contained B/A (SCBA)2. protective clothing (as described above)3. steel core rescue line and harness4. explosive-proof safety lamp.
An air compressor, together with spare cylinders, must also be carriedand all compressed air equipment must be inspected on a monthly basisand tested annually.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 169
170 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Where toxic chemical products are carried, all personnel on board thevessel must have respiratory equipment available. This equipment musthave adequate endurance to permit personnel to escape from the ship inthe event of a major accident.
Associated operations
Heating of cargoesCertain cargoes are required to be carried and/or discharged at high tem-peratures and to this end, heating while inside the ship’s tanks must takeplace. Heating is usually provided by either heating coils inside the tanksthemselves or, in the case of double-hull vessels, by heating channels on theoutside of the tanks. The medium used is either steam, hot water or oil, butcare must be taken that the medium is compatible with the cargo.
Tanks that contain chemicals, which could react with each other, must notbe on the same heating circuit. Another safety factor is that a heat exchangermust be used between the boiler and the cargo system. This would preventthe possibility of the cargo product finding its way into the ship’s boilers, inthe event of a leak occurring in the system.
IG systems with chemical cargoesIG, usually nitrogen, is used to blanket some cargoes. These are usually onesthat react with air or water vapour in the atmosphere. They are loaded intotanks after they have been purged with IG and the tank must remain inerteduntil cleaning has been completed. Other cargoes have the ullage spaceinerted either as a fire precaution or to prevent reactions, which, while notnecessarily dangerous, may put the cargo off specification. The nitrogen issupplied by a shipboard generator or from ashore, or from storage cylinders.
Precautions during loading, discharging and tank cleaningIn addition to the usual safety precautions for tanker practice, if handlingtoxic cargoes full protective clothing, including B/A, should be worn by allpersons on deck. Goggles should be worn when handling cargoes which maycause irritation to the eyes. Such vessels are generally equipped with decon-tamination deck showers together with escape sets for each crew member.
Tank cleaning After discharge of the majority of cargoes, the tanks canbe washed out with salt water as a first wash, then finished with a freshwater wash. Stainless steel tanks are usually washed only with fresh waterbecause of damage, which may be incurred to the steelwork by use of seawater. Washing is often assisted by one of a range of cleansing compounds,which can be sprayed onto the tank sides and then washed off. One of theadvantages of double-hull construction is that all the stiffening members ofthe tanks are on the outside of the tank and cleaning and drainage is there-fore much easier.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 170
Tanker cargoes 171
Some special chemicals may require special cleaning procedures and solv-ent use, and extreme care should be taken that mixtures created are not of adangerous nature. Similarly, if washing into a slop tank a dangerous mix-ture of unknown chemical properties should not be generated.
Fire fightingFire-fighting arrangements are similar to that aboard petroleum tankers,with the exception that nitrogen is commonly employed as a smotheringagent because some cargoes would be incompatible with CO2. Ships are there-fore generally supplied with an adequate supply of nitrogen. Ordinaryfoam breaks down when used on water-soluble chemicals so a special alcohol-foam is required – so named as being suitable for fires involvingalcohol. In addition, large fixed dry powder plants may be provided for useon the tank deck. Some specialized cargoes require specific fire-fightingtechniques and relevant details can be obtained from the shore authorities,prior to loading.
Note: Many cargoes give off harmful vapours when burning and fire parties are advisedto ensure that they wear protective clothing and B/A when fighting chemical fires.
CompatibilityGreat care must be taken during the cargo planning stage to ensure thatchemicals that react with one another do not come into contact. Such plan-ning is often a shore-based operation which is checked by the Ship’s Masteror the Chief Officer prior to the commencement of loading.
Chemicals must be located in an appropriate tank according to the IMOCode, and at the same time be compatible with the tank coating as specified inthe tables provided by the tank-coating manufacturers. Incompatible cargoesmust have positive segregation, and failure to observe such requirementscould give rise to a most hazardous situation involving toxics or flammablegas being given off as a by-product.
Additionally, some mixtures of chemicals may react together, but equallysome are potentially dangerous on their own. Those that react with air canbe contained by IG, or provided with vapour return lines as previouslydescribed. However, some react with water (e.g. ‘sulphuric acid’) and mustbe loaded in double-skin tanks.
A number of chemicals are self-reactive, in the sense that they may poly-merize with explosive violence or cause a generation of considerable heat.Examples of these are ‘vinyl acetate’ or ‘styrene monomers’. If shipped,these have an inhibitor added, but care must be taken with all monomers toensure that no impurities are introduced, which may act as a catalyst andcause polymerization. Accidental heating with such cargoes should also be avoided.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 171
172 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Volatile cargoesSuch cargoes of a volatile nature must not be stowed adjacent to heated cargoes. The possibility of flammable or toxic vapour release could lead toan after affect which could lead to disastrous consequences should thevapour reach the deck area.
Cargo-handling referenceMost shipping companies have prepared their own operational and safetymanuals but most are based on the International Chamber of Shipping(ICS) Tanker Safety Guide for Oil Tankers and Terminals (ISGOTT). Thiscontains an index of chemical names, including synonyms. Cargo informa-tion from data sheets for the most common chemicals is also included.Checklists are now also commonly employed to ensure correct proceduresare observed throughout all cargo operations.
Merchant Shipping NoticesMerchant Shipping Notices stress the danger from asphyxiation and/oraffects of toxic or other harmful vapours. They also strongly advise on theentry procedures into tanks and enclosed spaces alongside the Code of SafeWorking Practice (CSWP). Notices emphasize the need for continuousmonitoring of the vapour with gas detectors and the necessity of providingadequate ventilation when personnel enter enclosed spaces. Full proced-ures must include the use of a stand by man at the entrance of an enclosedspace while personnel are inside that space.
Compatibility tablesThere are various compatibility tables available, but perhaps the most widelyapplied are the USCG – Bulk Liquid Cargoes Guide to the Compatibility ofChemicals. A hazardous reaction is defined as a binary mixture which produces a temperature rise greater than 25°C or causes a gas to evolve.
The cargo groups for the two chemicals under consideration are firstestablished from an alphabetical listing, then cross-referenced in the com-patibility table; unsafe combinations being indicated by an ‘X’, and reactiv-ity deviations within the chemical groups by the letters ‘A’ to ‘I’.
IMO/IBC codeThe International Code for the Construction and Equipment of ShipsCarrying Dangerous Chemicals in Bulk and Index of Dangerous ChemicalsCarried in Bulk are clearly the main recognized authority regarding thebulk chemical trade. It is recognized as the definitive source of names forproducts subject to Appendices II and III of Annex II of MARPOL 73/78.
IMO/IGC codeThe International Code for the Construction and Equipment of ShipsCarrying Liquefied Gases in Bulk. Applicable to all ships regardless of size,inclusive of those vessels under 500-tonne gross, which are engaged in thecarriage of liquefied gases having a vapour pressure exceeding 2.8 bar
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 172
Tanker cargoes 173
absolute temperature of 37.8°C, and other products as appropriate underChapter 19 (of the code), when carried in bulk.
(Exception: vessels constructed before October 1994 to comply withResolution MSC. 5(48) adopted on 17 June 1983).
Bulk liquefied gas cargoesThe liquefied gases which are normally carried in bulk are hydrocarbongases used as fuels or as feed stocks for chemical processing and chemicalgases used as intermediates in the production of fertilizers, explosives,plastics or synthetics. The more common gases are LPGs, such as propane,butane, propylene, butylene, anhydrous ammonia, ethylene, vinyl chloridemonomer (VCM) and butadiene. LNG is also transported extensively indedicated ships (Figure 5.26), LNG being a mixture of methane, ethane,propane and butane with methane as the main component.
Gas propertiesLiquefied gases are vapours at normal ambient temperatures and pressures.The atmospheric boiling points of the common gases are given as follows:
LPG Propane �42.3°CButane �0.5°CLPG propylene �47.7°CButylene �6.1°C
Fig. 5.26 Two LNG carriers lie alongside each other outside the Dubai DryDock Complex. These dedicated ships are prominent by the conspicuous cargo
domes covering the gas tanks.
{
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 173
174 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Ammonia �33.4°CEthylene �103.9°CVCM �13.8°CLNG �161.5°CButadiene �5.0°C
The carriage of gases in the liquid phase can only be achieved by lower-ing the temperature or increasing the pressure or a combination of both lowtemperatures and increased pressures.
The carriage condition is classified as either: ‘fully refrigerated’ (at approx-imately atmospheric pressure) or ‘semi-refrigerated’ (at approximately 0 to �10°C and medium pressure) and fully pressurized (at ambient tem-perature and high pressures).
LNG and ethylene are normally always carried in the fully refrigeratedcondition – they cannot be liquefied by increasing the pressure alone –while the LPGs, ammonia, VCM and butadiene can be liquefied by lower-ing the temperature or increasing the pressure. This permits them to be carried in the fully refrigerated, or the semi-refrigerated or the fully pressur-ized condition. The IMO/IGC Code provides standards for ‘gas tankers’and identifies the types of tanks which must be employed for the carriageof liquefied gases (Figure 5.27).
Water ballast
Water ballast
Spray shield
Drip tray
Stiffenedsupport skirt
Insulation
LNG tank
InsulationProtectivesteel dome
Fig. 5.27 Gas tank construction (spherical tanks). Fully refrigerated sphericalLNG tank, the protective steel dome protects the primary barrier above theupper deck (no secondary barrier). Double-hull construction required in way of
all cargo tank spaces.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 174
Tanker cargoes 175
● Integral tanks – tanks which form part of the ships hull● Membrane – non-self-supporting, completely supported by insulation● Semi-membrane – non-self-supporting and partly supported by insulation● Independent tanks – self-supporting tanks not forming part of the ships
hull, independent tanks being subdivided into Types A, B and C.
Integral membrane and semi-membrane tanks are designed primarilywith plane surfaces. Of the independent tanks, both A and B can either beconstructed of plane surfaces or of bodies of revolution, Type C is alwaysconstructed of bodies of revolution.
Note: Prismatic tanks (fully refrigerated), carrying cargo at atmospheric pressure,require a primary and secondary barrier to resist undetermined design stresses. Thespace between the primary and secondary barriers is known as ‘hold space’ and is filledwith IG to prevent a flammable atmosphere in the event of cargo leakage.
Hazards of gas cargoesHazards associated with gas cargoes are from fire, toxicity, corrosivity, reactivity low temperatures and pressure.
Gas carrier types
Gas carrier profileThe more recent builds of LPG carriers include double-hull structure withvaried capacity. Up to 100 000 m3 cargo capacity, is no longer unusual –while LNG construction of 250 000 m3 using self-supporting, prismatic-shaped tanks requiring less surface space than the normal construction ofspherical ‘Moss’ tanks are under construction with IHI Marine UnitedShipbuilders (LNG carriage at �162°C and essentially at atmospheric pres-sure). Cargo boil-off with LNG is used as fuel for the ships propulsion sys-tem in some cases or vented to atmosphere (Figure 5.28).
Fig. 5.28 The LPG carrier ‘Scott Enterprise’ lies port side to a gas storage terminal.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 175
176 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fully pressurized carriersThese tankers are normally constructed to the maximum gauge pressure at the top of the tank. In all cases, the design vapour pressure should not be less than the maximum, allowable relief valve settings (MARVs) of thetank. This corresponds to the vapour pressure of propane at �45°C, themaximum ambient temperature the vessel is likely to operate in. Reliefvalves blow cargo vapour to atmosphere above this pressure. Cargo tanksare usually cylindrical pressure vessels. Tanks below deck are constructedwith a dome penetrating the deck on which all connections for the loading,discharging, sampling and gauging for monitoring pressure and tempera-ture are placed. Pumps are not normally installed on this type of ship, thecargo being discharged by vapour pressure above the liquid. No vapourreliquefaction facilities are provided.
Semi-refrigerated carriersThis type of vessel is normally designed to carry the full range of LPG andchemical gases in tanks designed for a minimum service temperatureof �48°C and working under design pressure. Simultaneous carriage of different cargoes is usually possible. The ships are generally installed withdeepwell cargo pumps to facility discharge. If delivery is required intopressurized shore storage units, these deep-well pumps operate in serieswith booster pumps mounted on deck. Cargo heating using sea water is the usual practice. Vapours produced by heat are drawn off into a relique-faction unit and the resultant liquid is returned to the tank. This actionmaintains the tank pressures within limits.
Fully refrigerated carriersCargo tanks are usually designed for a minimum service temperatureof �50°C and a maximum design pressure.
Discharge of the cargo is achieved by using deepwell pumps or sub-merged pumps. Unlike the deepwell pumps, the submerged pump assem-bly, including the motor, is installed in the base of the tank. As a result, it iscompletely immersed in cargo liquid. Booster pumps and cargo heatingmay also be installed for discharge into pressurized storage. Reliquefactionplant is also installed on board for handling boil-off vapours. Fully refriger-ated carriers now have capacities up to 250 000 m3.
Fully refrigerated ethylene tankersThe majority of liquid ethylene tankers can carry the basic LPG cargoes as well. Ethylene cargoes are normally carried at essentially atmosphericpressure. Product purity is very important in carriage and care must betaken during cargo operations to avoid impurities, such as oil, oxygen, etc.Reliquefaction plant is also provided on these ships.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 176
Tanker cargoes 177
Gas operational knowledgeOne of the main operational features of working on ‘gas carriers’ is theawareness of personnel to what is and what is not a gas-dangerous space.This is given by the following definition:
● A gas-dangerous space, or zone is a space in the cargo area which is notarranged or equipped in an approved manner to ensure that its atmos-phere is at all times maintained in a gas – safe condition.– Further: an enclosed space outside the cargo area through which any
piping containing liquid or gaseous products passes, or within whichsuch piping terminates, unless approved arrangements are installed toprevent any escape of product vapour into the atmosphere of that space.
– Also: a cargo containment system and cargo piping.– And: a hold space where cargo is carried in a cargo containment sys-
tem requiring a secondary barrier; a space separated from a holdspace described above by a single gas-tight steel boundary; or a cargopump room and cargo compressor room; or a zone on the open deck,or semi-enclosed space on the open deck, within 3 m of any cargo tankoutlet, gas or vapour outlet, cargo pipe flange or cargo valve or ofentrances and ventilation openings to cargo pump rooms and cargocompressor rooms.
– The open deck over the cargo area and 3 m forward and aft of the cargoarea on the open deck up to a height of 2.4 m above the weather deck.
– A zone within 2.4 m of the outer surface of a cargo containment systemwhere such surface is exposed to the weather; an enclosed or semi-enclosed space in which pipes containing products are located. A spacewhich contains gas-detection equipment complying with Regulation13.6.5 of the IGC Code and space-utilizing boil-off gas as fuel andcomplying with Chapter 16 are not considered gas-dangerous spacesin this context.
– A compartment for cargo hoses; or an enclosed or semi-enclosed spacehaving a direct opening into any gas-dangerous space or zone.
● A Gas-Safe space is defined by a space other than a gas-dangerous space.
The deepwell cargo pumpAdvantages of the deepwell cargo pumps are (Figure 5.29):
1. high speed, high efficiency and high capacity pumps2. compact in construction when installed in either the vertical or horizon-
tal position3. choice of power/drive – electric, steam, hydraulic or pneumatic4. self-flooding5. automatic self-priming and eliminates stripping problems6. easy vertical withdrawal for maintenance purposes7. easy drainage, essential on hazardous cargoes
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 177
178 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
8. tolerance of contaminates in fluid (no filters)9. improved duty regulation and performance
10. air and vapour locks.
Disadvantages include being suspended, the pump can create constructionproblems during installation and requires essential rigid bracing supportswithin the tank, in order to prevent swaying. It also has a long drive shaftwhich is subject to vibration and torsional stresses.
Stuffing boxDischarge line
Checkvalve
Air/gasrelease vent
pipe
Dischargeline
Pump drive shaft
Auto prime valves
Top pump bowl
Pump element
Suction barrel
Main suction line
Pump suction strum
Fig. 5.29 The deepwell cargo pump.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 178
Tanker cargoes 179
Deepwell pumps must always be operated and handled in accordancewith the recommended operating procedures. The net positive suctionhead (NPSH) requirements of the pump must always be maintained to pre-vent cavitation and subsequent pump damage.
LNG carriersThe LNG vessels are normally custom-built for the trade and carriage of thecargo at �162°C and essentially at atmospheric pressure. It is usual forLNG boil-off to be used as fuel for the ship’s adopted main propulsion sys-tem and they subsequently are not always equipped with reliquefactionplant (Figure 5.30).
Fig. 5.30 LNG carrier. Profile of an LNG vessel seen lying at anchor off Gibraltar harbour. Prismatic tank design as opposed to the spherical tanks.
Cargo operations – safetyThree main safety aspects should be borne in mind when handling lique-fied gas:
1. Flammability of the cargo and the need to avoid the formation of explo-sive mixtures at all times
2. Toxicity of the cargo3. Low temperature of the cargo which could cause serious damage to the
ships hull.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 179
180 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
DryingOnce a vessel is ordered to receive a cargo of LNG following overhaul ordelivery trials, all traces of water must be removed from the tanks. If this isnot done, operating problems due to freezing may result. The dew point ofIG or air in equipment must be low enough to prevent condensation ofwater vapour when in contact with the cold surfaces. Purging with dry gasrefrigerated driers and dosing with methanol are not uncommon tech-niques for removing moisture.
InertingOnce cargo tanks and associated equipment are suitably dried, air must beremoved from the cargo system before loading to prevent the formation ofexplosive mixtures and also to prevent product contamination. Either IGfrom the ship’s IG generator or a nitrogen supply from shore may be used.IG from a shipboard IG generator is of a relatively low purity content incomparison with ‘pure’ nitrogen from a shoreside supply and usually willcontain up to 15% CO2 and 0.5% O2. This can lead to contamination prob-lems with cargoes, such as ammonia, butadiene, etc. To prevent explosivemixture formation, the oxygen content of the tank must be reduced to 6%for hydrocarbon gases and 12% for ammonia using IG or nitrogen.
PurgingWhen the cargo tanks are suitably inerted, cargo vapours may be intro-duced to purge the tank of inerts. If the inerts are not completely purgedfrom the tank, then operating problems will be encountered in the relique-faction plant operations. IG is incondensable and can therefore lead to highpressure in the plant condenser with associated difficulties. The cargovapours are introduced either at the top or bottom of the tank dependingon the density of the gas, and the vapour IG mixture is either ventedthrough the vapour return to the shore flare stack or, where local port regu-lations allow, to the ship’s vent stack.
Cooling of cargo tanksWhen about to load liquefied gases into tanks, which are essentially atambient temperature, it is important to avoid thermal stresses being gener-ated in the ship’s structure by incurring high temperature differences. Acorrect pre-cooling procedure should be adopted to make sure that the tankis brought down in temperature at a rate not exceeding 10°C/h. The mostcommon method of achieving this is to spray cargo liquid from ashorethrough the tank spray line situated at the top of the tank. This procedureis continued until liquid begins to form on the tank base. Cargo vapours areformed during this cooldown and are either returned through the vapourreturn line to the shore facility, or, more commonly, handled by the ship’sreliquefaction plant on board.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 180
LoadingWhen tanks have been cooled down, loading of the cargo can commence.Liquid is taken on board via the liquid crossover and fed to each tank throughthe liquid loading line; this line going to the base of each tank to avoid staticelectricity build-up. The loading rate is determined by the rate at which thevapours can be handled. Vapours are generated by: (a) flashing of warmliquid; (b) displacement and (c) heat in leak through the tank insulation.
The vapour may be either taken ashore for shoreside reliquefaction or han-dled by the ship’s own plant facility. During the loading operation, cargotanks must be loaded with regard to trim and stability of the vessel at alltimes. Cargo tanks must be fitted with high-level alarms to prevent overfilling.Loading rates should be reduced as the cargo levels approach desired values.
DischargingDischarging can be accomplished by several different methods dependingon the equipment which is available aboard the ship:
1. By use of a compressor alone: this is usually only associated with smallpressurized carriers. The cargo is pressurized from the tank using acompressor taking suction from another cargo tank or with a vapoursupply from ashore.
2. By compressor with booster pump on deck: the liquid over-pressured fromthe tank to the suction of the booster pump.
3. By means of deepwell pumps or submersible pumps: these are installed in thetank.
4. By deepwell pumps operating in series with booster pumps mounted on deck:this is required when discharging into pressurized or semi-pressurizedfacilities onshore and is carried out in conjunction with a cargo heaterfor heating the cargo.
An important feature when discharging cargoes is to remember that thecargo is a boiling liquid and will vaporize very easily under normal condi-tions. When the cargo has been discharged, the vapour remaining in thecargo tank is pumped ashore using the compressor, which would be subjectto the design vacuum of the tank.
Working gas cargoesCertificate of Fitness – an International Certificate of Fitness is required to becarried by any vessel engaged in the carriage of gases in bulk. The certifi-cate is valid for a period not exceeding five (5) years or as specified by theCertifying Authority from the date of the initial survey or the periodicalsurvey (Figure 5.31).
This certificate should be taken to mean that the vessel complies with theprovisions of the Section of the Code and is designed and constructed underthe International Provisions of 1.1.5 of the Code, and with the requirementsof Section 1.5 of the International Bulk Chemical Code.
Tanker cargoes 181
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 181
182 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
The certificate can be issued or endorsed by another government onrequest. No extension of the 5-year period of validity will be permitted. Itwill cease to be valid if the ship is transferred to another flag state. A newCertificate of Fitness is issued only when the Government issuing the newcertificate is fully satisfied that the ship is in compliance with the require-ments of 1.5.3.1 and 1.5.3.2 of the IGC Code.
Cargo conditioning while at seaDuring the loaded passage, heat inleak through the tank insulation willcause the cargo pressure and the temperature to rise. The ship’s reliquefac-tion plant should be used to maintain the cargo within the specified limits.In the event that malfunction occurs with the reliquefaction plant, thenrelief valves will blow vapour off to atmosphere via the ship’s vent stack.
Changing cargoesDepending on the nature of the cargoes it is often necessary to gas freecargo tanks before changing grades.
On completion of the discharge procedure there will always be a littlecargo liquid left in the tanks. It is important that this is removed before anygas freeing is attempted, 1 m3 of liquid forms 300 m3 of vapour (dependingon the substance), and this vapour formation could greatly extend the gas-freeing operation. The residual liquid is blown from the tank by means ofan over-pressure created by IG and the liquid is generally blown oversidewhile the ship is on a sea passage.
Fig. 5.31 The Monrovian Gas Tanker ‘Annabella’ seen starboard side to the Gas Terminal in Barcelona while engaged in gas cargo operations.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 182
Tanker cargoes 183
When the tanks and pipework are known to be liquid free the cargovapours are swept from the tank using IG or nitrogen.
The Charter’s requirements regarding product purity determine the pro-cedure to be adopted on changing cargoes. Some cargoes, such as VCM,may require visual tank inspection before they can be loaded.
Fig. 5.32 A loaded LPG carrier, at sea, passing outward bound from theBosporous and Black Sea Ports. Profile indicates prismatic tanks not spherical
tanks.
Fig. 5.33 Gas hose sited amidships aboard the LPG carrier ‘Scott Enterprise’.
Note: IG cannot be used when purging because of its high CO2 content either beforeloading or after discharging ‘ammonia’ cargoes. Ammonia would react with CO2 to formsticky white carbonates.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 183
184 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Tank entryThe same general safety requirements relating to tank entry in oil andchemical carriers apply equally to gas carriers.
Reliquefaction plantThe function of reliquefaction plants is to handle vapours produced by heatinflow to the cargo. They are basically a refrigeration plant and may bedirect where the vapours are taken through a vapour compression cycle orindirect where the vapours are condensed on refrigerated surfaces, such ascooling coils within or external to the tank (Figure 5.34).
The indirect cycle must be used for gases which cannot be compressedfor chemical reasons, e.g. propylene.
The direct cycle can be either single stage or two stages where the cargocondenser is seawater cooled.
Cascade cycle is where the cargo condenser is refrigerated using a suit-able refrigerant like Freon 22, within a separate direct expansion cycle.
Pump roomsTo reduce the risk of explosion, cargo compressors and booster pumps are sited in ‘pump rooms’, divided into at least two compartments withgas-tight bulkheads. The motor’s driving compressors are positioned onopposite sides of the bulkheads with the connecting drive shafts fitted withbulkhead seals. Integrity of seals must be monitored and maintained at all times.
ValvesCargo tanks are protected from over-pressure by relief valves which havesufficient capacity to vent vapours produced under the conditions. Whereliquid can be trapped between closed valves on pipework sections, liquidrelief valves are fitted to protect against hydraulic pressure developing onexpansion.
Liquid and vapour connections on tank domes and crossover are fittedwith valves having quick closing actuators for remote operations. Theseactuators are, in addition, all interlocked with an emergency shutdown system with emergency operational buttons sited throughout the ship.
InstrumentationGas carriers are fitted with a gas detector system which continually moni-tors for cargo leakage. Sampling points are located, for example in void
Note: Pump rooms are considered as ‘enclosed spaces’ and as such the full procedures forsafe entry into enclosed spaces must be adopted by personnel, as per the CSWP. They arealso equipped with emergency escape B/A (EEBA) and full emergency fire-fighting appa-ratus is readily available.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 184
Tanker cargoes 185
(a)
(b)
(c)
Compressor 1st stage Compressor 2nd stage
Sea water
Cargo tank
Condenser
Compressor 2nd stage
Condenser
Freon 22 compressor
Sea water
Freon 22 receiverExpansion valves
Cargo tank
Condenser
Condenser
Sea water
Expansion valveCargo tank
Compressor
Expansion valve
Fig. 5.34 Reliquefaction plant. (a) Direct cycle – cascade system; (b) direct cycle – single system and (c) direct cycle – two stage.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 185
186 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
spaces, pump rooms, motor rooms and control rooms, etc. The analyserwill alarm on any sampling point reaching 30% of the LEL. In addition,portable gas-detection equipment is provided as describes under oil cargoes.
Fire fightingUnder the IMO Gas Code, gas carriers must be fitted with a water spraysystem capable of covering such areas as tank domes, manifolds, etc.
Gas carriers must also be fitted with a fixed dry chemical powder system,actuated by IG under pressure having at least two hand-held nozzles con-nected to the system.
Entry into enclosed spacesThe reader should make additional reference to the Code of Safe WorkingPractice for Merchant Seaman (MCA publication), regarding the topic ofmaking entry into an enclosed space. A ‘Permit to Work’ should also beobtained and a risk assessment completed prior to any person entering anenclosed space.
By definition, an enclosed space is one that has been closed or unventil-ated for some time; any space that may, because of cargo carried, contain-ing harmful gases; any space which may be contaminated by cargo or gasesleaking through a bulkhead or pipeline; any store room containing harmfulmaterials; or any space which may be deficient of oxygen.
Examples of the above include chain lockers, pump rooms, void spaces,CO2 rooms, cofferdams and cargo stowage compartments.
Any person intending to enter such an enclosed space must seek correctauthorization from the Ship’s Master or Officer-in-Charge. Entry would bepermitted in accord with the conditions stipulated by a ‘Permit to Work’ forentry into enclosed spaces. The Senior Officer would also complete a riskassessment prior to entry taking place and all safety procedures must bemonitored by an appropriate safety checklist.
A suggested line of action for permitted entry into enclosed compart-ments is suggested as follows:
1. Obtain correct authorization from the Ship’s Chief Officer.2. Ensure that the space to be entered has been well-ventilated and tested
for oxygen content and/or toxic gases.3. Check that ventilation arrangements are continued while persons are
engaged inside the tank space.4. Ensure that a rescue system and resuscitation equipment are available
and ready for immediate use at the entrance to the space.5. Persons entering have adequate communication equipment estab-
lished and tested for contact to a stand-by man outside the enclosedspace.
6. A responsible person is designated to stand by outside the space to bein constant attendance while person(s) are engaged inside the space
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 186
Tanker cargoes 187
(function of the stand-by individual is to raise the alarm in the eventthat difficulties are experienced by those persons entering the space).
7. Ensure that the space to be entered is adequately illuminated prior toentry and that any portable lights are intrinsically safe and of an appro-priate type.
8. Regular arrangements for the testing of the atmosphere inside thespace should be in place.
9. A copy of the ‘Permit to Work’ must be displayed at the entrance of thespace to be entered.
10. Prior to entry, all operational personnel must have been briefed onwithdrawal procedures from the space, in the event that such action isdeemed necessary.
Note: When the atmosphere inside an enclosed space is known to be unsafe, entry shouldnot be made into that space.
Where the atmosphere in the compartment is suspect, the followingadditional safety precautions should be adopted with the use of ‘B/A’:
11. Ensure that the wearer of the B/A is fully trained in the use of the B/A.12. Thorough checks on the B/A equipment must be made and the ‘mask
seal’ on the face of the wearer must be a proper fit.13. The stand-by man should monitor the times of entry and exit of all
personnel to allow adequate time for leaving the enclosed space.14. Rescue harness and lifeline must be worn.15. If the low pressure whistle alarm is activated the wearer must leave the
space immediately.16. In the event of communication or ventilation system breakdown,
persons should leave the space immediately.17. Operational personnel should never take the mask of the B/A off when
inside the space.18. The function of the stand-by man is only to raise the alarm if necessary.
He should not attempt to affect a single-handed rescue with possibleconsequences of escalating the incident.
19. Emergency signals and communications should be clarified and under-stood by all affected parties.
20. A risk assessment must be completed by the Officer-in-Charge to takeaccount of the items covered by the safety checklist, the age and experi-ence of the personnel involved, the prevailing weather conditions, thereliability of equipment in use, the possibility of related overlap of addi-tional working practices ongoing, the technical expertise required to com-plete the task and the time factor of how long the task is expected to take.
In all cases of enclosed space entry, the use of protective clothing, suitablefootwear and the need for eye protection must be considered as an essentialelement of any risk assessment.
Chap-05.qxd 3/3/05 9:43 AM Page 187
Chapter 6
Specialist cargoes – timber,refrigerated and livestock cargoes
IntroductionThe shipping world is actively engaged in trading in virtually every com-modity. Many such cargoes fall into specific categories like the container, orthe Roll-on, Roll-off (Ro-Ro) trades, and are easy to collate together under asingle title or group. However, when attempting to gather all cargoes underone roof so to speak, there is bound to be the odd product that falls outsidethe norm.
Such cargoes as timber and refrigerated (reefer) and livestock could bediscussed to fill a book in their own right. However, the outline of suchproducts falls within the scope of this text which is meant to provide theCargo Officer with the means to make an educated judgment as to therights and wrongs of the stowage of these cargo types.
It should be appreciated that cargo-handling methods have changed con-siderably over the years and the container and Ro-Ro trades have greatlyaffected quantities of raw products that were previously carried in openstow. No more so than in the refrigerated trades in foodstuffs and perish-able goods, many of which are now shipped in refrigerated container unitsor freezer Ro-Ro trucks.
Timber products in the form of sawn timber in pre-slung bundles or logscan be stored above or below decks. Wood flooring, packaged or palletsmay be shipped alongside wood pulp. Such is the variety of timber cargoes.The securing of timber deck cargoes, and the concern for ship securityagainst water absorption is always of concern to a Ship’s Master. Timberabsorbs great quantities of water at a high deck level, while it burns off tonnesof fuel from low-situated tanks, and could dramatically affecting the ship’smetacentric height (GM) and destroy the positive stability of the vessel.
Concern with the specialist cargo must be exercised at all times. It is theduty of the Deck Officer to ensure that not only is the interest of the shipperto be taken account of, but also that of the shipowner, and the well-being ofthe crew/passengers must be of a high consideration.
Chap-06.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 188
Specialist cargoes – timber, refrigerated and livestock cargoes 189
Definitions and terminology of specialized cargoesAbsorption – as associated with timber deck cargoes, an allowance madefor weight of water absorbed by timber on deck which could have a detri-mental affect on the ship’s positive stability.
Cant – means a log which is slab-cut; i.e. ripped lengthwise so that theresulting thick pieces have two opposing, parallel flat sides and, in somecases, a third side sawn flat.
CSWP for Ships Carrying Timber Deck Cargoes (IMO 1991) – the Code of SafeWorking Practice for the Carriage of Timber Deck Cargoes Aboard Ship.
Freon 12 – is a chlorofluorocarbon (CFC) used as a refrigerant in reeferships. It is due to be phased out by the Montreal Protocol and is expected tobe replaced by a gas (R134a) which has less ozone depletion potential(ODP) and a less greenhouse potential (Freon 22 has already been used inplace of Freon 12).
Livestock – a term which describes all types of domestic, farm and wild animals.
Pit props – are straight, short lengths of timber of a cross-section suitable forshoring up the roof in a coal mine.
Reefer – is an expression meant to portray a refrigerated carrier.
Timber – should be taken to mean any sawn wood, or lumber, cants, logs,poles, pulpwood and all other types of timber in loose or packaged forms.The term does not include wood pulp or similar cargo.
Timber deck cargo – means a cargo of timber carried on an uncovered part ofa freeboard or superstructure deck. The term does not include wood pulpor similar cargo.
Timber lashings – all lashings and securing components should possess abreaking strength of not less than 133 kN.
Timber loadline – a special loadline assigned to ships complying with certainconditions relating to their construction set out by the InternationalConvention on Loadlines and used when the cargo complies with thestowage and securing conditions of this code.
Wood pulp – and similar substances are not included in the timber termin-ology as far as deck cargo regulations are concerned.
The air-dried chemical variety must be kept dry, as once it is allowed toget wet it will swell. This action could cause serious damage to the ship’sstructure and the compartment in which it is carried. To this end, all venti-lators and air pipes should be closed off to restrict any possibility of waterentering the compartment (stowage factor (SF) 3.06/3.34).
Chap-06.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 189
190 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Timber is generally shipped as logs, pit props or sawn packaged timber.The high SF of timber (1.39 m/tonne), generally indicates that a ship whoseholds are full with forestry products will often not be down to her marks.For this reason an additional heavy cargo like ore is often booked alongsidethe timber cargo. Alternatively, the more common method is to split thetimber cargo to positions both below and above decks.
Where timber forms part of the deck stow, some thought should be madeto route planning in order to provide a good weather route. Prudent selec-tion of a correct route could avoid prevailing bad weather and unnecessaryconcerns with the cargo absorbing high seawater quantities. The ship beingloaded from the onset with adequate GM and sufficient positive stabilitycould be directly affected in the event of shipping heavy seas in conjunctionwith timber deck cargoes.
Example
Timber is loaded in various forms with differing weights and methodsbeing employed. Package timber is generally handled with rope slingswhile the heavier logs, depending on size, are slung with wire snotters orchain slings.Battens – sawn timber more than 10 cm thick and approximately 15–18 cmwide. Usually shipped in standardized bundles and may be pre-slung forease of handling.
Boards – sawn timber boards of less than 5 cm thick but may be of anywidth.
Cord – a volume of 128 ft3 � 3.624 steres.
Deals – sawn timber of not less than 5 cm thick and up to about 25 cm inwidth. A ‘Standard Deal’ is a single piece of timber measuring1.83 m � 0.08 m � 0.28 m.
Fathom – (as a timber measure) equals 216 ft3 (6 ft � 6 ft � 6 ft).
Logs – large and heavy pieces of timber, hewn or sawn. May also bereferred to as ‘baulks’. Stowed above and below decks and individual logsmay need to be considered as ‘heavy lifts’ for the safe working load (SWL)of the cargo-handling gear being used.
Pit props – short straight lengths of timber stripped of bark and used forshoring up the ceilings of mines. They are shipped in a variety of sizes.
Stack – a measure of timber equal to half a ‘fathom’ and equates to 108 ft3.
Note: The metric unit of timber measure is known as a ‘Stere’ and is 1 m3 or35.314 ft3 or 0.2759 cords.
Timber cargoes
Chap-06.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 190
Specialist cargoes – timber, refrigerated and livestock cargoes 191
Stowage and lashing of timber deck cargoesRegulations for the stowage of timber emphasizes that timber deck cargoesshould be compactly stowed and secured by a series of overall lashings ofadequate strength. Where uprights are envisaged as part of the securing,these uprights should be not more than three (3) metres apart. The max-imum height of the timber stow above the uppermost deck must not exceedone-third of the ship’s breadth when the vessel is navigating inside a sea-sonal winter zone.
Additional regulations apply if and when timber loadlines are beingused; i.e. when the vessel is being loaded beyond the appropriate normalmarks. These regulations take account of timber being stowed solidly inwells at least to the height of the forecastle. If there is no superstructure, atthe after end of the vessel, the timber must be stowed to at least the heightof the forecastle. This stow must extend to at least the after end of the after-most hatchway.
A further consideration is that the securing lashings should not be lessthan 19 mm close link chain (or flexible wire rope of equivalent strength).These lashings shall be independent of each other and spaced not morethan three (3) metres apart. Such lashings will be fitted with slip hooks andstretching screws that must be accessible at all times. Note: Wire rope lash-ings must be fitted with a short length of long link chain to permit thelength to be adjusted and regulated (Figure 6.1).
Chain lashing or short lengthof chain if wire lashing
Stretching screwSlip which should nothave a straight tongue
Fig. 6.1 An example of securing lashings.
Additional referenceAdditional Reference should be made to Code of Safe Practice for ShipsCarrying Timber Deck Cargoes, 1991.
Lashing pointsThe lashings over timber cargoes are secured to eye plates attached to thesheer strake or deck stringer plate at intervals not exceeding more than 3 mapart. The end securing point to be not more than 2 m from a superstructure
Chap-06.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 191
192 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
bulkhead, but if there is no bulkhead, then eye plates and lashings are to beprovided at 0.6 and 1.5 m from the ends of the timber deck stowage posi-tion. If the timber is in lengths of less than 3.6 m, the spacings of the lash-ings are to be reduced. Figures 6.2 and 6.3 indicate some of these points.Access to parts of the vessel fore and aft must be possible and when a cap-acity deck cargo is carried a walkway over the cargo is generally constructed.
Aft deck walkway Fore deck walkway
Timber deck cargo
1.5 m from the end
0.6 m from the end
End lashings not more2 m from the bulkhead
Lashings(not more than 3 m apart)
Lashings(not more than 3 m apart)
Fig. 6.2 Lashings over timber cargo deck stow.
Stowage of logsThe Code of Safe Practice for Ships Carrying Timber Deck Cargoes (AppendixC) provides general guidelines for the underdeck stowage of logs.
Prior to loading logs below decks the compartment should be clean andhold bilges, and lighting tested. A pre-stow loading plan should be prepared
1 m
1 m wide Uprights 1.5 m apart
380 mm
230 mm
380 mm
Fig. 6.3 Example walk way construction.
Chap-06.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 192
Specialist cargoes – timber, refrigerated and livestock cargoes 193
considering the length of the compartment and the various lengths of thelogs to be loaded.
Recommendations are that logs should be stowed in the fore and aftdirection in a compact manner. When loading, they should not be in aswinging motion and any swing should be stopped prior to lowering intothe hatch. The heaviest logs should be loaded first and extreme pyramidingshould be avoided as much as possible (Figure 6.5).
Fig. 6.4 Packaged timber being loaded onboard ship. Reproduced with kindpermission from Everard and Sons, Dartford.
Chap-06.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 193
194 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
If void spaces exist at the fore and aft ends of log stows these may befilled with athwartships stowed logs. Logs loaded in between hatch coam-ing areas should be stowed as compact as possible to maximum capacity ofthe coaming space.
Logs are heavy and oscillations can expect to cause ship damage. Person-nel are advised to maintain a careful watch during the loading/dischargingperiods.
Packaged timberPacked timber will usually be banded and may be pre-slung. Packages maynot have standard dimensions and may have different lengths within thepackage, making compact stowage difficult. Uneven packages should notbe loaded on deck and are preferred to be loaded below decks. Where deckstowage is made the packages should be stowed in the fore and aft, length-wise position (Figure 6.4).
Refrigerated cargoesThe increase in container and Ro-Ro trades has, to some extent, broughtabout the demise of the conventional ‘reefer’ ship (one that was dedicated
Fig. 6.5 Stowage and the Working of Timber Cargoes. A cargo of logs stowedunderdecks in twin hatches, being discharged by multi-fold lifting purchase.Wire snotters are used to manoeuvre the logs to allow slings to be passedunder, prior to discharging. Slings are often left in situ after loading to easedischarge but not always. Sawn bundles of lumber are seen stowed at the hatch
side as deck cargo.
Chap-06.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 194
Specialist cargoes – timber, refrigerated and livestock cargoes 195
to carry refrigerated and chilled cargoes in its main cargo-carrying com-partments), the compartments being constructed with insulation to act asvery large giant refrigerators. Some of these vessels still operate, particu-larly in the ‘Banana Trade’, but generally the cost of handling cargoes intoreefer ships has become uneconomic.
Refrigerated cargoes mainly fall into the category of foodstuffs by way ofmeat, dairy products, fruit, poultry, etc. as a high degree of cleanliness isexpected throughout the cargo compartments. Prior to loading such prod-ucts, the spaces are often surveyed and in virtually every case pre-cooling ofdunnage and handling gear has to be carried out. Bilge bays must be cleanedout and sweetened, and the suctions tested to satisfaction. Brine traps shouldalso be cleaned and refilled, brine traps serving a dual purpose by prevent-ing cold air reaching the bilge areas and so freezing any residual waterwhile at the same time preventing odours from the bilges reaching intocargo compartments.
Compartment insulationAll compartments are insulated for the purpose of reducing the load on therefrigeration plant and reducing heat loss from the compartment. It also pro-vides time for engineers to instigate repairs in the event that machinery fails.
Qualities of a good insulation material are that it:
1. should not absorb moisture2. should not harbour vermin3. should be fire resistant4. must be odourless5. should be low cost and available worldwide6. should be light for draught considerations7. should not have excessive settling levels as this would require re-packing8. should have strength and durability.
Examples in use include: polyurethane, plastics (PVC), aluminium foil,cork granules and glass wool.
Refrigeration plantRefrigerated cargoes, other than those specifically carried in container orRo-Ro units, will be carried under the operation of the ship’s own refriger-ation plant. Cargo Officers are expected to have a working knowledge ofthe hardware involved with this cooling plant, and the ramifications in theevent of machinery failure.
The majority of refrigeration plants in the marine environment operate onthe ‘vapour compression system’ (absorption refrigeration systems are gen-erally not used in the marine environment because they need a horizontalplatform).
Figure 6.6 shows a direct expansion, grid-cooling system. A refrigerant likeFreon 12 (C CL2 F2) in its gaseous form is compressed, then liquefied in thecondenser. It is then passed through into the grid pipeline of the compartment
Chap-06.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 195
196 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
via the regulator valve. As it passes through the pipes it expands, extract-ing the heat from the compartment and producing the cooling effect. Itsoperation is based on the principle that the boiling and condensation pointsof a liquid depend upon the pressure exerted on it, e.g. the boiling point ofcarbon dioxide (CO2) at atmospheric pressure is about � 78°C, by increas-ing the pressure the temperature at which liquid CO2 will vaporize is raisedaccordingly.
Condenser Evaporator
Regulator
Compressor
Refrigeratedcompartment
Supplies latentheat necessary tocause change ofstate from liquid togas of refrigerant
Fig. 6.6 Operation of a vapour compression refrigeration system.
In the past, many refrigerants have been employed in marine refriger-ation plants including CO2, ammonia and more recently the Freon’s, butdue to depletion of the ozone layer, more refined products are taking overfrom Freon 12.
Each refrigerant has specific qualities but the popular ones are those having least ODP and less greenhouse potential. It is non-poisonous, non-corrosive and requires only a low working pressure to vaporize and isprobably the main one used in any remaining dedicated reefer vessels.
Qualities of a good refrigerant1. A high thermal dynamic efficiency is required2. Low cost3. Low working pressure and low volume4. Non-toxic, non-inflammable and not explosive5. Easily available worldwide6. High critical temperature7. High value of latent heat8. Non-corrosive.
Chap-06.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 196
Specialist cargoes – timber, refrigerated and livestock cargoes 197
Refrigeration plant – monitoring systemIn order to protect cargoes, continual monitoring of the refrigeration machin-ery is considered a necessity. This can be achieved by the introduction of a‘Data Logging System’ to the relevant machinery and to the adjoining com-partments. With such a system in operation there is less likelihood of dam-age because an earlier warning system would be activated giving moretime to provide corrective action before valuable cargoes are effected byloss of the cooling element.
Sensors and transducers monitor the following points:
1. Temperatures of the cargo compartment2. Temperature of the fan outlet, discharge air3. Brine temperatures entering and leaving the evaporator4. Compressor suction and compression discharge5. Seawater temperature6. External air temperature.
Feedback of the sensed parameters are transmitted to either the cargo con-trol room, the engine control station or the navigation bridge (alarm circuitsbeing established to 24 hour manned stations).
Principal refrigerated cargoes and respective carriage temperatures
Product Carriage temperature
Meats: Frozen beef About �10°C (15°F).
Frozen lamb/or mutton From about �8° to �10°C (15° to 18°F).
Frozen pork About �10°C (15°F).
Offal and sundries Carried at as low a temperature as possible and (includes hearts, not more than � 10°C (15°F).kidneys, livers Usually carried in bags or cases. Any of which sweetbreads, tails are blood-stained should be rejected.and tongues)
Chilled beef Loaded at about 0–2°C, and carried atabout � 1.5°C (29–29.5°F), unless instructed otherwise by the shipper.
Note: Chilling meat only slows the decomposition process down and itremains in prime condition for about 30 days. This period could be extendedby about 15 days if a 10% concentration of CO2 is introduced into thecompartment, assuming the compartment can be sealed and theenvironment is safe to permit such action.
Poultry Packed in cases and carried at �10°C to �12°C (10–15°F).
Dairy products
Butter Liable to taint and should not be stowed alongside other strong smelling cargoes in the
Chap-06.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 197
198 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
same compartment, e.g. fruit. Generally packedin cartons. Carriage temperature about �10°C(15°F).
Cheese Carriage temperature varies but generallycarried at 5–7°C average. Usually stowed ondouble dunnage.
Shell eggs Stored in cases and liable to taint. Normally notstowed above 10 cases high with air circulationchannels on top of 50-mm dunnage. Carriagetemperature 1°C (33°F).
Liquid eggs Carried in tins at temperatures not over �10°C(15°F).
Bacon Stow on double 50-mm dunnage, do notoverstow. Carrying temperature �10°C(15°F).
Fish Shipped in boxes or crates and should bestowed on 50-mm dunnage. Fish has atendency to rapid deterioration, and should becarried at a low a temperature as possible,which should not exceed �12°C (10°F).
FruitsFresh fruits are generally carried in cardboard cartons or wood boxes, withventilation holes. They can often be carried in non-refrigerated spaces onshort haul runs Good ventilation must generally be given to prevent aconcentration of CO2 build-up. CO2 must not be allowed to build up over 3%concentration as this would cause deterioration of the cargo. Frequent airchanges are recommended to avoid this.
Apples Carriage temperature will vary with the variety of apple but is usually in the rangeof �1–2°C.
Pears Should not be stowed in the samecompartment as apples. Carriagetemperature �1°C to 0°C (30–32°F).
Grapes, peaches, plums Carriage temperature �1°C to 2°C (31–35°F).
Oranges Oranges must have adequate ventilation asthey are very strong smelling and thecompartment must be deodorized aftercarriage. Carrying temperature 2–5°C (36–41°F).
Lemons Similar to oranges. Carrying temperature 5–7°C(41–45°F).
Grapefruits Similar stow to oranges. Carriage at about 6°C(44°F).
Chap-06.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 198
Bananas The banana trade is specialized and special shipsare built for the purpose. Many of which usecontainers. The carriage temperature is critical astoo low a temperature can permanently arrestthe ripening process. Daily inspection of acompartment would be carried out and any fruitfound to be ripe is removed. One ripe banana ina compartment can cause an acceleration of theripening process throughout the compartment.Carriage temperature usually about 12°C(52–54°F).
The ‘reefer’ tradeIt should be realized that many of the said cargoes are now shipped by refrig-erated containers or Ro-Ro cold units. Some companies still operate desig-nated refrigeration vessels like those employed by ‘Lauritzen Cool’ engagedon the New Zealand to the US West Coast meat service.
Other specialized parcels, like some drugs, often require refrigeratedstowage and the instructions as to the carriage temperature would be issuedby the shipper.
Prior to loading any refrigerated cargoes it is normal practice for a surveyorto inspect the compartment for cleanliness and to ensure that the compart-ment temperatures are correct. Dunnage and any cargo fitments would bepre-cooled and machinery would be tested to satisfaction. Cooled gas andchemical cargoes are referred to in Chapter 5.
Refrigerated container unitsLloyds Register have developed ‘Rules for the Carriage of RefrigeratedContainers in Holds’. These standards take account of the problem of heatemanating from an on-line refrigeration plant operating below decks in thecargo hold. The heat energy rejected by each unit is from the evaporatorfans, the motor and the condenser. Concern for this rejected heat energyinto the surrounding air of the hold is currently considered a problem thatmay or may not be resolved by improved ventilation methods.
The container sector of the industry is exploring ways to carry increasednumbers of reefer units below decks. However, such increase would gener-ate increased temperatures into the cargo space areas. An effective ventila-tion system would probably aim to retain the hold temperature as close aspossible to the outside air temperature or a predetermined temperature tosuit the internal hold environment.
The majority of refrigerated containers employ insulation, usuallypolyurethane, within the prefabricated construction of the container. Thisdirectly affects the heat transmitted through the insulated unit between thecarriage temperature and the external ambient air temperature. Althoughthe insulation will reduce the actual payload capacity of the unit, it is seenas a necessary trade off.
Specialist cargoes – timber, refrigerated and livestock cargoes 199
Chap-06.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 199
200 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
ExampleCarriage temperatures for a 40-ft container:Bananas 13.0°CChilled apples 2.0°CFrozen �18.0°CDeep frozen �29.0°C
Various ventilation systems operate throughout the industry. The one illus-trated in Figure 6.7 is a semi-sealed louvred exhaust duct system. A verticalducting fitted with an air supply fan delivers supply air to each stack ofcontainers, specifically to each container condenser. The exhaust systemoperates in a similar manner, with the exception that the fan is an extractionfan as opposed to a supply fan. Isolation valves or flaps could be fitted toisolate ‘cells’ when not in use, each cell having its own inlet and outlet duct-ing (at time of writing modelled format only).
Closedlouvres
Openlouvres
Exhaustvent
Exhaust fanand outlet
Container
Container
Container
Fig. 6.7 Refrigerated Container – Hold Ventilation System.
The carriage of livestockThe carriage of animals, either domestic, farm or from the wild, is not anuncommon practice. The carriage is governed by the regulations laid downby the Ministry of Agriculture and Fisheries. Further advice can also beobtained from various animal protection societies who give advice on cagesize, crates, etc. for use with animals.
Chap-06.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 200
Where large numbers of animals are to be carried – like sheep or cattle –designated livestock carriers are available. The ships tend to discharge thebeasts directly into penned, quarantine areas. While in transit the animals arekept in pens or stalls which are protected from adverse weather and the sun.
Adequate straw and fodder would also be carried. The feeding and water-ing of animals would be to the shipper’s instructions. It is not unusual for a shipper to send a supervisory attendant where large numbers of animalsare carried or where specialist animals like valuable race horses are carried.If no attendant is carried, members of the crew would be designated to takecare of the animals during the passage, cleaning stalls and feeding, etc.
Where one or two animals are carried by a non-designated vessel, theyare usually carried in horse box-type stalls, or in caged kennels. These aregenerally kept on a sheltered area of the upper deck away from the prevailing weather. Each animal would be tallied and allotted a carriagenumber. In the event of the animal dying on passage, this number must berecorded. All vessels carrying livestock must carry a ‘humane killer’ withenough ammunition to be considered adequate.
Where a regular livestock trade is featured, like Australia/Middle Eastregions, shore facilities for loading and discharging are regularly inspectedby the country’s authorities. Ministry officials also inspect the cleanlinessand the facilities aboard designated livestock carriers.
Documentation inclusive of veterinary certificates is usually shippedwith the animal(s) together with routine welfare instructions. Whenlanded, documentation is usually landed at the same time being handed tothe shipper’s representative or quarantine officials.
Specialist cargoes – timber, refrigerated and livestock cargoes 201
Chap-06.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 201
Chapter 7
Roll-on, Roll-off operations
IntroductionSome time after the start of containerization came a cargo revolution in thedoor-to-door service of Roll-on, Roll-off (Ro-Ro) handling procedures. TheRo-Ro traffic provided a shuttle service for containers as well as cuttingdelivery times to hours rather than weeks, previously experienced withconventional shipping. The Ro-Ro explosion was so great that ports changedtheir operations and ship design started to incorporate new concepts, tohandle large vehicles.
The coastal traffic saw a new lease in life which opened up numerousavenues, in employment, cargo-handling methods, service industries andmanufacturing. Ferry companies increased their tonnage maximums in acomparative blink of an eye. Port exports climbed beyond previous records,with Ro-Ro activity being the main cause. Ro-Ro was an efficient and cheapmethod of shipping merchandise which was quickly realized and expandedrapidly beyond anyone’s wildest expectations.
The ship’s new design included the stern door/ramp, open vehicle deckspaces, drive through capability with the bow visor. Vehicle lifts became afeature with open and enclosed deck cargo spaces. Units could be carryingliquid or dry cargoes, they could be refrigerated or not, as their load required.However, the most important fact was that they could be delivered in theshortest period of time.
The time factor was critical to ensure that goods reached markets in apristine condition. Especially relevant to fresh produce like flowers, fruits,dairy foods, meats, etc. The ships were enhanced to ensure that deadlineswere achieved. Ships docking in and out carrying such cargoes could notbe delayed by the need for tugs. Bow/stern thrusters became essential fea-tures of ship design. Thruster units came alongside twin Controllable PitchPropellers, while Masters were given Pilotage Exemption Certificates. Notonly were the vessels fast, but also the procedures and concepts of shiphandling had been changed to meet the needs of the trade.
The Ro-Ro trade has now become an essential segment of the shippingindustry. Although it might be seen as the new boy on the block, it isalready alongside the tanker traffic, the cruise trade and greatly attached to
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 202
Ro
ll-on
, Ro
ll-off o
peratio
ns
203
Fig. 7.1 Ro-Ro shipping. A typical Ro-Ro ferry the ‘Stena Leader’ (previously European Leader andex-Buffalo, P&O Ferries) departs the Port of Fleetwood for her regular twice-daily voyage to Ireland.The vessel carries about 140 mobile units (40-ft container size) on three vehicle decks. The ship also
accommodates a limited number of unit drivers.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 203
204 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
the container business. The sector ships everything that was once shippedby general cargo vessels. These cargoes include hazardous goods, as well asheavy-lift units. The main difference is that such items are controlled byseparate legislation and generally move with less bureaucracy (Figure 7.1).
Ro-Ro definitions and terminologyFreight only Ro-Ro ship – a Ro-Ro vessel with accommodation for not morethan 12 (driver) passengers.
High-speed craft – a craft capable of a maximum speed, in metres per second(m/s). Equal to or exceeding 3.7V � 0.1667 where V � displacement corres-ponding to the design waterline (m3).
Passenger car ferry – a passenger or ferry ship which has Ro-Ro access of suf-ficient dimensions to allow the carriage of Ro-Ro Trailers and/or Ro-RoPassenger (Ro-Pax)/Ro-Ro Cars (Figure 7.2).
Reefer unit – a mobile/vehicle Ro-Ro unit, designed and capable of carryingrefrigerated cargoes.
Fig. 7.2 Diagram of passenger car ferry.
Right of ferry – an exclusive right to convey persons or goods (or both)across a river or arm of the sea and to charge reasonable tolls for the service.
Ro-Ro cargo space – a space not normally subdivided in any way and extend-ing to either a substantial length or the entire length of the vessel in whichgoods are carried (packaged or in bulk), in or on rail or road cars, vehicles(including road or rail tankers), trailers, containers, pallets demountabletanks in or on similar stowage units or other receptacles, can be loaded andunloaded normally in a horizontal direction.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 204
Roll-on, Roll-off operations 205
Roll-on Roll-off vessel – a vessel which is provided with horizontal means ofaccess and discharge for wheeled, tracked or mobile cargo (Figure 7.3).
Fig. 7.3 The modern face of Ro-Pax type vessels. High-speed catamaran or tri-maran hulls with vehicle access from a stern ramp. Generally engagedon the short sea trades around the world, operating at service speeds up to
45 knots.
Short international voyage – an international voyage in the course of which a ship is not more than 200 nautical miles from the port or place in whichpassengers and crew could be placed in safety. Neither the distancebetween the last port of call in the country in which the voyage begins andthe final port of destination, nor the return voyage, shall exceed 600 naut-ical miles. The final port of destination is the last port of call in the sched-uled voyage at which the ship commences its return voyage to the countryat which the voyage began.
Special category space – any enclosed space, above or below the bulkheaddeck intended for the carriage of motor vehicles with fuel in their tanks fortheir own propulsion, into and from which such vehicles can be driven andto which passengers have access (Figures 7.4–7.7).
Vehicle rampsThe design of Ro-Ro vessels is influenced from the onset of the design stage bythe nature of the payload it is intended to transport. Generally, the cargo flow,securing and handling equipment can amount to about 5% of the lightweight
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 205
206 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 7.4 Modern Ro-Ro (freight only) vessel. The ‘MYKONO’ a modern Greekoperated Ro-Ro vehicle ferry. Design features include all accommodationforward, with twin Port and Starboard smoke stacks seen aft either side of theupper vehicle deck. The stern door/combined vehicle ramp is positioned right
aft in the upright closed position while the vessel is at sea.
Stern door/rampOption bow visor Internal ramp
to upper cargo deck Chainlocker
Engine room
Bow thrust compartmentWater ballast
• Open deck stowage of Ro-Ro cargo either side of the engine room smoke stack.
• Chain locker at the ships sides either side of the fore and aft line to facilitate the operation of separate Port and Starboard windlass operations.
• Bow visor option to permit drive through capability and is not always featured.
• Lift to lower cargo hold may be mechanical or of hydraulic operation.
• All cargo ramps are fitted with wheel tread, anti-skid, steel grips.
• All cargo decks are fitted with insert star lashing points and/or star domes.
• Accommodation for twelve (12) driver/passengers.
Lift Cargo hold
CargoDoor
Cargo
Fig. 7.5 General arrangement – modern Ro-Ro ferry (freight only) 1900-mlane length.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 206
Roll-on, Roll-off operations 207
Fig. 7.6 Ro-Ro ferry example. Stern door/ramp access into the enclosed vehicledeck of a Ro-Pax ferry operating in the Mediterranean Sea.
Fig. 7.7 The bow visor of the passenger vessel ‘Jupiter’ (since renamed) seenin the open position against the skyline. The bow visor fitted with a stern ramp
access permits a drive through capability.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 207
208 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
tonnage. However, to avoid operational problems in the future such fittingsneed to take account of the types of rolling cargo which is anticipated.Commercial vehicles are limited to about six types (unlike military vehicles)and these need to be accommodated by respective access widths, rampslopes, clearing heights, lane lengths, turning areas or drive through facilities.
Similarly, shoreside receptions must be compatible with a ship’s facil-ities. Ramp slopes and break angles, for commercial traffic, will generallyfall at about 1 : 8 or 1 : 10 in order to avoid the vehicle grounding while intransit from the ship to the shore. Where tidal waters are present and averagerise or fall is expected, floating shore links or adjustable link spans tend toovercome excessive tidal movement, while at the same time keeping thebreak angle with the ship’s ramp manageable (Figure 7.8).
Entering flapsBridge flaps
Stern door/ramp
Car deck ramp
Entering flaps
Casing
Car deck
Quay
Quay
Door/ramp closed
Pull-up
cylinder
Upper deck
Car deck ramp in working position
Parked positionCar deck/ramp
Car deck ramp hoisted
Fig. 7.8 Example stern door and vehicle ramp arrangement.
The design of equipment will be to the requirements of Lloyds Registeror similar Classification Society, but would include specific features to sat-isfy operational needs. In order to match these needs and provide a suitableend product, a designer would include the following features:
1. Length of ramp (overall)2. Width of ramp (overall)
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 208
Roll-on, Roll-off operations 209
3. Total load on ramp (anticipated maximum)4. Maximum axle loads5. Hinging arrangement (top, bottom or guillotine)6. Number of ramp sections and hinges within the structure7. Maximum/minimum operating angles8. Watertight sealing/securing arrangements9. Cleating/locking arrangements
10. Power requirements (electric, hydraulic) with limitations11. Operational lifting/lowering times12. Supporting and preventor arrangements13. Roadway landing area.
Many stern ramp arrangements open up all the transom to provide max-imum width and height clearance. This effectively gives wide access to avariety of vehicles of differing lengths with comparative short load/dis-charge times involved. Other designs have employed stern quarter ramps(with or without bow quarter ramps). Such ramps are still required to meetthe design criteria of the Classification Society but must also satisfy designfeatures to meet specific vehicle traffic like ‘car carriers’ (Figure 7.9).
Ramps tend to be manufactured in steel with ‘Chevron Pattern’ anti-skidbars on the working surface. They are usually operated by twin hydraulic
Visor operatingcylinder
Top hinged bulkhead doorWatertight and part of thecollision bulkhead
Ramp cylinder
Deck
Visor
Hydraulic lock
Bow door/rampQuay maximum height
Internal link
Flaps
Quay
Fig. 7.9 Bow visor with combination inner bow door and vehicle ramparrangement.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 209
210 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 7.10 Stern door of a Ro-Pax ferry seen in the stowed, closed position asshe turns off the berth in the harbour at Tangier.
Fig. 7.11 The Ro-Pax ferry ‘Sanasa’ of the Comarit Ferry Group enters Tangierharbour. The vessel is fitted with a bow visor and stern/ramp door.
cylinder actions or winch arrangement. Watertight integrity is achievedwith hydraulic pressure cleating in conjunction with a hard rubber seal, with the hinge arrangement being positioned above the waterline(Figures 7.10 and 7.11).
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 210
Roll-on, Roll-off operations 211
Internal ramps and elevatorsThe current generation of Ro-Ro vessels have moved into multi-deck con-struction with a totally enclosed main vehicle deck with access from either
Fig. 7.12 An internal ramp that can tilt both forward and aft to suit stern loadand/or bow discharge. It allows loading to a higher deck level ‘three’ where thelower hold level would be termed ‘No. 1 Deck Level’ and ‘No. 2 Deck Level’
would be considered as the main, largest of the three vehicle decks.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 211
212 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
a stern ramp or bow door arrangement. This deck is often fitted with elevator access to a lower hold while an internal ramp to a partially coveredupper vehicle deck, which permits access to the higher, uppermost continu-ous deck (Figures 7.13 and 7.14).
Fig. 7.13 Cargo doors. Upper deck hydraulic cargo door set in the bridge frontand leading to an enclosed upper vehicle deck aboard a modern Ro-Pax ferry.Weather sealing of the door takes place against hard rubber seals with hydrauliccleating and positive pressure held on operational rams. When in the openposition the door is locked with hydraulic securings and rams are fitted with
non-return valves to prevent accidental closing.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:50 AM Page 212
Roll-on, Roll-off operations 213
Internal cargo operations – Ro-Ro vesselsVehicles require wide open deck space to be able to manoeuvre. Such deck areas are lane marked to ease vehicle stowage and alignment of mixed types of vehicles, e.g. private cars and commercial trucks. The deckareas are always well-illuminated by overhead lighting and fitted withextraction fans to change the air volume 10 times every hour. Such atmos-phere replenishment prevents the build of exhaust gases from drive-on,drive-off operations.
Cargo vehicle decks are protected by sprinkler and/or water-drenchingsystems and well provided for with fire extinguishers at every 40 m length.Such protection dictates that the decks must also be fitted with an adequatedrainage system to clear residual waters quickly (Figure 7.15).
Vessels without ‘bow visor’ facilities are generally denied drive throughcapabilities and usually must provide sufficient deck space to permit theturning of wagons ready for stern discharge at the arrival port. Vehicledecks have always been considered as a hazardous environment for bothshore and shipboard personnel, especially where vehicles are turning. Tothis end speed of vehicles is strictly controlled by stowage marshals whousher units into designated lane spaces. With this in mind deck spaces areclearly sign painted to reflect basic instructions to driver personnel andcar/passenger travellers (Figure 7.15).
Fig. 7.14 Example vehicle deck of the enclosed cargo compartment of a high-speed passenger vehicle ferry operating in the Irish Sea region of the UKcoastline. Steel pillars support aluminium upper decks and the internal, angledramp is seen at the upper right-hand side of the view. The deck structures are
manufactured in unpainted aluminium to save increased weight.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 213
214 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 7.15 Typical bulkhead markings prominently displayed around vehicledecks to ensure safe and efficient loading of vehicle lanes.
Fig. 7.16 Ro-Ro traffic trailer units, parked on the dock side at Liverpool readyfor loading on to P&O, Irish sea ferries. Trailer units being lifted by mechanical‘tugs’ and deposited on the vehicle decks of short sea ferries then similar ‘tugs’
attach to discharge the unit at the destination port.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 214
Roll-on, Roll-off operations 215
Ventilation systemIt is a requirement that Ro-Pax vessels carrying more than 36 passengersmust be provided with a powered ventilation system (fans) sufficient togive 10 air changes per hour in spaces designated to carry vehicles (withfuel in their tanks for their own propulsion). If the vessel carries less than36 passengers then the venting system need only provide six air changesper hour.
Ventilation ducting serving such spaces should be constructed in steel,and the system should be completely separate from other ventilation sys-tems aboard the vessel. It must be capable of being controlled from outsidethe vehicle spaces and be operable at all times when vehicles are occupyingthe specific areas.
Note: Where special category spaces are employed, the administration may require anadditional number of air changes when vehicles are being loaded or discharged.
Ventilation systems must be fitted with rapid means of shut down, in theevent of fire occurring. They must also have a means of monitoring any lossor reduction in the venting capacity with such data being indicated on the‘navigation bridge’.
Drainage systemsThe hazards of slack water on large vehicle decks and the subsequent lossof stability which could occur are well known. The fixed pressure waterspraying system, installed for fire prevention, if operated, could cause anaccumulation of water on vehicle deck or decks. To ensure adequate stabil-ity at all times a suitable drainage system must be installed to effect rapiddischarge of slack water.
Scuppers should be fitted to ensure discharge directly overboard. Specialcategory spaces situated above the bulkhead deck, and in all Ro-Pax vesselswhich have positive means of closing scuppers by valve action, must keepsuch valves open while the vessel is at sea in accord with the ‘loadline convention’.
In the case of special category spaces, the administration may requireadditional bilge pumping and drainage facilities over and above the speci-fications of Safety of Life at Sea (SOLAS), Regulation II-1/21.
Bilge pumping arrangementsCargo ships and passenger vessels are required to have in place an efficientbilge pumping system, capable of pumping from and draining any water-tight compartment. Passenger Ships are required to have at least three (3)power pumps connected to the bilge main.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 215
216 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Cargo (vehicle) definitionsA vehicle – defined as a vehicle with wheels or a track laying vehicle.A flat-bed trailer – defined as a flat-topped open-sided trailer or semi-trailerand includes a roll trailer and a draw-bar trailer.Freight vehicle – defined as a vehicle which is a goods vehicle (flat-bedtrailer) (road train) (articulated road train) combination of freight vehiclesor a tank vehicle.A semi-trailer – defined as a trailer which is designed to be coupled to asemi-trailer towing vehicle and to impose a substantial part of its totalweight on the towing vehicle.A tank vehicle – defined as a vehicle fitted with a tank which is rigidly andpermanently attached to the vehicle during all normal operations of loading,discharging and transport and is neither filled nor discharged on board anddriven on board by its own wheels.Reefer unit – container box unit fitted with refrigeration plant. Employed totransport frozen/chilled produce by road and sea. Power for the freezerunit is generated by the drive motor of the unit when on the road and sup-plied from the ship’s supply while the vessel is at sea. (Special stowagespace is required for reefer units to ensure that they are positioned aboardthe ferry close to a power supply connection.)
Fig. 7.17 Long load (sail for wind turbine) is loaded on adjustable stretchload trailer unit.
Ro-Ro vehicle typesThe majority of freight vehicles engaged in Ro-Ro vessels vary in size andtype for the shipment of cargoes, both dry goods and liquids. Probably the
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 216
Roll-on, Roll-off operations 217
most widely used is the drop trailer vans (40-ft container box/van stowedon a horse or trestle and the rear wheels of the unit). Other varieties include:
Curtain-sided trailersSemi-trailer without sideboards (drop sides)Semi-trailer with sideboardsSemi-trailer with sideboards and hood coverFully enclosed goods vehicleOpen flat-top truckFlat-top truck with canvas-covered loadArticulated trailerRoad tankerFramed container/tankFreight container (20 � 8 � 8)Freight container (400 � 8 � 8)Draw-bar combination (two units)Draw-bar combination (three units)Refrigerated (reefer) vansLow loaders (for heavy machinery/plant)Adjustable (stretch) low loader (for exceptional long loads) (Figure 7.17).
Additional private vehicles such as coaches, furniture removal vans, buses,caravans, boats on trailers, military transports, etc. are also regularly shipped.Freight units of one kind or another, once discharged, may be reloaded butnot in every case. Many units are often returned by the same ferry or a sistervessel in an empty state (Figures 7.18 and 7.19).
Fig. 7.18 Ro-Ro, unit types. Several Ro-Ro units on the quayside in Cadiz,Spain. From left to right: a flat-top trailer unit, a 40-ft container carrier, with twoarticulated container carriers on the end. A mobile tank container trailer unit
is seen in the background.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 217
218 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Vehicle stowage and securingIt is essential with vessels-carrying vehicles that a stable deck is maintainedand this is why virtually all Ro-Ro ferries are now built with stabilizers ofone form or another. However, cargo movement can still expect to occur invery rough sea conditions even when stabilization systems are operational.To this end individual vehicles are secured by various means to preventmovement at sea.
The stowage/securing arrangements of units should be supervised by aresponsible Ship’s Officer assisted by at least one other competent person.Vehicles should, as far as possible, be aligned fore and aft, with sufficient dis-tance between vehicles so as to allow access through the vehicle deck. Theparking brake on each vehicle/unit should be applied and where possiblethe unit should be placed in ‘gear’. Where drop loads or uncoupled units arebeing carried these should be landed on trestles or equivalent support, priorto being secured by chain or other suitable securing constraint (Figure 7.21).
Upper hook to vehicle
Loadbinder bartensions chainbetween deckposition and vehicle
Lower hook secured intostart point at deck level
Fig. 7.19 Example of a chain lashing.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 218
Roll-on, Roll-off operations 219
All vehicle/cargo units should be secured prior to the vessel leaving theberth and such securings should be at the master’s discretion to be mosteffective. While on route these lashings should be regularly inspected toensure they remain effective during the time at sea. It should also be realizedthat personnel so engaged on vehicle deck inspections should take extremecaution against injury from swaying vehicles. As such, Masters may feel itappropriate to alter the ship’s course while such inspections are ongoing toreduce the motion on the vehicle deck.
Vehicles stowed on slanting decks should have the wheels ‘chocked’ andthe hand brakes observed to be on and working. Suitable lashings againstthe incline should be secured and the unit left in an opposing gear. Anyvehicle which is lashed should be secured at the correct securing points sodesigned on the vehicle and at the deck position.
All lashings applied whether of a ‘hook’ type or other variety should besecured in such a manner that in the event of them becoming slack, they areprevented from becoming detached. They should also be of a type which willpermit tensioning in the event of them becoming slack during the voyage.
Note: Lashings are considered to be most effective at between 30° and 60° to the deckline. Alternatively, additional lashings may be required. Crossed lashing should, wherepractical, not be used, as limited restraint against ‘tipping’ is experienced with this styleof securing.
Lashings should only be released once the ship is secured at the berthand personnel so engaged should take care when clearing securings. Thesemay be under high tension following transit and cause injury if releasedwithout forethought.
Note: Cargo units must be loaded, stowed and secured in accord with the Ship’s CargoSecuring Manual, as approved by the Authority. (This Cargo Securing Manual isrequired to be carried aboard all types of ships engaged in the carriage of all cargoes, withthe exception of bulk cargoes.)
Unit securing – chain lashingsRo-Ro units are secured in accordance with the Cargo Securing Manual ofthe vessel. In some short sea voyages, during the summer season and witha predominantly good weather forecast, units may not even be securedother than by the hand brakes and left in gear. However, at the Master’sdiscretion, chain lashings could be applied by the crew if and when circum-stances dictate that securing becomes necessary.
In virtually all cases, hazardous units would automatically be chaineddown. Chain lashings vary but tend to have a common theme of being ableto be applied between a deck ‘star’ lashing point and the unit itself, thentensioned by a load-binding lever.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 219
220 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Such lashings can be secured and tensioned quickly, and lend to laboursaving. The number of lashings per unit will be variable, depending on theweight and size of the vehicle. However, a standard 40-ft unit would usu-ally be fitted with a minimum of six (6) lashings.
Vehicle decks are built with star lashing points or ‘elephants feet’ typeanchor points. Lashings will have a club-foot fitting into these points, witha hook at the opposite end. Alternatively, as shown in Figure 7.19, hooks ateach end.
Ro-Ro ship stabilityModern Ro-Ro shipping has experienced some painful losses over the years,the most notable being the Herald of Free Enterprise (1987) the Estonia (1994)and more recently the Tricolour (2003) with 2800 cars, and the Hyundia No.105 (2004) with more than 4000 vehicles on board. Clearly, the losses andsubsequent salvage operations have rocked the marine insurance marketsgenerating tighter legislation to cause improved conditions on Ro-Ro vessels.
Improvement features now include the following:
1. The stability of the vessel must be assured as adequate, with the maindeck flooded to a depth of 50 cm of water.
2. Cargo-loading computers must have a direct link to the shoreside administration.
3. The vessel must be fitted with automatic draught gauges.4. All access points to inner compartments must be monitored by Close
Circuit Television (CCTV) and have light open/shut indicators dis-played to the navigation bridge.
5. Increased drainage facilities must be fitted to vehicle decks.6. Individual units must be weighed and respective kg measured ashore
for transmission to the Vessel’s Cargo Officer (Figure 7.20).
Double axlewheels held byair brake
Drop van
Six point chainlashings
Weight-bearing trestle
Fig. 7.20 Drop unit stowage.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 220
Roll-on, Roll-off operations 221
Inherent dangers associated with Ro-Ro vesselsThe ships themselves generally have high freeboards and expect to experi-ence high windage over and above the waterline. Cargo units are by neces-sity loaded with a high kg value, which can be detrimental to the overallmetacentric height (GM). In the event of bad weather conditions, these fea-tures tend to lend to the vessel rolling heavily, which may generate unitsshifting.
To improve these conditions most Ro-Ro vessels are equipped with stabi-lizer units of either the fin varieties (fixed or deployable) or tank sluice sys-tems or a combination of both tanks and fins. Tank systems are extremelyuseful when loading/discharging, as they tend to keep the vessel uprightthroughout cargo operations. Provided over reliance on mechanical systemsdoes not allow complacency to permit the vessel to list over, because it iscoupled with imprudent loading schedules.
Fig. 7.21 Wheeled trestle is positioned under the unit before being detachedfrom the motor tug. Trestles fitted with spring-loaded wheels to permit easy
manoeuvring under the cargo unit.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 221
222 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
If the vessel is allowed to list the vehicle ramp(s) are likely to becometwisted. This may cause damage to the ramps themselves but will inevitablystop all cargo units passing over the ramps.
Passenger and cargo terminalA Ro-Pax Ship is a Passenger Ship with Ro-Ro cargo spaces or special cat-egory spaces as defined by SOLAS Regulation II-2/3 (Figure 7.22).
Fig. 7.22 Ro-Pax ferries seen in operation at the Dover Sea Terminal.
Ship-to-shore access Ro-Ro terminal features
Link spansAccess to Ro-Ro vessels must be capable of landing vehicles at all states oftide and, in order to operate successfully, the shipboard end of the linkmust be able to adjust for the rise and fall of the tidal conditions prevailing.A hoist structure with associated lifting machinery is built at the shipboardend of the link to allow movement of the span to suit the rise of tide and thefreeboard of respective vessels (Figures 7.23 and 7.24).
High-speed craftThe image of the Ferry World has changed considerably over the lastdecade. The sleek lines of mono- and multi-hull craft now operate as Ro-Pax vessels all over the world. They provide a fast and regular servicemostly on the short sea trades together with some more long-haul ventures(Figures 7.25 and 7.26).
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 222
Roll-on, Roll-off operations 223
Fig. 7.23 An example of the ship-to-shore, shore-to-ship access ‘link spans’which operate at the Dover Terminal. The upper enclosed passage is forpassenger transit, while the lower open top links accommodate car and truck
vehicle traffic.
PCCs and PCTCsThese vessels are designated to the carriage of cars. It was estimated that over 8.7 million new cars were transported in 2003, compared with 8.3 million in 2002, the main trade countries for such cargoes being Japanand South Korea. The ships are employed with multi-decks, side-loadingfacilities and internal ramps to facilitate high-speed-loading/dischargingrates.
The ships are designed with exceptionally high freeboards and as suchare susceptible to wind pressure causing considerable leeway, slowingservice speed and detrimentally affecting fuel burn. More recent designshave taken this into account, and the new generation car carriers have beenfitted with an aerodynamically rounded bow and bevelled along the bow-line with a view to reducing wind pressure from head winds. Six (6) PCCsoperating with MOL shipping are now in service with this design feature(Figure 7.27).
Large car carriers are shipping up to 6500 car units at any one time, usu-ally on a one-way trip, with limited prospects for return cargoes. With thisin mind a high ballast capacity is generally a main feature of their oper-ation. Where return cargoes are booked the Pure Car Carriers (PCCs) andPure Car Truck Carriers (PCTCs) have greater flexibility.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 223
224 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 7.24 Link span operation. A typical link span machinery housing forhoisting and lowering the link span down to a position above the waterline.The stern ramp of the Ro-Ro ferry then lowers her stern ramp onto the linksdriveway to permit discharge of vehicles. The rise and fall of tide of 10.5 m is countered by the adjustment of height to the link span to allow continuous
operations no matter what state of tide.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 224
Roll-on, Roll-off operations 225
Fig. 7.25 The high-speed Ro-Pax catamaran vessel ‘Millenium Dos’ seen load-ing vehicles via the stern access, lying port side to the terminal in Barcelona,
Spain.
Fig. 7.26 The Seacat Isle of Man, engaged on the Irish Sea trade betweenLiverpool and the Isle of Man carrying vehicles and passengers.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 225
226 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 7.27 The Huel Trotter car carrier manoeuvres with tug assistance foreand aft in the Port of Barcelona, Spain.
Features of the car carrier
Car carrier construction (Figure 7.28)Typical build features:
Gross tonnage 60 587 GT Panamax-sized vessel. Serviced by ship-to-shoreDraught 9.82 m ramps, one at the stern (Starboard Quarter)Air draught 52.0 m the other midships (beam on).Length O/A 121.08 m Also has an option to carry refrigeratedBreadth 32.23 m cargo on decks 5, 6 and 7 instead of doingService speed 21 kt the return voyage in ballast.
The multi-deck configuration of the car carrier is in itself a striking con-structional feature, the decks being interlinked by a fixed internal rampsystem and elevator to lower holds. Rates of movement of car units varydirectly with design but 1000 car equivalent units (CEUs) per eight (8) hourshift would not be unusual, the vessel turning round from empty, in a 48-hperiod.
Some decks are set at different heights to allow different head vehicles tobe carried, particularly relevant where high-sided trucks may become anoptional cargo. Other features of the same deck might also include higherand heavier structure to cater for the heavy-weight wheeled load. Somedesigns incorporate hoistable car decks offering alternative head room, asan added feature, providing additional flexibility to maximize cargo load.
A vehicle cargo mix tends to offer more options to shippers as well asbeing convenient in permitting direct dealing with a single carrier, thespeed of cargo operations being a direct influence for shippers and on the
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 226
Roll-on, Roll-off operations 227
ship’s running costs. Loading and discharge are generally achieved by aminimum of two vehicle ramps, one about the midships area while a sideloading, quarter ramp, has become a popular feature of many car carriersand/or PCCs and PCTCs.
Fixed deck loading is usually about 2 tonne/m2 throughout, though thismay vary where hoistable decks are engaged. Decks are fitted with forcedventilation fan systems to clear exhaust fumes during loading and dis-charge periods.
As stated previously, the main disadvantage of these ships is in their con-struction, producing very high-sided vessels which are subject to massivewind effect when in open aspect sea conditions. As such, they experienceconsiderable leeway which can generate increased fuel burn over a pas-sage. Some efforts in design features, like the rounding of the bow area andbevelled bowlines, has been incorporated in some of the latest builds in aneffort to increase fuel efficiency.
The ships tend to be fitted with a high ballast capacity because of the des-ignated trade not lending to full return cargoes per voyage, although somemutual exchange cargoes that are suitable for the design decks – like pal-letized cargo/fork lift or tractor loading – can sometimes be arranged(Figures 7.29 and 7.30).
The new car trade is generally predominant from South Korea, Japan,Europe and Scandinavia, routing to the Canadian, USA, European and
Car decks 1–12
Car deck 6
Car deck 1
Freeboard deck
Water ballasttank Fuel oil tanks
Water ballasttank
Car deck 8 Gas-tight deck
Car deck 10 Gas-tight deck
Upper deck
Fig. 7.28 Car carrier construction.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 227
228 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 7.29 A specialist unit load system. The ‘Republic Di Genova’ one ofGrimaldi’s car carrier vessels seen in the Falmouth Dry Dock.
Fig. 7.30 A specialist unit load system. The angled quarter ramp and accesspoint to vehicle decks of the above car carrier. These angled ramps have becomea popular feature of car carrier vessels and are often employed with a midsection
shell door ramp to improve the speed of load and discharge operations.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 228
Roll-on, Roll-off operations 229
Australian markets. The main car carrier companies are MOL, Hual, Grimaldiand Wallenius Wilhelmsen being amongst the largest companies operatingPCCs and PCTCs.
Note: Car carriers do not conform to conventional Ro-Ro regulations.
The BACAT: BArge CATamaranA double-hull catamaran shaped vessel which accommodates barges of upto about 140 tonnes. Barges are floated in from the stern and lifted from thewater tunnel between the hulls by an elevator system. Additionally the‘Lighter Aboard SHip’ (LASH) barges (375 tonnes) can be transported bythe water tunnel with a stern door being closed up after the completion of loading.
The LASH systemA lift-on, lift-off system where lighters are raised to the upper deck by meansof a moveable ‘gantry crane’. They are often loaded into holds or on deck ina similar manner to containers. Alternatively, they are operated on a similarprinciple as the floating dock, where the parent vessel is ballasted down andthe lighters are floated in via the stern, between the high-sided bulkheads.As the vessel de-ballasts, the barges are lifted into the transport.
The SeaBee: Sea bargeThis system uses barge units of about 800 tonnes deadweight which arefloated towards a stern elevator. An automatic transporter rolls under thebarge, when at the required deck level, it is carried forward to the desiredstowage position.
Note: LASH and SeaBee systems an also accommodate the carriage of containers.
Chap-07.qxd 3/3/05 9:51 AM Page 229
Chapter 8
Containers and containerization
IntroductionThe first recognized container vessel was a converted World War II Tanker,named the ‘Ideal X’ and owned by Pan Atlantic. Her first container voyageshipped 58 containers on specially rigged decks from Port Newark, NewJersey in April 1956. Malcom P. Maclean (1914–2001) a liner-shipping pio-neer, was probably the accepted founder of containerized traffic. He receivedthe ‘Admiral of the Ocean, Sea Award’ in 1984 from President Reagan and‘Lloyds List’ nominated him as one of the three most influential men of thetwentieth century, alongside Aristotle Onassis and Ted Arison.
The first fully ‘Cellular Container Ship’ was a converted cargo vessel, the‘Gateway City’, altered to carry 225 container units of 35 ft size. Her maidenvoyage was between the Mexican Gulf and Puerto Rico but dock labourrefused to work the vessel and the ship returned to the USA with her cargo.
Then the first transatlantic container line was started in 1966, and as theysay, the rest is history. Door-to-door service met a huge customer demandand revolutionized the shipping industry. Containerization has all butobliterated general cargo handling, as the industry once new it. By thetwenty-first century, nearly every commodity, apart from bulk productsand heavy lifts, could be ‘stuffed’ into a container.
The largest container ships are currently being built to carry just under10 000 TEU, and it must be anticipated that this barrier will soon be brokenand even larger vessels will join the world’s fleets. The system broughtwith it sister operations, like the Roll-on, Roll-off (Ro-Ro) system (seeChapter 7) which dovetailed with transhipping operations to feed themajor terminals. Both sectors of the industry thrive today as main line con-tributors to cargo movement.
List of relevant container definitions and termsAdministration – means that Government of a Contracting Party, underwhose authority containers are approved.
Approved – means approved by the administration.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 230
Containers and containerization 231
Approval – means the decision by the administration that a design type or acontainer is safe within the terms of the present convention.Cargo – is defined by any goods, wares, merchandize and articles of everykind whatsoever carried in the containers.Cell – defined by that space which could be occupied by a single verticalstack of containers aboard a container vessel. Each stowage/hatch spacewould contain multiple cells, each serviced during loading/discharging by‘cell guides’ (Figure 8.1).
Cell guide – a vertical guidance track which permits loading and dischargeof containers in and out of the ships holds, in a stable manner.Container – is defined as an article of transport equipment: (a) of a perma-nent character and accordingly strong enough to be suitable for repeateduse; (b) specially designed to facilitate the transport of goods, by one ormore modes of transport, without intermediate reloading; (c) designed tobe secured and/or readily handled, having corner fittings for these pur-poses; (d) of a size such that the area enclosed by the four outer bottom cor-ners is either: (i) at least 14 m2 (150 ft2) or (ii) at least 7 m2 (75 ft2) if it is fittedwith top corner fittings.
The term ‘container’ includes neither vehicles or packaging. However,containers when carried on chassis are included.Container spreader beam – the engaging and lifting device used by gantrycranes to lock on, lift and load containers.
Fig. 8.1 Empty cell guides numbered odd to starboard and even to port,situated at the fore end of the cargo container hold.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 231
232 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Corner fitting – is defined by an arrangement of apertures and faces at thetop and/or bottom of a container for the purposes of handling, stackingand/or securing.
Existing container – is defined as a container, which is not a new container.
Flexible boxship – a term which describes a container vessel designed withflexible length deck cell guides, capable of handling different lengths ofcontainers, e.g. 20, 30 and 40 ft units.
Gantry crane – a large heavy-lifting structure found at container terminalsemployed to load/discharge containers to and from container vessels.Some container vessels carry their own travelling gantry crane system onboard (Figure 8.2).
Hatchless holds – are defined as a container ship design with cell guides tothe full height of the stowage without separate or intermediate hatch topsinterrupting the stowage.
International transport – means transport between points of departure anddestination situated in territory of two countries to at least one of which thepresent (CSC) Convention applies. The present convention will also applywhen part of a transport operation between two countries takes place in theterritory to which the present convention applies.
Karrilift – trade name for a mobile ground-handling container transporter.There are many variations of these container transporters found in andaround terminals worldwide. Generally referred to as ‘Elephant Trucks’ or‘Straddle Trucks’.
Fig. 8.2 Gantry cranes engage in container cargo operations over the ‘ZimCalifornia’ berthed in Barcelona, Spain.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 232
Containers and containerization 233
Lashing frame/lashing platform – a mobile, or partly mobile, personnel carrierwhich lashing personnel can work on twist-locks at the top of the containerstack without having to climb on the container tops.Maximum operating gross weight – is defined by the maximum allowablecombined weight of the container and its cargo.Maximum permissible payload (P) – means the difference between the maxi-mum operating gross weight or rating and the tare weight.New container – is defined as a container the construction of which wascommenced on or after the date of entry into force of the present convention.Owner – means the owner as provided for under the national law of thecontracting party or the lessee or bailee, if an agreement between the par-ties provides for the exercise of the owner’s responsibility for maintenanceand examination of the container by such lessee or bailee.Prototype – means a container representative of those manufactured or to bemanufactured in a design type series.Rating (R) – see maximum operating gross weight.Safety approval plate – is described as an information plate which is perma-nently affixed to an approved container. The plate provides general operat-ing information inclusive of country of approval and date of manufacture,identification number, its maximum gross weight, its allowable stackingweight and racking test load value. The plate also carries ‘end wallstrength’, the ‘side wall strength’ and the maintenance examination date.Stack – a term when referring to containers, which represents the deckstowage of containers in ‘tiers’ and in ‘bays’ (Figure 8.3).
Fig. 8.3 The container stack on the deck of the ‘ZIM ANIKAH’ being dischargedby terminal ‘gantry cranes’ in the Port of Barcelona, Spain.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 233
234 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Tare weight – means the weight of the empty container including perman-ently affixed ancillary equipment.Terminal representative – is defined as that person appointed by the terminalor other facility where the ship is loading or unloading, who has responsi-bility for operations conducted by the terminal or facility with regard tothat particular ship.TEU – twenty feet equivalent unit. Used to express the cargo capacity of acontainer vessel.Type of container – means the design type approved by the administration.Type-series container – means any container manufactured in accordancewith the approved design type (Figure 8.4).
Loading containersThe order of loading, when the large container vessels are carrying cur-rently up to 10 000 TEU, must be well planned and considered as a detailedoperation. Planners are usually employed ashore to provide a practicalorder of loading, particularly important when the vessel is scheduled todischarge at two, three or more terminal ports.
Once loading in the cell guides is complete, the pontoon steel hatch covers, common to container vessels, are replaced and secured. Containers
Fig. 8.4 Working containers. The Mediterranean Shipping Company (MSC)Sintra lies starboard side to working containers by shoreside gantries in St John’s, Newfoundland container terminal. The ships own two container
cranes are turned outboard to permit access by the gantries.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 234
Containers and containerization 235
are then stowed on deck in ‘stacks’ often as high as six tiers. The overallheight of the deck stowage container stack may well be determined by theconstruction of the vessel. It must allow sufficient vision for bridge watch-keepers, to be able to carry out their essential lookout duties. The stabilitycriteria of the vessel, when carrying containers on deck, must also be com-patible with the stowage tonnage below decks.
Any deck stowage requires effective securing and this is achieved usu-ally by a rigging gang based at the terminal. As the ‘stack’ is built up, eachcontainer is secured by means of specialized fittings, between containersthemselves and to the ship’s structure.
Container transportA fully laden container vessel is unlikely to be loaded down to her loadlinemarks despite having a container stack on deck of three or four high.Containers may weigh up to about 30-tonne gross weight each, when fullypacked, but may also be empty. Hence a full capacity load may not neces-sarily equal the maximum permissible deadweight. If containers are car-ried on deck, they must be well secured by means of the iron rod lashingswith associated rigging screws, fixed as part of the ship’s structure. Emptyor light containers could be affected by buoyancy when seas are shipped,and Deck Officers should be especially diligent when checking the upperdeck stow and respective securings (Figures 8.6–8.11 and 8.19–8.22).
Owners code Serial number Check digit
Country code Size Type
Length(m)
Width(m)
Height(m)
GrossWeight
(kg)
TareWeight
(kg)
PayLoad (kg)
Usablecapacity
(m³)
Imperialsize(ft)
1590.30 30.75 (20�)(30�)(40�)
9.126.05 2.43 2.43
2.432.43
2.43 2092.92 46.8412.19 2.43 30 481.4
20 320.924 401.2
2593.64 27 887.023 308.318 730.6
62.92
AAAA NNNNNNN W
XXX SSS YYY
Fig. 8.5 Markings on containers.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 235
236 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Container Ship Cargo PlanThe modern type of container vessel will normally operate a container‘box’ tracking system which allows continuous monitoring of any singlecontainer at any time during its transit. The plan shown in Figure 8.12allows a six-figure number to track and identify its stowage positionaboard the vessel. Distinct advantages of such a system tend to satisfy
Fig. 8.6 Container vessel – upper deck stow showing stack of three high onthe top of pontoon hatches. Below decks, containers secured in cell guides.
The navigation bridge is not obscured for the vessels operational needs.
Fig. 8.7 The ‘Dole America’ container vessel manoeuvres with tugs in atten-dance inside harbour waters. Containers are stacked two high on deck and the
two ships container cranes are seen in the stowed, fore and aft position.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 236
Containers and containerization 237
Fabricated deck stool
Pontoon hatch cover
Containerguides
Fore andaft passage
Wingtank
Upperdeck
Container unitsstowed in cells
Double bottom construction
Deck stowcorner unitof ‘stack’
Fig. 8.8 Container vessel construction.
Fig. 8.9 The container spreader beam operates secured to the gantry cranetravelling the length of the gantry jib to lift the containers on and off the vessel.The corners of the spreader beam are fitted with hinged droppable guides toensure the beam locks can accurately locate the container corner recesses. Thebeam is also used to lift off pontoon hatch covers but when doing so does not
deploy the hinged guides.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 237
238 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 8.10 The ‘P&O Nedlloyd Susana’ lies port side to the container terminalin Lisbon, Portugal, part loaded prior to sailing.
Fig. 8.11 The shoreside gantry cranes silhouetted against the Lisbon skylineafter the P&O Nedlloyd Susana departs the berth.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 238
Co
ntain
ers and
con
tainerizatio
n239
5759 54 51 49 46 42
13 13 13 13 13 13 13 13 11 9 9
3739 35 33 31 29 26 23 21 18 15 13 10 07 05 02
13
6 6
13 13
33.25
30.63
28.01
1010
13 13 13 13 132620 30
303232
4343
4444
4444
4444
4444
4444
4444
4444
41 414141
373787
3232
3131
2020
70
1414
1212
336
353583 99
20
108 150
The modern type of container vessel will normally operate a container ‘box’ tracking system which allows continuous monitoring of any single containerat any time during its transit. The plan allows a six figure number to track and identify its stowage position aboard the vessel. Distinct advantagesof such a system tend to satisfy shipper enquiries as well showing that the shipping company is efficient in its business.
202 202 202 101 190 1522121 27
27
67
26 26 26 26 26 26 11
51
18
Total
Total
Nil 200 � 20
1276 � 20418 � 40
494 � 40
76 � 401076 � 20
8 88
8 88
6
6 62 2
4 4
1010
1010101010
1010101010
1010101010
1010
10101010
88
81010
1010101010
1010101010101010
81010101010101010
81010101010101010
81010101010101010
81010101010101010
81010101010101010 8
84
10101010101010
10101010101010
8
888
8
44
10101010101010
6
66
2 2
10101010
101010
888
88
4
44 4
4
46
6
66 6
6
66
6
2
2
222
2
222
2
2
1010
10
10
1010 20 20 10 10 10 5
1 High on deck
Under deck PS
PS
19.27 19.07
17.94 16.72
16.11 16.24
13.95 13.48 13.48 13.48 13.77 14.49 15.30 15.90
17.53
18.69
19.37
21.83
16.32
33.25 33.72
30.63 31.10
28.01 28.47
HOMD KG’s
To 86 20.67To 84 18.97To 82 17.14
U/D
15.12
13
Other aspects of secutiry are also clearly beneficial in a security conscious age.
An example tracking system could be typically: The first two numbers of the six-digit number � The identification of the ‘Bay’ of stowage. The second two numbers � The ‘cell’ of stowage The last two numbers � The level/tier of stowage
Fig. 8.12 Container Ship Cargo Plan.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 239
240 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
shipper enquiries as well as showing that the ship company is efficient inits business. Other aspects of security are also clearly beneficial in a securityconscious age. An example tracking system could be typically: the first twonumbers of the six-digit number (the identification of the ‘bay’ of stowage);the second two numbers (the ‘cell’ of stowage) the last two numbers (the‘level tier’ of stowage).
Container typesThere are many container types in operation to suit a variety of trades andmerchandize. Sizes also vary and they can be shipped in the following sizes:8 ft in width and 8 ft or 8 ft 6 inch in height, with lengths of 10, 20, 40 or 45 ft.
Conventional units (general purpose) – also known as a dry container aremade from steel and fully enclosed with a timber floor. Cargo-securinglashing points are located at floor level at the base of the side panelling.Access for ‘stuffing’ and ‘de-stuffing’ is through full height twin lockingdoors at one end.
Open top containers – covered by tarpaulin and permits top loading/dis-charging for awkward sized loads which cannot be easily handled throughthe doorways of general purpose containers. These may be fitted with aremovable top rail over and above the door aperture.
Half-height containers – an open top container which is 4 ft 3 inch in height,i.e. half the standard height of a general purpose container. They weredesigned for the carriage of dense cargoes such as steel ingots, or heavy-steel cargoes or stone, etc. since these cargoes take up comparatively littlespace in relation to their weight, two half-height containers occupying thesame space as the standard unit.
Flat rack container – this is a flat bed with fixed or collapsible ends and noroof. They are used to accommodate cargoes of non-compatible dimensionsor special cargoes that require additional ventilation.
Bulk container – are containers designed to carry free flowing cargoes likegrain, sugar or cement. Loading and discharging taking place via three cir-cular access hatches situated in the roof of the unit. They also incorporate asmall hatch at the base which allows free flow when tipping the unit. Suchcontainers are usually fitted with steel floors to facilitate cleaning.
Tank containers – are framed tank units designed for the carriage of liquids.The cylindrical tank usually made of stainless steel is secured in the frame-work which is of standard dimensions to be accommodated in loading anddischarging as a normal general purpose container unit. The tanks cancarry hazardous and non-hazardous cargo and are often used for whisky orliquid chemicals.
Ventilated containers – generally designed as a general purpose containerbut with added full length ventilation grills at the top and bottom of theside walls of the unit. They were primarily designed for the coffee trade but
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 240
Containers and containerization 241
are equally suitable for other cargoes, which require a high degree of venti-lation during shipping.
Open-sided containers – these units are constructed with removable steelgrate sides which are covered by poly vinyl chloride (PVC) sheeting. Theside grates allow adequate ventilation when it is used to carry perishablegoods and/or livestock. Such containers permit unrestricted loading anddischarging with the grates removed.
Insulated containers – are insulated and often used in association with a refrigeration air-blower systems to keep perishable cargoes fresh, e.g.meats, fruits vegetables, etc. The container has two porthole extractors fit-ted to one end of the unit to allow the cool air circulation to operate fromthe cooling plant. They are generally stowed under deck and close to, oradjacent to, the ship’s circulation ports. Other types of containers in thiscategory rely only on the insulation and are not fitted with cooling plant,and these can be stowed in any position on the ship.
Refrigerated containers – more generally known as the reefer container, theyare totally insulated and fitted with their own refrigeration plant. Theymust be connected to the ship’s mains and require close stowage to a situ-ated power point. They are usually employed for holding foodstuffs, meatand dairy products being prime examples. These units have become pro-lific and have caused a major reduction in the numbers of dedicated ‘reeferships’, although reefer ships still operate they tend to be limited to specifictrades like ‘bananas’ (Figures 8.13 and 8.14).
Fig. 8.13 The ‘OOCL Shanghai’ lies port side to the container terminal inBarcelona, Spain, after completing cargo loading with a full container load, thedeck stack being at a six-tier height. The terminal ‘gantry cranes’ seen in the
upright and clear position (the ship is not fitted with its own cranage).
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 241
242 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Reefer containersWith many of the chilled and frozen products being transported by sea con-tainers there was bound to be an influence on the reefer trade; so much so thatdesignated ‘reefer’ ships have been greatly reduced in number, other thanpossibly in the banana trade. Ro-Ro units, as well as the specified refrigeratedcontainers, have now dominated the reefer commodity shipping markets.
The container units themselves are built with insulation and pre-cooledprior to being loading at the handling station, a shore power supply beingused to activate the units cooling plant. Once packed and sealed the tem-perature of the unit is lowered to the desired level and monitored by a tem-perature sensor attached to the container. As soon as the unit is packed, therefrigeration machinery is activated either by the continued use of a shoresupply or linked directly to the transporters (mobile) power source.
Terminals and container parks have specialized park areas to enablemobile units to switch to a static shore power supply, once the mobile trans-port supply is stopped. Disconnection of units takes place just prior to load-ing on board the ship. The supply is reconnected from the ship’s mainsonce the unit is stowed in its allocated position aboard the vessel.
The modern container vessel can expect to carry numerous units withrefrigerated cargoes, all plugged into the ship’s power supply fitted tospecified loading bays. They would, in the main, be fitted with a reefer con-tainer monitoring system to ensure that temperatures are retained withinacceptable limits.
Fig. 8.14 Container (internal) hatch stowage. Container hatch with part loadcontainers lying in the cell guides of the lower hold cargo space.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 242
Containers and containerization 243
‘Reefer’ container monitoringVarious types of monitoring systems are available for shipping operators,either stand-alone or integrated operations which could include tank gaugesystems, ballast control, power management, fire fighting, etc.
The local control unit indicated could monitor up to 3000 cargo units, ornumerous tanks for pressure, temperature, volume, viscosity, etc. (Figure 8.15).
Containers on deckIt is regular practice to carry containers on deck on both designated con-tainer vessels and general cargo/service vessels. Further recommendationson deck stowage are advised by ‘M’ Notice 1167.
Deck containers should be stowed and secured taking account of thefollowing:
1. Containers should preferably be stowed in a fore and aft direction.2. They should be stowed in such a position as not to deny safe access to
those personnel necessary to the working of the vessel.
Containermanagement
consolePrintoutMonitor
Mastermonitoring
unit
Mastermodem
Four poleplug unit
Containerswith high-data-ratemodem
Containerswith low-data-ratemodem
Reefer containers
Cargo control room
Containerswith fourpole plug
input
Alarm
Three phasepower cable
Fig. 8.15 Cargo control room – container monitoring.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 243
244 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
3. They should be effectively secured in such a manner that the bottomcorners will be prevented from sliding and the top corners will berestrained to prevent tipping.
4. The unit should stowed in a manner that it does not extend over theships side (many containers are stowed part on the hatch top and parton extending pedestal supports, but the perimeter of the unit is keptwithin the fine lines of the vessel).
5. Deck containers should be carried at a single height (one high).However, this may be increased if twist-locks are used to secure the bot-tom of the container to a fabricated deck stool.
6. Deck loads should not overstress the deck areas of stowage. Where unitsare on hatch tops, these hatch covers must be secured to the vessel.
7. No restraint system should cause excessive stress on the container.8. Restraint systems and securings should have some means of tightening
throughout the voyage period.
Container deck stowageContainer decks, and reinforced pontoon hatch tops to take the deck loadcapacity, are generally constructed with increased scantlings to satisfyClassification and Construction Regulations. Both open decks as seen inFigure 8.16 and the pontoon hatch cover (Figure 8.23), when fitted, areusually equipped with container feet to permit the ‘boxes’ to be locked intoposition. The first tier, being the foundation for second and subsequenttiers, would be stowed on top (Figures 8.17–8.22).
Fig. 8.16 The exposed container cargo deck of the ‘Baltic Eider’ seen with the con-tainer deck stool-securing points in uniform rows to form the basis of an even stow.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 244
Containers and containerization 245
Fig. 8.17 Part loaded deck of the ‘Sete Cidades’. Containers seen on the hatchtops as the vessel lies starboard side to the container terminal in Oporto. Theship’s own two container cranes are turned outboard to allow access to the
shoreside gantry cranes.
Fig. 8.18 Part loaded deck of the vessel ‘Hydra J’. Containerized vehicles andhalf-height container seen clear of securings and ready for discharge.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 245
246 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Single bridge
Double bridge
Corner casting pin
Top lock
Deck pin
Portable twist lock(seen in the open position)
Long and short diagonal rods
Bottle screw or turnbuckle
Fig. 8.19 Container lashing fitments.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 246
Containers and containerization 247
Loadicator and loading plan computersMany ships are now equipped with loadicator systems or a loading com-puter with appropriate software. It is usually a conveniently sited visualdisplay for the Master and the Loading Officers and is gainfully employedon Ro-Ro vessels, container ships, tankers and bulk carriers. The systemshould ideally be interlinked with the shoreside base to enable data trans-missions on, unit weights/tonnages/or special stow arrangements.
The computer would permit the location and respective weights ofcargo/units to be entered quickly and provide values of limiting measureddistance between the keel and the centre of gravity of the vessel (KG) and‘metacentric height’ (GM) together with deadweights at respectivedraughts/displacements. It would also have the capability to provide a
Portabletwistlocks
Longdiagonalrods
Shortdiagonalrods
Deck anchor pointsSingle bridge
studs � deck pininto deck stool
Doublebridges
Top locks
Fig. 8.20 Container deck stowage example. Short and long rods secured bybottle screw or turnbuckle to deck anchor points.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 247
248 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
printed record of the state of loading and show a visual warning in theevent of an undesirable stability condition or overload occurring.
Distribution of the ship’s tank weights, stores and consumables affectingfinal calculations, and total displacement would also be identifiable withinthe completed calculations. The primary aim of the loading computer is to
Fig. 8.21 Deck stowage and securing of container stack. The deck stow is seenin way of the edge of the pontoon hatch cover. The lashings are to the base, thirdtier container level by long bar (not shown).The second tier container level being secured by short bar lashings with the base containers locked to the pontoon.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 248
Containers and containerization 249
Fig. 8.22 Container lashing bars, seen secured from the main deck to the firstand second tier of deck containers.
Fig. 8.23 The container hoist engaged in lifting the pontoon hatch coversclear of the cellular holds.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 249
250 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 8.24 Tracked shoreside ‘gantry crane’ for the loading of containers, semi-automatic, driverless transports deliver containers to its underside for loading
aboard the container vessel.
Fig. 8.25 Shoreside container terminal showing automatic stacking cranesin the background.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 250
Containers and containerization 251
ensure that the vessel always departs the berth with adequate stability forthe voyage. If this situation can be achieved quickly, costly delays can beeliminated and safety criteria is complied with.
The data required to complete the stability calculations would need to besupplied by the shoreside base with regard to cargo weights. This in turnwould be certificated by the driver – for Ro-Ro unit loads – obtaining a loadweight certificate authorized from an approved ‘weight bridge’ prior toboarding the vessel. Draught information would inevitably come from a‘Draught Gauge System’ for the larger vessel and be digitally processedduring the period of loading.
A ship’s personnel could expect to become familiar with manipulation of the changing variables very quickly alongside the fixed weight distribu-tion throughout the ship. This would permit, in general, few major changesto the programme, especially on short sea ferry trade routes where limitedamounts of bunkers, water and stores are consumed and values stay rea-sonably static.
Fixed weights are applicable to a variety of units or vehicles and, as such,where units are pre-booked for the sea passage, an early estimate of theship’s cargo load, and subsequent stability, can often be achieved evenprior to the vessels arrival.
The loadicator programmes provide output in the form of:
● shear forces and bending moments affecting the vessel at its state ofloading
● cargo, ballast and fuel tonnage distributions● a statement of loaded ‘GM’, sailing draughts and deadweight.
Terminal operationsThe sheer size of ‘container terminals’ around the world must generatecause for the tremendous volume of work which is employed in the trans-port, storage and shipping of the many units. The general public wouldonly visibly see the number of units which a terminal has inside its peri-meter at any one time. However, the maintenance of the gantry cranes, theground-handling transports, the documentation concerning a single ‘boxunit’ become the invisible operations that generate a successful terminal.They employ considerable manual workers with various skills, from thewharf men to personnel engaged in ‘stuffing container units’ – securitypersonnel, administration staff, maintenance workers, ships planners, etc.not to mention the insurance and legal professionals engaged in thebackground.
The largest terminals in the world are shown in Table 8.1.The increased growth of unit movements is based on figures from
2002/2003 and should not be considered for future years, as world trade isinfluenced by many factors; not least the strength of national economies,
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 251
252 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Table 8.1 Main terminals throughout the world
Terminal port Number of TEU handled Annual percentage increase(millions) (�/�)
Hong Kong 20.82 �8.8Singapore 18.41 �8.7Shanghai 11.37 �32.1Shenzhen 10.65 �39.9Pusan 10.37 �9.7Kaohsiung 8.81 �3.8Rotterdam 7.10 �9.2Los Angeles 6.61 �8.4Hamburg 6.14 �14.2Antwerp 5.44 �14.0
Fig. 8.26 The container gantry cranes discharge the vessel ‘Zim Marseille’which lies port side to the container terminal in Barcelona, Spain.
the strength of the US dollar, the emergence of China and Charter rates tomention but a few of the relevant influences.
However, what is clear is that if the location of the ports is noted then thegeography would indicate that the USA, Europe, the Far East, and, inparticular, China are emerging as the main trading blocks for container-ized traffic. Feeder operators to Australasia, India, the Baltic and Mediter-ranean regions continue to flourish in support of the major operators(Figures 8.26–8.31).
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 252
Containers and containerization 253
Fig. 8.27 A single gantry crane and a mobile dock side crane work thecontainer cargo of the feeder container vessel ‘Providence’. The ship’s owncontainer cranes are seen turned outboard to facilitate the shoreside loading
systems in the port of Barcelona.
Fig. 8.28 Automated stacking cranes provide unit movements to the termi-nals container stack. The containers being loaded to driverless ground-handling
transports.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 253
254 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 8.29 Automated, driverless ground-handling transports deliver containerunits from the terminal stack to the underside of ship/shore gantry cranes.
Fig. 8.30 Tracked, terminal stacking gantry cranes operate through the Lisbon container terminal. Rail and road transport having access to the
container park.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 254
Containers and containerization 255
Container operations
Shipping and bookingIn order to ship a container certain procedures and documentation processesare required and the freight office of a shipping company would require thefollowing information:
1. Name and address of company booking the unit for export2. Bill of Lading (B/L), with name and address of shipper if different
from above3. The quantity of cargo to be shipped: including weight, measurement,
marks and numbers of packages4. Name of port of discharge5. Commodity details, hazardous, refrigeration required and/or precise
description of goods6. The place of delivery and acceptance7. Place of packing the container8. Earliest date of container availability9. Customs assigned number
10. Customs status of cargo declaration.
The container would then be designated a booking reference number toallow a constant trace to be maintained on the unit while being exported.
Fig. 8.31 Walkways, road paths and track rails for gantry cranes seen alongsidethe berth, opposite the terminal stacking gantries. Container avenues lying
parallel to the ships berth.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 255
256 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
The Export Container Packing Document: ECPDA detailed packing list of the container is required and this serves as notonly a list of container contents but also includes: (a) quarantine declara-tion (if required); (b) transport document for (i) receipt from shippers forempty container, (ii) receipt from shipping company for full container; (c) stated conditions which relate to the use of equipment at shippers premisesand (d) Declaration of Customs Status.
B/LThe shipping company will produce a ‘B/L’ once they have been informedof all relevant details regarding the nature of the cargo. It would be normalpractice that a ‘freight invoice’ would also be issued at this time, as the B/Land the freight invoice are both computer generated.
Shipping proceduresFigure 8.32 shows the likely procedure that would be followed in orderfor a smooth outcome to ensue. It is normal practice for the shipper tohave a financial bond in place prior to shipment, the function of thebond being to guarantee payment at the country of entry of the goods.
Agent: contents � weight (net/gross) Value Size Cubic capacity Specific/requirements
Customs documentation �Schedule � possibleinspection
Quayside discharge:
Despatch to consignee onpayment of port entry feesto the country of entry
Ship with clearancesmanifest andpassenger return
Export Licences for:
Specific cargoes,e.g. computers foodstuffs livestock armaments
Damaged cargo
B/Lendorsed
Ship’s Master
Final agreement tocarry or reject cargoparcels.
Shipper
Markings andlabels to cargo
Hazardousgoods:
IMDGCodeapplies
Fig. 8.32 Shipping procedures.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 256
Fig. 8.34 Lifting, stacking and transporting.
Fig. 8.33 Ground handling of containers – equipment and methods.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 257
258 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 8.35 Container terminal movement. Container transporter, with lift, trans-port, and stacking capability. A type of container karrilift based on the fork lift
truck principle which is widely employed in container terminals worldwide.
Chap-08.qxd 3/3/05 2:28 PM Page 258
Chapter 9
Special cargoes, hazardousgoods and deck cargoes
IntroductionAll cargoes must be considered special in some way, particularly so, if it is the first time that an individual has had experience of that specific cargo.It would take a lifetime for a mariner to carry every commodity and eventhen, certain products would be absent from the list. The interpretation ofspecial cargoes can encompass many types of cargoes but it is generallyaccepted that those parcels that require special or additional attention fortheir safe transport and discharge, fall into this category.
Clearly, hazardous goods covered by the International MaritimeDangerous Goods (IMDG) Code are deeply entrenched under this particu-lar umbrella of special cargoes. However, it is not just hazardous materials.Valuables, like bullion, bank notes, stamps, or personnel effects requiringlock-up stowage conditions, are also considered as specials.
Within the scope of this chapter falls ‘deck cargoes’. They are exposed to theelements and are often the first to suffer from any misadventure which maybefall the ship’s voyage. Deck cargoes, by their very nature, may fall into theclass of hazardous goods or they may, like timber deck cargoes, have their owninherent dangers, which may threaten the well-being of both ship and cargo.
Whatever goods are shipped, it is essential that correct stowage proced-ures are taken from the onset. They should be clearly noted on the stowageplan and relevant persons should be made aware of the nature of potentialhazards or special precautions that should accompany the transport.
Definitions and terminology relating to hazardous cargoesAuto-ignition temperature – is the lowest temperature at which a substancewill start to burn without the aid of an external flame. Spontaneous combustion begins, provided that conditions are right, when auto-ignitiontemperature is attained.Carrier – means any person’s organization, or government, undertaking thetransport of dangerous goods by any means of transport. This includes
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 259
both carriers for hire or reward (known as common or contract carriers)and carriers on own account (known as private carriers).
Control temperature – means the maximum temperature at which certainsubstances (such as organic peroxides and self-reactive and related sub-stances) can be safely transported during a prolonged period of time.
Cylinders – are transportable pressure receptacles of a water capacity notexceeding 150 l.
Dangerous goods – means substances, materials and articles covered by theIMDG Code.
Defined deck area – means that area of the weather deck of a ship or of a vehicle deck of a Roll-on, Roll-off (Ro-Ro) ship which is allocated for thestowage of dangerous goods.
Emergency temperature – means that temperature at which emergency pro-cedures shall be implemented.
Flammable liquid – is a liquid having a flash point lower than 37.8°C. A com-bustible liquid is a liquid having a flash point of 37.8°C or above, e.g. gaso-line is a flammable liquid, whereas kerosene is a combustible liquid.
Flammable range – the limits of flammable (explosive) range, in the rangebetween the minimum and the maximum concentrations of vapour in airwhich forms a flammable (explosive) mixture. Usually abbreviated to LFL(lower flammable limit) and UFL (upper flammable limit). These are synonymous with the lower and upper explosive limits.
Flash point – is that lowest temperature at which a liquid gives off sufficientvapour to form a flammable mixture with air near the surface of the liquid,or within the apparatus used. Flash point represents the change point fromsafe to risk.
Harmful substances – are those substances that are identified as marine pol-lutants in the IMDG Code.
International Maritime Dangerous Goods Code – a mandatory code for the carriage of dangerous goods at sea as adopted by the Maritime SafetyCommittee (MSC) of the International Maritime Organization (IMO).Effective from 1 January 2004 this code is applicable to all ships to which theSafety of Life at Sea (SOLAS) convention applies (Resolution MSC. 122(75)).
Medical First Aid Guide – a section of the supplement to the IMDG Codewhich details guidelines for the application of first aid to persons exposedand affected by hazardous goods.
Packaged form – means the form of containment specified in the IMDG Code.
Settled pressure – means the pressure of the contents of a pressure receptaclein thermal and diffusive equilibrium.
Sift proof – is packaging which is impermeable to dry contents includingfine solid material produced during transport.
260 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 260
Tank – means a portable tank (including a tank container) a road tank vehicle, a rail tank wagon or a receptacle with a capacity of not less than450 l to contain solids, liquids or liquefied gases.
Water reactive – means any substance which in contact with water emitsflammable gas.
Working pressure – means the settled pressure of a compressed gas at a ref-erence temperature of 15°C in a full pressure receptacle.
The IMDG CodeThe IMDG Code is the recognized code of practice for the carriage of hazardous cargoes and is covered by four volumes, plus a supplement.
IMDG Code Volume 1This contains a general introduction and covers standards on the:
1. classification of goods2. packaging of those goods3. documentation required when shipping4. marking labelling and placarding required5. standards concerning explosives in passenger vessels.
Various sections cover the above standards for Classes 1–9 hazardousgoods, in a more detailed format. Annex 1 follows the introduction andprovides details on modes of packaging to UN standards.
An alphabetical General Index of all the substances, inclusive of the UN number, class, packaging group, follows the Annex. This index shouldbe employed as the first step to retrieve information affecting a particularcargo substance. Included here is also the Medical First Aid section with theMedical First Aid Guide (MFAG) table numbers. Definitions, abbreviationsand explanatory notes complete the volume.
IMDG Code Volume 2This volume contains detailed instructions regarding the packing, labellingand stowing of explosives (including the specific requirements for the con-struction of magazines), together with individual schedules for substancesin ‘Class 1’ explosives, ‘Class 2’ gases and ‘Class 3’ flammable liquids.
IMDG Code Volume 3This volume covers ‘Class 4’ flammable solids and ‘Class 5’ oxidizing agentsand organic peroxides. Each schedule contains specific instructions on thepackaging and stowing, and relevant information regarding each class.
IMDG Code Volume 4This volume covers Classes 6 (poisons), 7 (radioactive substances), 8 (corro-sives) and 9 (miscellaneous). It also details specific information for each
Special cargoes, hazardous goods and deck cargoes 261
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 261
class including segregation details, toxicity level and radioactive ratingscales, as well as radioactives for offshore supply vessels, package require-ments for corrosives and miscellaneous substances.
Supplement of the IMDG CodeThe supplement contains emergency procedures (EmS) and schedules forparticular commodities, plus details of specialized equipment required forhandling spills and fires. The MFAG provides information on symptomsand the body’s reaction to exposure following an accident, as well as safepractice for handling of solid bulk cargoes, particularly concentrates.Methods of reporting procedures for vessels involved in incidents are alsocovered.
Shipping procedure for the loading and transport ofhazardous goodsTo transport dangerous goods by sea, they must pass through the followingprocedures:
1. The shipper is responsible for obtaining ‘Export Licences’ for the goodsin question.
2. The shipper would also be responsible for marking and labelling thegoods to be shipped in accord with the IMDG Code.
3. Following contact with the shipping company, agents must provide:– the number of packages together with their weight– the value of the goods– special requirements for carriage of the goods.
4. Customs clearance would be required as for any other cargo.5. The Bill of Lading would be sighted and seen to be free of endorsements.6. The goods would be entered on the ship’s manifest and marked on the
cargo stowage plan.7. A ship’s Officer would check the UN number, the details of the commod-
ity, the labelling of the package and the condition of the packaging. Anyspecial stowage arrangements would be noted and observed at thisstage.
8. The Ship’s Master has the right to accept or reject the cargo prior toloading.
Once the goods are stowed on board the vessel the requirements of theIMDG Code would be followed throughout the period of the voyage.
If appropriate, a ‘Document of Compliance’ for the carriage of certainhazardous goods may be required by the ship.
262 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Note: Reference should also be made to Annex III of Maritime Pollution (MARPOL),regarding the Regulations for the Prevention of Pollution by Harmful Substances,carried at sea in packaged form.
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 262
Documentation for shipping dangerous goods1. Where dangerous goods are to be carried by sea, all documentation
relating to the goods must carry the correct technical name where thegoods are named. The use of a trade name alone must not be used.
2. Any shipping documents prepared by the shipper must include or beaccompanied by a signed certificate or declaration that the shipmentoffered for carriage is correctly packaged and marked, labelled, etc. andis in proper condition for shipment.
3. The person responsible for the packing of dangerous goods in a freightcontainer or road vehicle must provide a signed container packing cer-tificate or a vehicle packing declaration, which states that the cargo inthe unit has been correctly packed and secured and that all applicabletransport requirements have been fulfilled.
4. In the event that a freight container or road vehicle containing danger-ous goods is not compliant with the above, then such vehicle or con-tainer shall not be accepted for shipment.
5. Every ship carrying dangerous cargo shall have a special list or manifestof such dangerous goods on board contained within a detailed stowageplan. Such documents will identify by class and location all such dan-gerous goods on board the vessel. Copies of these documents will beavailable prior to departure to a person as designated by the Port StateAuthority.
6. In the case of marine pollutants, the signed shipping documents mustalso state that the parcel offered for shipment is a marine pollutant andthat as such it is in a proper condition for carriage by sea.
Documentation detail – for shipping dangerous goodsOne of the prime functions of any documentation that accompanies dan-gerous goods for shipping is to provide basic information associated withthe hazardous substance. To this end, the shipping document for eachproduct, material or article offered for shipment must include the following:
1. The proper shipping name.2. The class and when assigned, and the division of the goods.3. The UN number.4. The packaging group for the substance carried under a ‘Not Otherwise
Specified’ (NOS) notation or other generic entry which may include thepossibility of the assignment of more than one packaging group.
5. For ‘Class 7’, radioactive materials only, the Class 7 schedule number.6. Any empty or any packages containing residual dangerous goods
must be marked by the words empty uncleaned or residue-last contained,before or after the proper shipping name of the substance.
Special cargoes, hazardous goods and deck cargoes 263
Note: A copy of the stowage plan must be retained ashore until the harmful substanceshave been discharged from the vessel.
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 263
7. Where dangerous goods waste (except radioactive waste) are beingtransported for disposal, the proper shipping name should be pro-ceeded by the word waste.
8. The number and kind of packages together with the total quantity ofdangerous goods covered by the description.
9. The minimum flash point if 61°C or below (°C closed cup test), or otheradditional hazard which is not communicated in the description of thedangerous goods.
10. The identification that the goods are marine pollutants and whendeclared under an NOS, or generic entry, the recognized chemicalname of the marine pollutant in parentheses.
11. For Class 4.1 self-reacting substance or a Class 5.2 organic peroxide, thecontrol and emergency temperatures, if applicable.
Additional information is required where special classes of dangerousgoods are carried and this information is applicable for: all ‘Class 1’ goods,gases, infectious substances, radioactive materials, certain substances inClass 4.1 which may be exempt from display of an explosive subsidiarylabel, and certain organic substances that are also exempt from displayingthe explosive subsidiary label.
Classes of dangerous goodsDangerous goods are classified as follows:
Class 1 ExplosivesClass 2 Flammable gases, poisonous gases, or compressed, liquefied, or
dissolved gases which are neither flammable nor poisonousClass 3 Flammable liquids, subdivided into three categories:
3.1 Low flash point group of liquids having a flash point below�18°C (0°F) closed cup test, or having a low flash point incombination with some dangerous property other than flammability
3.2 Intermediate flash point group of liquids having a flashpoint �18°C (0°F) up to but not including 23°C (73°F) closedcup test
3.3 High flash point group of liquids having a flash point of 23°C(73°F) up to and including 61°C (141°F) closed cup test
Class 44.1 Flammable solids4.2 Flammable solids or substances liable to spontaneous
combustion4.3 Flammable solids or substances which in contact with water
emit flammable gasesClass 5
5.1 Oxidizing substances5.2 Organic peroxides
264 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 264
Class 66.1 Poisonous (toxic) substances6.2 Infectious substances.
Class 7 Radioactive substancesClass 8 CorrosivesClass 9 Miscellaneous dangerous substances. That is, any other sub-
stance which experience has shown, or may show, to be of such adangerous character, that this class should apply to it.
Stowage of Class 1: explosivesExplosives are categorized for stowage in one of the following methods:
1. Stowage Category I – goods not requiring a magazine stowage.2. Stowage Category II, Type ‘A’ – a fixed magazine structure. This maga-
zine should be close boarded on the inner sides and floor. Althoughcargo battens are sufficient on the ship’s sides and bulkheads if they arenot more than 150 mm apart.
3. Stowage Category II, Type ‘B’ – fixed magazine structure. Similar to‘Type A’ but close boarding of sides and floor is not a requirement.
4. Stowage Category II, Type ‘C’ – a fixed magazine structure similar to‘Type B’, but restrictions are placed on the permitted distance from theship’s side.
5. Stowage Category II – approved portable units.6. Stowage Category II – freight containers.7. Stowage Category III (pyrotechnics) – similar stowage to Category I,
except that goods should not be overstowed with other cargo.8. Stowage Category IV – the goods requiring this stowage should be
placed as far as possible away from living accommodation and shouldnot be overstowed. Deck stowage is preferred.
Package requirements for dangerous goodsAll dangerous goods intended for carriage by sea must conform to thespecifications and performance tests as recommended by the IMDG Code.
Packaging must be:
1. well made and in good condition,2. sealed to prevent leakage,3. of a package material which should not be adversely affected by the
substance it is containing within. If necessary it should be provided byan inner coating capable of withstanding ordinary risks of handling andcarriage by sea. Where the use of absorbent material or cushioningmaterial is employed, that material shall be:– capable of minimizing the dangers to which the liquid may give rise,– so disposed as to prevent movement and ensure that the receptacle
remains surrounded,– where reasonably possible, of sufficient quantity to absorb the liquid
in the event that breakage of the receptacle occurs.
Special cargoes, hazardous goods and deck cargoes 265
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 265
When filling packages/receptacles with liquids, sufficient ullage should beleft to make an allowance for expansion which may be caused by rises intemperature.
Gas cylinders for gases under pressure must be adequately constructedand tested, maintained and correctly filled. When pressure may develop ina package by the emission of gas from the contents due to a rise in tempera-ture, such a package may be fitted with a vent, provided that the gas emit-ted will not cause danger in any form to the surround.
Marking of dangerous goods (Ref. IMDG Code)Packages of ‘dangerous goods’ must be transported in accordance with theprovisions of the IMDG Code. Packages containing a harmful substanceshould be durably marked with the correct technical name (trade namesalone should not be used). They should be marked to indicate that they area marine pollutant and identified by additional means like by use of the relevant UN number.
Markings on packages containing harmful substances must be of such adurable nature as to withstand three (3) months immersion in sea water.They must be adequate to minimize the hazard to the marine environmenthaving due regard to their specific contents.
Empty packages which have previously been used for the transport of harm-ful substances shall themselves be treated as harmful substances, unlessadequate precautions have been taken to ensure that they contain noresidues that are of a harmful nature to the marine environment.
Purpose of marking and labellingThe purpose of marking packages with the correct and proper shippingname, and the UN number of the substance, is to ensure that the material orsubstance can be readily identified during transportation of the goods. Thisidentification is particularly important in determining the nature of emer-gency treatment which would be required in the event of a spillage or acci-dent occurring (Figure 9.1).
Carriage in cargo transport unitsThe shipper is responsible for providing the transport documents; namelya signed certificate that the unit offered for carriage is properly packaged,marked and labelled or placarded, as appropriate. If dangerous goods havebeen packed in such a unit and the packing certificate is not available, thecargo transport unit should not be accepted for carriage.
SegregationDangerous goods that have to be segregated from each other must not betransported in the same cargo transport. Exceptions to this apply and are
266 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Note: Packages that contain small quantities of harmful substances may be exemptfrom the marking requirements. Exemptions are referenced in the IMDG Code.
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 266
Special cargoes, hazardous goods and deck cargoes 267
LABELS, MARKS AND SIGNS
Labels of class
EXPLOSIVE
FLAMMABLE GAS
FLAMMABLE LIQUID
FLAMMABLE SOLID DANGEROUSWHEN WET
SPONTANEOUSLYCOMBUSTIBLE
NON FLAMMABLECOMPRESSED
GAS
POISON GAS
Labels of class
Labels of class
Labels of class
Labels of class
Labels of class
Label of class
Label of class
Class 2.1 Class 2.2
Class 4.1
Class 5.1
TOXIC
Class 6.1
Category I
RADIOACTIVE I
CORROSIVE
RADIOACTIVE II
Category II Category III
Label of class
Class 5.2
Class 6.2
Class 4.2 Class 4.3
Class 2.3
DANGER
FUMIGATION WARNINGSign
ELEVATED TEMPERATUREMark
MARINE POLLUTANTMark
THIS UNIT IS UNDER FUMIGATIONWITH ...............* APPLIED ON..............*..............*
DO NOT ENTER
*Fumigant name and date and time of fumigation to be entered
Subsidiary risk labels
For goods of Class 1 in Division 1.4,compatibility Group S, each packagemay alternatively be marked 1.4 S
Subsidiary risklabel of Class 1 forself-reactive and relatedsubstances in Class 4.1and organic peroxides(Class 5.2) with experienceproperties
The appropriate compatibilitygroup is to be placed in thislocation, e.g. N
The appropriate compatibilitygroup is to be placed in thislocation, e.g. D
The appropriate division numberand compatibility group are to beplaced in this location for divisions1.1, 1.2 and 1.3, e.g. 1.1 D
1.4 1.5 1.6D D N
111.1D
2 2
3
4 4
5.1 5.2
4
2
1 1
6 6
7
8
7
1
2
34
5
6
7
8 9
Subsidiary risk labels are asshown here, but they shouldnot bear the class number inthe bottom corner.For example:
MARINE POLLUTANT
ORGANICPEROXIDE
OXIDIZINGAGENT
INFECTIOUS SUBSTANCExxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx
RADIOACTIVE III
7
CORROSIVE
9
Fig. 9.1 Marking of dangerous classes of goods. Reproduced with kindpermission from IMO.
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 267
contained in Chapter 7. Further advice on the segregation of containers,housing dangerous goods on board container vessels, is given in the code.Similar conditions for Ro-Ro units apply, and reference to the IMDG Codeshould be made.
Dangerous/hazardous cargoes(in dry cargo/container ships or Ro-Ro vessels)
In the event of any dangerous goods or harmful substances being carriedaboard the vessel, ‘The IMDG Code should be consulted. Additionally,the Chemical Data Sheets contained in the Tanker Safety Guide (Gas andChemical) issued by the International Chamber of Shipping may be appropriate.
Such goods/substances must be classified, packaged and labelled inaccord with the Merchant Shipping Regulations. Such trailers or vehiclesshould be given special consideration when being loaded and inspected forleakage prior to loading on the vessel. Such vehicles/containers should alsobe provided with adequate stowage which would provide good ventilation inthe event of leakage whilst in transit, e.g. upper deck stowage exposed toatmosphere (defined deck area) is recommended as a general rule (Figure 9.2).
Deck (Cargo) Officers should pay particular attention to the securing ofsuch transports to ensure negative movement of the unit. Special attentionshould also be given to the securing of adjacent units to prevent escalationof cargo shifting in a seaway. Tank vehicles may not necessarily be carryinghazardous goods, but any spillage of the contents could act as a lubricanton surrounding units and generate a major cargo shift on Ro-Ro vessels inheavy seas.
In the event that a cargo parcel/unit is found to be ‘leaking’ or haveexposed hazards, the nature of the cargo should be ascertained and person-nel kept clear of the immediate area until the degree of hazard is confirmed.In any event the unit should not be accepted for shipment and rejected untilsatisfactorily contained.
Where a hazardous substance is discovered at sea to be a threat to per-sonnel, full information should be sought as soon as possible. Any actiontaken would reflect on the nature of the substance and the emergencyactions stipulated in carriage instructions. It may become prudent to seekadditional instructions from the manufacturer/shipper of the substanceand act accordingly.
268 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Note: With reference to Regulation 54 of SOLAS (1996 Amendment) in ships havingRo-Ro cargo spaces, a separation shall be provided between a closed Ro-Ro cargo spaceand the weather deck. The separation shall be such as to minimize the passage of danger-ous vapours and liquids between such spaces. Alternatively, separation need not be pro-vided if the arrangements of the closed Ro-Ro space are in accordance with those requiredfor the dangerous goods carried on the adjacent weather deck.
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 268
Special cargoes, hazardous goods and deck cargoes 269
Irish Sea
Top Copy – ShoreSecond Copy – ShipThird Copy – Ship
European AmbassadorHazardous Cargo Stowage Plan
Deck 3
Deck 2
Deck 1
A5
A7
A2A1 B1
B2
A6B5B4B3 C3
C5B6B7 C7
C6D5
D3C2C1 D1
D2E2
E5D6D7 E7
E6F5
F3E2E1 F1
F2G3G4G5F6F7 G7
G6H5H4H3G2G1 H1
H2
H6 J6K5K4K3J2
H7
J3J4J5
A4
A7A6A5A4A3A2A1
B7B6B5B4B3B2B1
C7C6C5B4C3C2C1
D7D6D5
D3D2D1
E7E6E5
E3E2E1
F7F6F5
F3F2F1
G7G6G5
G3G4
G2G1
H7H6H5
H3H4
H2H1
J7J6J5
J3J4
J2
K6K5
K3K4
K2J1
A3
Signature: Loading OfficerDate
Time
Voyage
Position Class Reg. No. UN No. EMS MFAG Remarks: Packaging, etc.
DK3: CLASS 1 LANE 3,4,5 UP TO FR. 39 LANE 1,2,6,7 FWD. FR. 25 TO FR. 39
PHOHIBITED: DECK 1 & 2 : CLASS 1.1-1.6, 2.1, 3.1, 3.2, 5.2, 6.1(B), 8(B) DECK 3: AS ABOVE BETWEEN FR. 35/39
Q � DECK 3 AFT OF FR.52 ONLY DECK 1 & 2 O.K.
A3A2 B2 C2 D2
C1 D1B1A1
B3 C3
P&O
Fig. 9.2 Stowage and monitoring of hazardous goods in Ro-Ro units.
Precautions when loading/discharging hazardous goods1. All documentation regarding the ‘dangerous goods’ should be in order
and include the Container Packing Certificate, the Shipper’s Declarationand relevant Emergency Information.
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 269
2. All cargo operations should be supervised by a responsible officer whowill be in possession of operational and emergency information.
3. No unauthorized person, or persons, intoxicated or under the influ-ence of drugs should be allowed near to hazardous cargoes.
4. The compartment or deck area should be dry and clear, suitable for thestowage of the cargo.
5. Where cargo-handling equipment is to be used, such equipmentshould be inspected to be seen to be in good order before use.
6. Dangerous goods should not be handled under adverse weather conditions.
7. All packaging, labelling and segregation of the goods are carried out asper the IMDG Code.
8. Tanks, where applicable, should not be overfilled.9. Suitable ‘Emergency Equipment’ should be kept readily available for
any and every potential hazard associated with the goods.10. Fire wires should be rigged fore and aft of the vessel.11. Packages should be identified and stowed in an appropriate place to
protect against accident.12. Safe access to packages must be available in order to protect or move
away from immediate hazards.13. Emergency stations with suitable protective clothing should be identi-
fied in respect to the location of the cargo.14. Correct signals, i.e. ‘B’ Flag should be displayed during the periods of
loading and discharging.15. Stowage positions should be such as to protect the goods from acciden-
tal damage due to heating. Combustible materials being stowed awayfrom all sources of ignition.
16. Cargoes requiring special ventilation should be positioned to benefitfrom the designated ventilation system.
17. The Port Authority should be informed of all movements of hazardousgoods.
18. Suitable security should be given to special cargoes like explosives.19. All hazardous parcels should be tallied in and tallied out of the vessel.20. Some packages may require daylight movement. Some operations may
also be effected by rain or strong sunlight and appropriate loadingschedules should reflect related hazards.
270 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Note: Emergency information on cargoes should include:
● The correct technical name of the product and its UN number● Classification and any physical and/or chemical properties● Quantity to load and the designated space to load● The stated action in the event of leakage● Fire fighting and spillage procedures, and any specific equipment required.
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 270
Deck cargoesThe term ‘weather deck’ refers to an open deck which is exposed to theweather on a minimum of two sides. The phrase is synonymous with deckcargo being carried on exposed decks and running a greater risk of lossbecause of the stowage location. Below decks and unaffected by the elem-ents of weather provides a level of assumed security completely opposite tothe weather risks associated with deck cargoes.
Numerous Codes of Safe Practice, conventions and recommendationshave been published to advise on the securing and safe transport of specificdeck cargoes, inclusive of timber, containers, vehicles, steelwork, etc. Thelosses incurred over the years would indicate that the force and power of the elements may generate extreme forces on exposed cargoes, causingrestraints to part, and cargo parcels to be lost overside.
Such losses, if noted frequently, would probably deter the carriage of anydeck cargoes at all. However, certain cargoes must be categorized andclassed as deck cargo because of inherent dangers if they were carriedbelow decks, e.g. certain hazardous goods, such as acids and corrosives.
General observance of SOLAS (Chapters 6 and 7), together with theCode of Safe Working Practice for Cargo Stowage and Securing of CargoUnits Including Containers, have become recognized sources of informa-tion. Alongside these, full reference to the ship’s Cargo Securing Manualshould go some way to assisting the Cargo Officer with decisions con-cerning the number and positioning of securings and restraints on deckcargo loads.
The regulations require that the following criteria are met when carryingdeck cargo:
1. That the vessel will have adequate stability at all stages of the voyage forthe amount of cargo it is proposed to load. It should be borne in mindthat cargoes like coke and timber may absorb up to about one-third oftheir own weight by water. Also, losses of bottom weight like fuel, oiland water from double bottom tanks would work against the positivestability of the vessel.
2. Adequate provision must be made for the safe access of the crew whenpassing from one part of the vessel to another. Deck cargoes that preventaccess to crews’ quarters, either along or underdeck, must be providedwith a walkway over the cargo, and in any event walkways are requiredfor ships with timber deck cargoes.
3. Steering gear arrangements must be protected against damage and inthe event of a breakdown of the gear, enough deck space must be avail-able to operate an emergency system.
4. If cargo is to be stowed on hatches, these hatches must be correctly bat-tened down and of adequate strength to support the carriage of the cargoes.
5. Decks, designated for the stowage of deck cargo, must be of adequatestrength to support the stowage.
Special cargoes, hazardous goods and deck cargoes 271
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 271
6. Deck cargo parcels are to be well-secured and, if necessary, protectedfrom the weather elements including the heat of the sun. The height ofany cargo should not interfere with the navigation of the vessel andobstruct the keeping of an efficient lookout.
Example deck cargoesAcids and corrosives – liquid acids and dangerous corrosive substances are usu-ally carried in glass containers known as carboys. These containers are strawprotected by a steel wire frame and are often crated for shipping. They arealways allocated deck stowage away from crews’ quarters in accordance withthe IMDG Code and would need to be well lashed and secured against move-ment. In the event of spillage, the accompanying documentation should beconsulted and any persons involved in clear up procedures should be issuedwith protective clothing inclusive of goggles, gloves and suitable footwear.
Chemicals – the type of chemical substance and its form will depend on itsstyle of packaging. Obviously, the numerous chemicals shipped vary con-siderably and stowage method would be advised by shippers and supplieddocumentation. Special attention should be paid to instructions in theevent of spillage occuring, as some chemicals react with water or air, andbecome harmful to personnel if incorrect procedures are adopted.
Containers – regularly carried on open decks of container vessels in the‘stack’. However, containers carrying hazardous goods are identified andgiven appropriate segregated stowage. Where single containers with dan-gerous goods are carried on open decks on other than dedicated containervessels, suitable stowage and securing are expected to be provided. Themain concern for Cargo Officers is that the goods themselves are securedinside the container and packed under correct supervision and deliveredfor shipment with a Container Packing Certificate, together with relevantdocumentation regarding the actual goods inside the container.
Gases – carried in cylinders of various sizes. These must be well-securedagainst unwanted movement. They should not be stowed near any heatsource and protected from the sun’s rays, usually by a tarpaulin.
Livestock (see Chapter 6) – most livestock would be carried on a sheltered partof the upper decks, along with shipper’s instructions for feeding and hygiene.
Oil (drums) – can be carried below decks as well as above decks. Part car-goes are often carried as deck cargo to provide an improved stability condi-tion without having to shut cargo out. Drums are usually of 50 gallon sizeand should be tightly packed, the most common being for the carriage andshipping of lubricating oil. Once stowed, they should be securely lashedand bowsed into the side bulwarks. If total deck coverage is employed thena walkway, similar to timber deck cargoes, would need to be constructed toprovide crew access to fore and aft parts of the ship.
Steelwork – may be shipped in a variety of forms: castings, bulldozers, rail-way lines, etc. Must be stowed on timber bearers and not steel to steel. The
272 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 272
bearers are meant to reduce friction between the deck and load but alsospread the deck load capacity weight. In every case, heavy-steel cargoesshould be well secured preferably with chains and bottle screws. A combi-nation of chains and wires is also considered as being suitable, dependingon the nature of the load. Some loads may lend to being welded to the deckto prevent unwanted movement.
General principlesDeck cargo should be stowed and distributed in a manner that will avoidundue stress on deck areas and ensure that adequate stability is retainedthroughout the voyage. Certain deck cargoes like timber have the associ-ated danger of absorbing moisture at a position higher than the ship’s centre of gravity. With the combined burning off of fuel and the consump-tion of fresh water from the lower tanks of the vessel the danger to gener-ate a loss of metacentric height (GM) or even create a negative GM isreadily apparent. Icing of cargoes, particularly container deck stows, couldalso be extremely detrimental to the stability of the vessel.
Other cargoes may be large or heavy and generate their own restrictionson the ship. Deck cargoes must not impair the working of the vessel, partic-ularly obstructing the lookouts’ duties or preventing access to the workingspaces of the vessel. Large cargo parcels could increase the windage expe-rienced by the ship and cause excessive leeway affects and such affectswould need to be monitored by Navigation Officers (Figure 9.3).
Special cargoes, hazardous goods and deck cargoes 273
Fig. 9.3 Securing deck cargoes. Steel pipes seen stowed on upper decks.Chain lashings are stretched across at intermediate lengths and tensioned byratchet gear once in position. The pipes have been left pre-slung with wire
snotters for speed of discharge.
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 273
During loading, Chief Officers are advised to ensure that decks are notoverstressed by ‘point loading’ and that supporting structures about theloaded area are adequate to cater for the size and volume of load. All loadsmust be suitably secured to prevent movement in a seaway, and in theevent of heavy weather, prior to sailing.
All deck cargoes should be loaded in accord with the Merchant Shipping(Load Lines) (Deck Cargo) Regulations and S.I. No. 1089 of 1968.
Offshore supply vesselsA major section of the industry is occupied with oil and gas recovery fromoffshore waters. Offshore installations, from the colossal ProductionPlatforms, to the smaller drilling rigs have the need to be re-supplied on acontinuous basis. Cargoes vary in this sector of the industry from theunusual in the form of ‘mud’ and/or cement, carried in underdeck tanks tothe more mundane general stores packed in small containers. The offshoresupply vessels, once in close proximity of the installation, are discharged byuse of the rig’s own cranes. The position of the vessel is held precariouslyclose to the structure of the installation by dynamic position (DP) or by expertship handling skills of the vessel’s Master, weather permitting (Figure 9.4).
274 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 9.4 Capped drilling pipes seen loaded on the wide beam cargo deck ofan offshore supply vessel. The pipes are capped at each end to prevent waterretention in the event of the vessel encountering rough weather. Any fluid inquantity being retained amongst deck cargoes could seriously affect the
positive stability of the vessel.
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 274
TimberSpecial regulations apply to the carriage of timber on deck (see Chapter 6).Separate loadlines may apply and specific securing arrangements are rec-ommended as per the Code of Safe Practice for Ships Carrying TimberDeck Cargoes.
VehiclesIt is not unusual to see vehicles carried as deck cargo on board ships otherthan designated Ro-Ro types of vessel, especially tractors and other farmvehicles. Heavy-lift bulldozers, and similar tracked vehicles are frequentlysecured on deck or on hatch top squares. Private cars are generally carriedbelow decks as protection from the weather elements is preferred.
Securing of vehicles on deck by means of rope, wire or even chains forheavy plant vehicles is expected for ocean-going vessels. Some form ofchocking or tomming may also be desirable. Cargo Officers should payparticular attention to the securing of these cargoes. They are often the lastparcels to be loaded and rigging gangs may be tempted to cut corners to beoff the ship prior to sailing.
Once at sea, a prudent Chief Officer would order deck cargo lashings tobe tightened, especially in the event of a heavy weather warning.
Special cargoes, hazardous goods and deck cargoes 275
Chap-09.qxd 3/3/05 9:54 AM Page 275
Chapter 10
Security, cargo documentation,stability examples
IntroductionSince the implementation of the International Ship and Port FacilitySecurity (ISPS) Code in July of 2004, all Ship’s Officers have been madeaware of the need to be security conscious. This is not to say that before thistime personnel were ignorant to the dangers and security risks which havealways been associated with the maritime industries. The fact that portshave now installed better security fences, X-ray detection methods, closemonitoring of dock transports, and tighter control of crews seems to haveprovided some degree of improved marine security.
For the Cargo Officer, vigilance is essential and on most ship’s securitystarts with ensuring that correct documentation is presented by the crewmembers on joining, close inspection of the cargo manifests, correct shipping papers for specific cargoes, etc. It is from such information thatthe safety of the ship can be assured. The Chief Officer is able to takeaccount of the vessel’s stability criteria for all stages of the voyage.Hazardous parcels can be secured and monitored for the protection of personnel and cargo alike, while the function of the ship’s crew is to protectthe shipowner’s interests and affect the delivery of all cargoes in good condition and a safe manner.
It has been said that information is power. It is also abundantly clear thatcargo information is an essential element of the ship’s well-being. To thisend the ports around the world are moving rapidly to comply with thesecurity measures required by the Code. Maritime authorities are continu-ing to work under the umbrella of the International Safety Management(ISM) System and monitoring the safe operation of vessels on the high seas.
Industry sectors such as Safe Navigation operate with external assistancesuch as VTS schemes, communication networks and hydrographic depart-ments around the globe. The safe transport of cargoes now similarlyemploys equal support, in the way of customs, police and in some cases themilitary, to ensure a secure working environment in the modern world.However, these people cannot be all things to all men and it has become
Chap-10.qxd 3/3/05 9:55 AM Page 276
clear that the Ship’s Officer is closer to the front line of safety and securityaboard ships than any other individual.
The ISPS Code and cargo security
IntroductionIt is difficult to visualize Cargo Officers being directly involved in the cargosecurity aspects of an 8000 teu container vessel other than being vigilantduring loading, discharging and while in transit. The practicalities ofsearching excessive numbers of containers are clearly beyond their scope.Sampling possibly a few containers at random must be considered themaximum that anyone could expect as being practical. Security of cargoesmust therefore be considered at the start of the container’s journey when it is empty, prior to the packing stage. The ‘stuffing’ of the unit must be carried out under supervision and receive a Packing Certificate. Thegoods would be subject to customs controls and inspection before beingsealed.
Units should be provided with secure holding before delivery to the ter-minal. Once inside the container park, units fall under the security cordonexpected by the ISPS Code. Full documentation of the unit is listed with theshipping agents and seals would be inspected prior to loading the unit onboard the vessel.
The ability to detect security threats and take preventive action is paramount. The level of terminal security would vary from port to port and the degree of ship/port interface would be established with experi-ence. It would be envisaged that the Port Security Officer (PSO) wouldliaise with the Ship Security Officer (SSO) regarding all aspects of ‘cargosecurity’. Such liaison is expected to ensure that:
1. tampering of cargo is prevented, and2. that cargo which is not intended for shipment, is prevented from being
accepted and stored on board.
In order to retain a safe environment it is anticipated that such measureswill be in place to include inventory and control applications, such precau-tions being supported by the identification of all cargo parcels on board thevessel. To this end, container companies have installed methods that allowthe tracking of all ‘box’ units and Roll-on, Roll-off (Ro-Ro) units, showingas being approved for loading and shipping by the vessel.
Screening of stores, cargo parcels and unaccompanied baggage tends torest with the port facility and is meant to be covered by the ‘Port FacilitySecurity Plan’ (PFSP). Such screening may include the searching of baggageboth ashore and on board. Scanning equipment and/or specially traineddogs may very well be used, to ensure the security of packages.
Security, cargo documentation, stability examples 277
Chap-10.qxd 3/3/05 9:55 AM Page 277
The ISPS Code
ApplicationThe ISPS Code is applicable to the following types of vessel on inter-national voyages:
1. Passenger ships, inclusive of high-speed passenger craft2. Cargo ships, including high-speed craft of 500 gross tonnage and upwards3. Mobile offshore drilling units4. Port facilities serving such ships engaged on international voyages.
Definitions effective within the ISPS CodeShip Security Plan – means a plan developed to ensure the application of measures on board the ship designed to protect persons on board, cargo,cargo transport units, ship’s stores, or the ship, from risks of a security incident.
Port Security Plan – means a plan developed to ensure the application of measures designed to protect the port facility and ships, persons, cargo,cargo transport units, and ships stores within the port facility from the risksof a security incident.
Ship Security Officer – that person on board the ship accountable to the master, designated by the company as responsible for the security of theship, including implementation and maintenance of the Ship Security Planand for the liaison with Port Facility Security Officers.Note: The master can now be the designated SSO.
Company Security Officer – means that person designated by the companyfor ensuring that a ship security assessment is carried out; that a Ship’sSecurity Plan is developed, submitted for approval and thereafter imple-mented and maintained, and for liaison with Port Facility Security Officersand the SSO.
Port Facility Security Officer – means the person designated as responsible forthe development, implementation, revision and maintenance of the PFSPand for liaison with the SSO and the Company Security Officer (CSO).
Security ‘Level 1’ – means that level for which minimum appropriate pro-tective security measures shall be maintained at all times.
Security ‘Level 2’ – means that level for which appropriate additional pro-tective security measures shall be maintained for a period of time as a resultof heightened risk of a security incident.
Security ‘Level 3’ – means that level for which further specific protect-ive security measures shall be maintained for a limited period of time when a security incident is probable or imminent, although it may not bepossible to identify the specific target.
278 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Chap-10.qxd 3/3/05 9:55 AM Page 278
Security, cargo documentation, stability examples 279
Ship – the term ship as used within the context of the code includes mobileoffshore drilling units and high-speed craft as defined by Regulation XI-2/l.
Ship/port interface – means the interactions that occur when a ship is directlyand immediately affected by actions involving the movement of persons,goods or the provisions of port services to or from the ship.
Ship-to-ship activity – means any activity not related to a port facility thatinvolves the transfer of goods or persons from one ship to another.
Security incident – means any suspicious act or circumstance threatening thesecurity of the ship, or of a port facility or any ship/port interface or ship-to-ship activity.
Security level – means the qualification of the degree of risk that a securityincident will be attempted or will occur.
Security threatsClearly in this day and age any threat to the ship or the port’s facilitiescould have a direct consequence to personnel working aboard or within theport confines. The PFSP is meant to identify such threats and prioritize pro-tective security actions. Such threats may take on a variety of forms fromdamage to the ship or port facilities – i.e. from an explosive device, arson,tampering with cargo, smuggling activities – to the extreme of nuclear, biological or chemical attack.
Cargo concernsAnything that generates cause to affect the well-being of cargo parcels is ofconcern to Ship’s Officers. Pilferage from open stow cargoes has long beenan expensive activity and to some extent containerization went a long wayto curb theft. However, thieves are known to hijack the whole container,often with insider knowledge as to its contents. Other cargoes are of ahigher profile and more readily visible, requiring immediate and increasedsecurity – like, for instance, nuclear waste flasks (Figures 10.1 and 10.2).
Shipboard security activityMany aspects of shipboard activity are exposed to abuse and threats tosecurity. Some of these are listed and officers should be mindful of the secur-ity elements associated with the following:
1. The handling of cargo which may contain harmful substances or terror-ist personnel
2. The handling of unaccompanied baggage3. The handling and loading of ship’s stores4. Controlling access of persons who may have criminal intent5. Monitoring berthing areas in close proximity to the ship’s hull6. Monitoring offshore areas to prevent incursion by waterborne craft
Chap-10.qxd 3/3/05 9:55 AM Page 279
280 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Fig. 10.1 Nuclear waste flasks discharged with full heavy-lift precautionsonto special transports in Japan monitored by security mobiles and specializedpersonnel. Open aspects and security fencing surround the working area of the
port facility.
Fig. 10.2 Security personnel monitor nuclear waste flasks, following dischargeinto the port facility handling grounds. Customized transports are designated
to each flask and movement is checked at every stage of transit.
Chap-10.qxd 3/3/05 9:55 AM Page 280
Security, cargo documentation, stability examples 281
7. Controlling the embarkation of persons and their effects (especially sowith high-profile vessels carrying increased numbers of passengers)(Figure 10.3).
Fig. 10.3 High-profile passenger ship ‘Queen Mary 2’ lies port side to alongsidethe berth in Southampton. Such vessels require maximum security within the
port facility and on all access points to the vessel.
Security progressIn order to be compliant with the ISPS code, Safety of Life at Sea (SOLAS)has been amended to include relevant requirements:
1. All ships on international voyages will be equipped with AutomaticIdentification System (AIS).
2. Companies will be expected to install Ship Security Alert Systems ontheir vessels.
3. Ships will run a continuous synopsis record while in service from thetime of launching for new builds.
4. Companies must report to a flag, state-appointed, recognized securityorganization and create internal positions for dedicated CSO as well ason board SSO.
5. Companies will develop their own security plans to suit each individualvessel, which must be implemented on board.
6. Vessels which are compliant will be issued and International Ship SecurityCertificate (ISSC) by the companies recognized safety organization. Thisorganization will also be responsible for conducting internal audits.
Chap-10.qxd 3/3/05 9:55 AM Page 281
282 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
ApplicationThe ramifications of the ISPS Code will mean that practical activities tosafeguard the ship and cargoes will begin to operate; for example, mastersbeing informed beforehand of the presence of self-igniting chemicals; con-tainers being scanned inside the terminal before being loaded aboard thevessel; while tighter access controls into terminals and onto ships willexpect to create a more security conscious environment.
Cargo documentation summaryBallast Management Record – the dangers to aquatic life have instigated theneed for tighter controls on the movement and in particular, the discharge ofballast waters. Positions of ballast change, dates, amount and tank location.
Bill of Lading (B/L) – are the consignee’s title to the goods which have beenshipped or are about to be shipped. The B/L will quantify the goods andrefer their condition at the time of shipping and he/she would expect toreceive the goods at the port of discharge in the same good condition aswhen shipped. In the event that the goods are damaged at receipt or inloading or discharging the B/L would be endorsed to specify the damage.Such an endorsed B/L would be considered as a dirty or foul B/L, asopposed to a clean B/L which is without endorsement. The B/Ls are usuallydrawn up by the shipping agent and signed by the Master of the Vessel.
Cargo manifest – the official listing of all cargo parcels carried on board thevessel. This document is what the master bases his declaration on whenentering port; all cargoes being officially declared on the manifest which issubject to inspection by Customs Officers, and port security inspection.
Cargo Record Book – vessel engaged in the carriage of noxious liquid sub-stances must carry a record of the cargo movements affecting the ship. Thesame ships would also be expected to carry a Maritime and CoastguardAgency (MCA) approved Procedures and Arrangement Manual, reflecting theoperational aspects of the vessel.
Cargo Securing Manual – a legal requirement for every ship other than thoseengaged in the carriage of solid or liquid bulk cargoes. The purpose of themanual is to cover all relevant aspects of cargo stowage and securing.Securing devices and methods must meet acceptable criteria for strength,applicable to relevant cargo units, inclusive of containers and Ro-Ro trans-ports. Each manual is prepared in a manner to reflect the individual ship’sneeds, relevant to the type of cargo parcels it is engaged to ship.
Cargo stowage plan – a charted plan of the vessel’s cargo-carrying spaceswhich illustrates the type, tonnage and description of goods for designateddischarge in the various intended ports of call for the voyage. The plan isconstructed by the Cargo Officer and is meant to provide an overall illus-tration of the distribution of the ship’s cargo. The plan is copied anddespatched to the various ports of discharge prior to the ship’s arrival on
Chap-10.qxd 3/3/05 9:55 AM Page 282
Security, cargo documentation, stability examples 283
the berth. It allows relevant cranes to be ordered and stevedore gangs to beemployed in advance which subsequently speeds up the time of the vessellying in port. It is considered essential for dry cargo vessels, tankers, bulkcarriers and container vessels to all carry stowage plans respective to theirrelevant cargoes.
Certificate of Fitness – is required by every UK tanker and gas carrier. Theseare issued by the MCA and are valid for a period not exceeding five (5)years, being subject to initial, annual and intermediate surveys. This certifi-cate cannot be extended.
Charter party – is a private contract between the principal parties to an agree-ment and is evidence of who the operator of the ship is. Charter parties areset in three categories: Time Charter, Voyage Charter or a Demise Charter (USBare Boat Charter). Variations of the three categories are drawn up based onthe operational requirements of the ship and the intended voyage.
Container Packing Certificate – the packing and unpacking of containers usu-ally takes place at shore terminals or at the address of the shipper or con-signee. Prior to loading on board the vessel, a valid Container PackingCertificate must be received as evidence that the goods have been packedin such a way as to withstand carriage at sea. It is also a security check thatthe unit does not contain contraband goods and that the merchandise is aswhat is described on the certificate. Container units are now electronicallyscanned at entry to many shipping terminals.
Document of Authorization – is a required certificate issued by a surveyor fol-lowing survey of the ship’s cargo holds and its ability to carry cargo safely.Unless the ship is in the possession of an Exemption Certificate, theDocument of Authorization would be an official requirement.
Document of Compliance (dangerous goods) – a certificate of compliance issuedto a type of ship that is permitted to carry certain categories of hazardous/dangerous goods. Not all ships can carry hazardous cargoes; for example,passenger vessels are not allowed to carry Class 1, explosives.
Enclosed space entry permit – a work permit which is issued prior to entry into an enclosed space compartment. The permit is issued only after all therequired safety checks and inspections of the compartment have beenmade and the relevant precautions have been taken.
Export licences – these are supplied by the shipper as required for certainspecific cargoes: computers, foodstuffs, livestock, armaments, etc. The exportlicence is required by Government / State Officials for certain types of cargoeswhich are subject to inspection by customs (e.g. armaments, drugs, etc.).
International Security Certificate – issued to a vessel by a recognized securityorganization confirming that the ship is compliant to the ISPS Code.
Mate’s Receipt – a receipt for goods received and delivered on board the vessel. As the name implies, it is signed and issued by the Mate of the Ship,i.e. the Chief Officer. It may form the basis for the final B/L.
Chap-10.qxd 3/3/05 9:55 AM Page 283
284 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Note of Protest – is where the Master of a Ship makes a declaration of‘Protest’ under oath before a Notary Public, Magistrate or British Consul.The declaration often affects cargo damaged or suspected of having damagedue to a ‘peril of the sea’. The main use of Protest in the UK is to support acargo owner’s claim against his underwriters. The Note of Protest is admis-sible as evidence before legal tribunals in many countries, but not in the UKunless both parties agree. Masters should note Protest as soon after arrival inport and before ‘breaking bulk’. The master may extend ‘Protest’ once the situation has been further assessed and the full extent of damage is revealed.Register of Lifting Appliances and Cargo-Handling Gear – a record of all theship’s cargo-handling equipment, usually retained and updated by the Ship’sChief Officer. It contains all the certificates for such items as shackles,blocks, wires, derrick and crane tests, hooks, chains, etc. The register isopen to inspection by Port State Control Officers and would be required bythe surveyor when carrying out the Cargo-Handling Equipment Survey.Rigging plan – a ship’s arrangement plan which illustrates the operationalaspects of the ship’s lifting appliances. Safe working loads and maximumpermissible outreach limits would expect to be displayed alongside therelated positions of cargo stowage compartments.
Stability information booklet – the ship’s stability criteria may be in bookletformat or in the form of a series of plans, or even carried in a combination for-mat of both. Either way the documents are in the control of the Ship’s ChiefOfficer and will include the following: general particulars of the vessel; ageneral arrangement plan showing cargo compartments and tank disposi-tions; special notes on the stability and loading procedures; hydrostatic partic-ulars; metric conversion table; capacity plan showing centre of gravity of cargostowage compartments (to include free surface moment of oil and watertanks); notes on the use of free surface moments; cross curves of stability(known as KN curves) with examples of their use; deadweight scale; list ofship conditions and typical condition sheets; statical stability curve for condi-tions; simplified stability information together with damaged stability criteria.
Transportable Moisture Limit (TML) Certificate – a certificate issued within 7 days of measuring the moisture limit of the bulk product to be shipped.
Abbreviations used in the following example calculationsA AftAP Aft perpendicularC of G Centre of gravitycm Centimetre CoT Change of trimd distanceDW Dock waterDWA Dock water allowanceF ForwardFP Forward perpendicularFWA Fresh water allowance
Chap-10.qxd 3/3/05 9:55 AM Page 284
Security, cargo documentation, stability examples 285
G Position of the ship’s C of GGG1 Movement distance of the ship’s C of GGM Metacentric heightKG Measured distance between the keel and the C of G of the vesselKM Measured distance between the keel and the metacentreL Length of shipl A proportionate length of the ship’s lengthM Metacentrem metresMCTC Moment to change trim 1 cmmm MillimetresRD Relative densityStbd StarboardSW Salt watertan tangentTPC Tonnes per centimetreW Displacement of vesselw added or discharged weight
Cargo work – stability examples
Example 1A vessel of 5870 tonnes displacement has a load draught of 5.4 m with aTPC � 11. Calculate the load draught of the vessel if she is a workingcargo in fresh water.
Example 2A vessel has a load draught in SW of 6.4 m. Calculate the maximum loaddraught in DW of RD 1.010. The ship’s FWA is 75 mm.
Maximum draught � 6.40 � 0.045 � 6.445 m.
DWA FWA1025 density of DW
751025 1010
� ��
� ��
25
25
�� �
� �
751525
45 mm 0.045 m
FWAW
4 TPC5870
4 11133.4 mm
0.133 mLoa
��
��
�
�
dd draught in FW 5.40 0.133 5.533 m.� � �
Note: DWA being the amount the vessel may legally submerge herdisc (Plimsoll Line) when loading in a DW of less density than that ofsea water.
Chap-10.qxd 3/3/05 9:55 AM Page 285
286 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Example 3A vessel of 10 000 tonnes displacement with a KG of 7.0 m loads 100tonnes of KG 12 m. Calculate the new KG of the vessel, by takingmoments about the keel.
Weight KG Moment
12 000 7.8 93 600�250 11.0 �2750�100 7.0 �700
�50 3.0 �150
12 400 97 200
GM � KM � KG � 8.6 � 7.839
� 0.761 m.
Final KGtotal momenttotal weight
97 20012
� �4400
7.839 m.�
Weight KG Moment
10 000 7.0 70 000�100 12.0 �1200
10100 71 200
Example 4A vessel of 12 000 tonnes displacement has a KG of 7.8 m and a KM of8.6 m. She then loads the following cargo parcels:
250 tonnes at KG of 11.0 m100 tonnes at KG of 7.0 m and50 tonnes at KG of 3.0 m
Calculate the vessel’s final GM after completion of loading.
Final KGtotal momenttotal weight
71 20010 10
� �00
7.0495 m.�
Chap-10.qxd 3/3/05 9:55 AM Page 286
Security, cargo documentation, stability examples 287
Final KG � 6.8 � 0.2 � 6.6But
Example 6A ship of 10 000 tonnes displacement is to load a heavy lift of 100 tonneswith a KG of 3.0 m by means of the ship’s heavy derrick. The head of thederrick is 24 m above the keel. The ship’s KM was 7.0 m, with a KG of 6.2 mbefore loading. The load is to be stowed on the ship at a KG of 6.0 m.
Calculate: (a) the minimum GM experienced and (b) the final GM.
� KG � 6.2 � 0.21 � 6.41 m
� GM � 7.0 � 6.41 � 0.59 m.
GGw d
W100 (24 3)
0.21 m
1 ��
�� �
�
10 000
Weight KG Moment
7500 6.0 45 0001.15w 11.0 12.65w
7500 � 1.15w 45 000 � 12.65w
Example 5A vessel of 7500 tonnes displacement with KG of 6.0 m, and KM of 6.8 m,is expected to load timber on deck in a position of KG 11.0 m. Calculatethe maximum weight of timber that can be loaded in order to arrive atthe destination with a GM of 0.2 m if an allowance of 15% increase inweight is anticipated with water absorption by the deck cargo.
Let the weight of cargo to be loaded � w
(a)
Final KGtotal momenttotal weight
45 000 12� �
� ..65w7500 1.15w�
� 6.612.65w
7500 1.15w�
�
�
45 000
� 49 500 7.59w 45 000 12.65w� � �
4500 � 5.06w
w45005.06
�
w 889 tonnes of timber to load.�
Chap-10.qxd 3/3/05 9:55 AM Page 287
� KG � 6.2 � 0.03 � 6.23 m
� GM � 7.0 � 6.23 � 0.77 m.
Example 7
Note: When the C of G of a vessel moves off centre, an upsetting lever isproduced which causes the vessel to list until G and M are in the samevertical line. The angle of heel due to G being off centre is found by theformula
A vessel with 4000 tonnes displacement which is initially upright movesa 12 tonnes weight 7 m transversely across the deck. The ship’s GM withthe weight on board is 0.3 m. Calculate the resulting list.
Example 8A vessel of 11000 tonnes initial displacement loads a 50 tonnes weight bya floating crane in a position 12 m to port off the ship’s centre line. Assumethat the KG and KM remain constant and that the vessel is upright priorto loading. Calculate the angle of list if the ship’s GM is currently 0.25 m.
Example 9A vessel of 10 000 tonnes displacement with an initial GM of 0.2 m conducts the following cargo operations:
Loads 50 tonnes 4 m to Stbd of the centreline.Loads 70 tonnes 5 m to port of the centreline.Discharges 90 tonnes 3 m to Stbd of the centreline.Shifts 40 tonnes 6 m to Stbd.Assuming KG and KM remain constant, determine the final list.
tanw d
W GM50 12
11050 0.2512 25 to p
��
��
�
�
� � �� oort.
tanw d
W GM12 7
4000 0.34 0 .
��
��
�
�
� � �
tanTransverse GG
GMbut GG
w dW
tanw d
11 � �
�
��
�WW GM
listing momentW GM�
��
GG100 (6 3)
0.03m
1 �� �
�
10 000
288 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
(b)
Chap-10.qxd 3/3/05 9:55 AM Page 288
Weight Distance off centre List moment
Port Stbd
10 000 – – –�50 4 m Stbd 200�70 5 m port 350�90 (discharge) 3 m Stbd 270�40 (transferred) 6 m Stbd 240
10 030 620 440440180 (port)
Example 10A vessel of 160 m length, loads 40 tonnes in a position 60 m from the AP.Calculate the final draughts if the initial draughts are forward 5.0 m aft6.0 m. The longitude centre of floatation is 70 m forward of the AP. Theships TPC is 20, and MCTC is 100.
Forward Aft
Initial draughts 5.0 6.0Sinkage 0.02 0.02
5.02 6.02CoT �0.0225 �0.0175Final draughts 4.9975F 6.0375A.
Sinkage due to loadweight loaded
TPC4020
2� � � cm
CoTw dMCTC
40 10100
4 cm (by stern)
CoT
��
��
�
aft due to CoTlL
CoT70
1604 1.75 cm
CoT
� � � � �
fforward due to CoT 4 1.75 2.25 cm� � �
� tan180
10 030 0.2
5 13 to port.
��
� � �
Security, cargo documentation, stability examples 289
Chap-10.qxd 3/3/05 9:55 AM Page 289
Appendix A
Miscellaneous cargo information
IntroductionA text of this size cannot hope to cover every commodity or every situationthat Ship’s Officers encounter. Cargoes are varied and can be carried inmany alternative forms. The following brief notes are meant to portray thefundamentals that go along with and support the various chapters andspecifics expressed throughout this work.
Charter PartyA formal agreement to hire, rent or lease a ship. It is a private contractbetween two parties and may be written up in several formats, i.e. TimeCharter, Bare Boat Charter or a Demise Charter.
DemurrageMonies paid by the Charterer to the owner of the ship for delays in loadingand unloading in accord with the terms of the Charter Party. The rate ofdemurrage is fixed and agreed between the owner and Charterer at thetime of completing the Charter Party and cannot be altered. Can be taken in contrast with ‘Despatch Money’ opposite to demurrage where the ownerpays reward money to the Charterer for completing loading and/or discharging earlier than the expiry of ‘Laytime’.
Freeboard Form (FRE 13)Following the completion of cargo operations in a port, the ship’s draughtswill expect to have changed. The draughts fore and aft should be read andthe mean draught obtained.
It is a legal requirement that before the ship sails outward, the ‘Free-board Certificate’ is completed and displayed for the crew to see that thevessel is not overloaded and the minimum bow height is not exceeded(Figure A.1).
App-a.qxd 3/3/05 4:22 PM Page 290
Miscellaneous cargo information 291
DRAUGHT OF WATER AND FREEBOARDNOTICE
Issued by the Departmentof Transport pursuant toSection 10 (2) of theMerchant Shipping (LoadLines) Act 1967
SHIP .............................................................PORT OF REGISTRY .............................................................
GROSS TONNAGE ...................................................................
(Where a ship has alternative gross tonnages, both must be given)
(1) Summer freeboard* .................. millimetres corresponding to a mean draught † of ................. millimetres (equal to ............. feet ............ inches).
(3) Tropical freeboard* .................... millimetres corresponding to a mean draught † of ................. millimetres (equal to ............. feet ............ inches).(2) Winter freeboard* ...................... millimetres corresponding to a mean draught † of ................. millimetres (equal to ............. feet ............ inches).
(6) Timber Summer freeboard* ....... millimetres corresponding to a mean draught † of ................. millimetres (equal to ............. feet ............ inches).(7) Timber Winter freeboard* .......... millimetres corresponding to a mean draught † of ................. millimetres (equal to ............. feet ............ inches).(8) Timber Tropical freeboard* ........ millimetres corresponding to a mean draught † of ................. millimetres (equal to.............. feet ............ inches).(9) Timber Winter North Atlantic freeboard* ................ millimetres corresponding to a mean draught † of ............... millimetres (equal to ............ feet ............ inches).
(10) Allowance for fresh water for timber freeboards* ......................... millimetres.
(4) Winter North Atlantic freeboard* .................................... millimetres corresponding to a mean draught † of ............................... millimetres (equal to ............. feet ............ inches).(5) Allowance for fresh water for ail freeboards other than timber freeboards* ................... millimetres.
* Particulars to be given above of freeboards and allowance for fresh water are to be taken from the load line certificate currently in force in respect of the ship. Paragraphs referring to freeboards which the certificate shows have not been assigned to the ship must must be deleted.
† The mean draught to be given below is the mean of the draughts which would be shown on the scales of measurement on the stem and on the stem post of the ship if it were so loaded that the upper edge of the load line on each side of the ship appropriate to the particular freeboard were on the surface of the water.
Where the draught is shown on the scales of measurement on the stem and on the stem post of the ship in feet the mean draughtmust be given in both millimetres and feet and inches using an equivalent of 25.4 millimetres to one inch.
PARTICULARS OF LOADING1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Date Place
Forward Aft MeanActual (seenotes 1 and
2 below)
Corrected(see note3 below)
Master An Officer
ACTUAL DRAUGHT MEAN FREEBOARD SIGNATURE OF MASTER AND AN OFFICER
NOTES (1) The actual mean freeboard (column 6) is the mean of the freeboards on each side of the ship at the time when the ship is loaded and ready to leave. (2) If the actual mean freeboard is less than the appropriate minimum salt water freeboard as shown on the load line certificate there must be entered in Column 7 the corrected freeboard arrived at after making any allowances for density of water, rubbish to be discharged overboard and fuel, water and stores to be consumed on any stretch of river or inland water, being allowances duly entered in the ship's official log book. (3) If the actual mean freeboard is greater than the appropriate salt water freeboard, Column 7 need not be filled in.
This Notice should be posted in some conspicuous place on board the ship, where it can be seen by all members of the crew, before the shipleaves any dock, wharf, harbour or other place for the purpose of proceeding to sea and is to be kept so posted until after the ship arrives at anyother dock, wharf, harbour or place.
The date and time of recording the above particulars on each occasion must be entered in the Official Log Book.
This Form should not be handed in with the Official Log Book and Agreement at the termination of the Agreement. It can be used untilcompleted, when a further copy should be obtained.
Form FRE 13
Fig. A.1.
App-a.qxd 3/3/05 4:22 PM Page 291
292 Cargo Work for Maritime Operation
FreightCharges made for carriage of the cargo. Advance freight is money paidbefore the delivery of the cargo – freight being payable concurrently withdelivery of the cargo at the port of destination.
Heavy weather and cargo proceduresIn the event of heavy weather possibly affecting a ship’s passage, certainobvious precautions, depending on the nature of the cargo carried, can beadopted to protect the cargo condition:
1. Investigate an alternative route for the vessel clear of weather-affectedareas.
2. Improve the ship’s stability and reduce any free surface effects.3. Tighten up on any cargo lashings, especially deck cargo lashings and
heavy lifts.4. Reduce speed in ample time to avoid the vessel pounding.5. Adjust the ship’s head to avoid excessive rolling.6. Close up ventilators to avoid water ingress.7. Check all hatch and access seals are secure.
LaytimeDescribed as that time which is available to the Charterer to load or dischargethe Chartered Cargo, free of any charge other than the freight charges.Laytime cannot commence until three conditions have been satisfied that:
1. the vessel is an arrived ship (under legal terms)2. Notice of Arrival has been tended (it does not need to have been accepted)3. the vessel is in all respects ready to load or discharge.
Lifting plant – tests and examinationIt is a legal requirement that lifting apparatus like derricks and cranes areperiodically tested:
● after installation when new● following any defect and major repair to the plant● at intervals not exceeding five (5) years.
Additionally, it would be considered a normal practice for the CargoOfficer to inspect the lifting appliances prior to their use. Each apparatuswould also be thoroughly examined by a responsible person (i.e. the ChiefOfficer) at least every twelve (12) months.
Notice of protestMasters would ‘Note Protest’ for any of the following cargo reasons:
1. Whether damage has been caused or is suspected of being caused to cargo.2. Whenever the ship has encountered heavy weather which may have
resulted in damage to cargo.
App-a.qxd 3/3/05 4:22 PM Page 292
3. Where cargo is known to have been damaged through a peril of the sea.4. Where cargo is shipped in such a state that it is likely to deteriorate during
the voyage (Bills of Lading (B/L) should be also endorsed in this case).5. Where a serious breach of the Charter Party has occurred by the Charterer
or his agent, e.g. refusing to load cargo, or delaying the loading, loadingimproper cargo.
6. In all cases of general average being declared.7. When consignees fail to take delivery of cargo and pay due freight in
accord with the terms of the Charter Party or B/L.
Oil-filtering and monitoring equipment (oil water separators)Every ship of 400 GT and above, but less than 10 000 GT, shall be fitted withoil-filtering equipment which complies with an approved design in accor-dance with the specifications for such equipment as set out in the recom-mendations on International Performance and Test Specifications for oilywater separating equipment and oil content meters.
Every ship over 10 000 GT and above shall be provided with:
1. oil-filtering equipment (as stated)2. oil-content-measuring equipment fitted with a 15 parts per million
(ppm) alarm device and with arrangements for automatically stoppingany discharge of oily mixture when the oil content in the effluentexceeds 15 ppm.
Oil record booksCurrent legislation require oil tanker vessels to carry two (2) Oil RecordBooks, one for cargo movement and one for fuel movements. Non-tankertype vessels are only required to carry one (1) Oil Record Book.
Entries into Oil Record Books should cover any movement of oil in or outof the vessel, including internal transfers between tanks. Each entry in thebook should be signed by the Ship’s Master and another officer.
SecurityThe Master of the Vessel should not be constrained by the company, theCharterer or any other person, from making a decision which, in his pro-fessional judgement as the master, is necessary to maintain the safety andsecurity of the ship. This includes the loading of cargo, including contain-ers or other enclosed cargo transport units, which may have a direct threatto the well-being of the vessel or personnel on-board.
Vapour-recovery systems (protecting theenvironment)More and more use is being made of Vapour-Recovery Systems in orderto reduce emissions of volatile organic compounds (VOCs) in offshoreoperations. This expansion is currently being pushed by Norway, which is
Miscellaneous cargo information 293
App-a.qxd 3/3/05 4:22 PM Page 293
introducing legislation to ensure that all offshore loading operations havereduction plants in operation by 2005. When cargo tanks are loaded withcrude, hydrocarbon gas emissions are vented to air and the loss may beestimated to between 100 and 300 tonnes for each loading. The recoverysystems are meant to be economic and currently three types are employed:
1. Absorption of non-methane VOCs (NMVOCs) into the crude beingloaded.
2. Liquefaction and the storage of NMVOCs to be discharged at a later time,or used as onboard fuel.
3. Sequential transfers of tank atmospheres during the cargo operations ofloading and discharging.
Reliquefied VOC emissions can be used to fuel the VOC recovery plant aswell as similar steam-driven on-board systems. It can also be used as ablanket gas in cargo tanks instead of inert combustion gases. Further usecan be achieved by discharging it ashore for use as fuel or further refining.
294 Cargo Work for Maritime Operation
App-a.qxd 3/3/05 4:22 PM Page 294
Appendix B
Self-examiner – questions andrecommended answers to cargorelated examples
Calculations and questions
Example 1Calculate by how many millimetres a ship may submerge her loadlinewhen she is currently loading in dock water of relative density (RD) 1.013,if the vessel has a fresh water allowance (FWA) of 190 mm.
Summer loadline may be submerged by 91 mm.
Example 2A rectangular tank of 9 m length and 6 m breadth has a depth from theullage plug of 11 m. Find how many tonnes of oil of a RD of 0.83 does thetank contain when the ullage is 350 mm?
Depth of tank � 11.0 mUllage � 0.35 m
Depth of oil � 10.65 m
Therefore the volume of oil 9 6 10.65 m57
3� � �
� 55.1 mWeight of Oil Volume Density
575.1 0
3
� �
� � ..83477.33 tonnes.�
Dock Water Allowance FWA(1.025 water densi
� �� tty number)
1.000
190(1.025 1.013)
1 025
0 0
.
.
�
� ��
225
� �
�
190(0.012)0.025
91 mm
App-b.qxd 3/3/05 9:56 AM Page 295
Example 3What is the smallest purchase that could be used to lift a 5 tonne weightwith flexible steel wire rope having a safe working load (SWL) of the wireequal to 3.125 tonnes?
Assuming the purchase is to be used to disadvantage P � n.
Therefore a gun tackle is the minimum purchase to use for this lift.
Example 4Calculate the maximum number of tonnes which can still be loaded intoa vessel whose tonnes per centimetre (TPC) � 19 and FWA � 190 mm.Her loaded salt water freeboard is 2310 mm and her present freeboardsare 2420 (starboard (Stbd)) and 2404 mm (port), in water of RD 1.009.
Present freeboards 2420 mm Stbd
2404 mm Porttrue mean freeboard � 2412 mm
Corresponding salt freeboard
2412 � 121.6 � 2533.6 mm
Permitted freeboard � 2310 mm
Sinkage allowed � 223.6 mm
(TPC � 19, TPmm � 1.9) � 1.9
Cargo to load � 424.84 tonnes
where TPmm represents tonnes per millimetre.
Example 5A cargo tank with an area of 75 m2 is being filled from a pipe of 200 mmin diameter. The ullage is now 1.6 m. Calculate how much longer the filling valve must be left open to obtain an ullage of 800 mm, if the aver-age rate of flow through the pipe is 1.75 m/s?
DWA 190(1.025 1.009)
1.000121.6 mm
� ��
��
1 025.
Then 3.125 P(5 P)
105
2.625P 5P 2
� ��
�
�
�
S P WnW10
� � �
296 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
}
App-b.qxd 3/3/05 9:56 AM Page 296
The valve should be left open for a further 18 min.
Example 6A ship is 140 m long and displaces 10 000 tonnes is floating at draughts6.5 m forward and 7.7 m aft. The vessel is scheduled to enter a canalwhere the maximum draught allowed is 7.2 m. Calculate the minimumamount of cargo to discharge from a compartment which is 30 m for-ward of the aft perpendicular. The ship’s TPC � 16, moment to changetrim (MCTC) � 180 and the centre of floatation is amidships.
Example 7What do you understand by the term ‘loadicator’ and what informationwould you obtain from it?AnswerA loadicator is the term given to a cargo-loading computer, which is con-figured to suit the ship’s loading programmes. The loadicator will pro-vide the Cargo Officer with the following information once the weightdistribution is entered into the programme. Distribution of weights or
Change in draught aft 7.7 7.2 0.5 m (50 cm)� � �
CChange in draught aft Rise Change due to C� � hhange of Trim
Therefore 50w
TPC12
(w d)MCTC
� � ��
�� � �� �
�� �
�
w16
12
w (70 30)
360w (16 40w)360
180
1650 �� � � � �
� �
�
16 360 369w (16 40w)288 000 360w 640w
w2888 000
w 288 tonnes represents theminimu
1000�
mm cargo to discharge.
Difference in ullages 1600 mm 800 mm 800 mm� � � (0.8 m)Volume of liquid to load 75 m 0.82� � m 60 mArea of pipe r 3.1416 100 100
31
3
2
�
� � � � �
� 4416 mm31416
1000 1000m
Volume of liquid l
2
2��
ooaded per second31416
1000 10001.75m
Time
3��
�
to load 60 m60 1000 1000
31416 1.75s
109
3 �� �
�� 11 s or 18.18m
Self-examiner – questions and recommended answers 297
App-b.qxd 3/3/05 9:56 AM Page 297
cargo units in the ship’s compartments, the status of relevant tank weightsand commodities, the sea-going shear force and bending moment condi-tions, and the stability aspect with values for measured distance betweenthe keel and the centre of gravity (C of G) of the vessel (KG) and metacen-tric height (GM). Ballast distribution and quantity would also be available.
The loadicator is often linked to a shoreside monitor to allow datatransmission on unit weights for cargo distribution and special stowagerequirements. Particularly relevant to a Roll-on, Roll-off (Ro-Ro) vesselengaged on fast turn round, short voyage trades.
Example 8How would you load a bulk carrier with iron ore?AnswerEnsure that the hold is clean and that bilge suctions are tested to satis-faction prior to commencing loading. Draw up a pre-load plan and a bal-last/deballast plan calculating the stress factors affecting the shipthroughout the proposed loading programme. The maximum angle ofheel would also be calculated for a potential shift in the cargo volume,bearing in mind that a moisture content is present in the cargo.
The loading rates for the cargo would commence slowly and graduallyincrease. Fast rates of loading can cause serious damage by generatingrapid stress values throughout the ship’s length. The important aspect isthat iron ore is a dense cargo and heavy. The cargo compartments wouldonly be about one-fourth full. The Chief Officer would calculate the stabil-ity based on the load draughts. Condition formats for the bendingmoment and shear force affecting the loaded condition would be drawnup (stowage factor (SF) iron ore 0.34/0.50).
Example 9What are the concerns for the Master of a Container Vessel, carrying con-tainers stacked on deck, engaged on the North Atlantic trade in winter?AnswerThe Master, and his Chief Officer would be concerned about the positivestability of the vessel, bearing in mind that the possibility of encounteringsub-freezing air temperatures on this trade route at this time is likely. Suchconditions could lead to ice accretion, and added weight from icing ofthe container stack could detrimentally affect the stability of the vessel.
Masters would monitor all weather reports and consider re-routingfarther south to warmer latitudes if practical. A reduction in speed couldalso effectively reduce the rate of ice accretion occurring on the vessel.Where possible, the crew should be ordered to make their best endeav-ours to remove ice formations if safe to do so.
Example 10When working as a Cargo Officer aboard an oil tanker, how would youkeep the tanks outside the ‘flammable limit’?
298 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
App-b.qxd 3/3/05 9:56 AM Page 298
AnswerThe introduction of inert gas into any tank containing hydrocarbon gas/airmixture will decrease the flammable range until a point is reached wherethe lower flammable limit (LFL) and the upper flammable limit (UFL)coincide. This point corresponds to the oxygen content approximately11% at which no hydrocarbon gas/air mixture can burn.
Self-examiner – questions and recommended answers 299
Note: Additional reference should be made to the ‘FlammabilityComposition Diagram’ found in International Safety Guide for OilTankers and Terminals (ISGOTT).
Example 11What and when is ‘lateral drag’ evident and what can the Cargo Officerdo to reduce the effects?AnswerLateral drag is associated with heavy lifts causing the vessel to heel overas the weight is taken up by the ship’s derrick/crane. It can occur duringloading or discharging of the load and is effectively a sideways move-ment of the load as the vessel returns to the upright. If unprepared for,the lateral movement of the load can be violent as the ship rolls againstthe angle of list.
The effects of lateral drag can be reduced by retaining the line of plumbof the derrick head above the point of landing. This can be achieved by‘coming back’ on the topping lift and cargo hoist runner, quickly. Thisaction tends to reduce movement of the load when discharging. If load-ing the weight a steady slow lifting operation should be carried out.
Example 12When about to make a heavy lift by means of the ship’s heavy derrick,how can the vessel’s stability condition be improved so that positive stability is retained throughout the loading period?AnswerThe concern with loading a heavy weight is that the C of G of the weighteffectively acts from the head of the derrick. The GM of the ship shouldbe increased by filling the double bottom tanks before the lift is made.This will increase the GM value. Additionally, eliminate any free surfacemoments in tanks, as this also will reduce the GM value.
Example 13How can the risk of a grain cargo shifting be reduced?AnswerGrain should be loaded in accord with the ‘Grain Regulations’ and therisk of ‘shifting’ of the cargo can be reduced by:
1. fitting of temporary longitudinal subdivisions (shifting boards)2. use of bagged cargo in a saucer formation3. bundling in bulk.
App-b.qxd 3/3/05 9:56 AM Page 299
Example 14How would you describe the ‘SF’ of a commodity?AnswerThe SF can be defined as that volume that is occupied by a unit weightof cargo and is usually expressed in cubic metres per tonne (m3/tonne).
For example, how much cotton at a SF of 2.0 m3/tonnes could be loadedinto a tween deck space of 200 m3
Example 15When loading drop trailers and mobile units aboard a Ro-Ro ferry, explainwhy it is essential that the vessel is kept in the upright position.AnswerRo-Ro ferries load their mobile units via vehicle ramps either at the bowor more often through the stern door. These ramps are lowered onto linkspans that provide the landing connection between ship and shore. If thevessel develops a list the ramps become angled to the flat shore connec-tion and prevents the movement of vehicles to and from the ship’sgarage spaces.
Most modern ferries will have automatic stabilizing tank systems tocounter any overload to Port or Starboard, so keeping the vessel always inthe upright position and vehicle ramps flush on the shore or the link span.
TonnageVolume of space
SF200
2100 tonnes c
� �
� ootton.
By example: SFVolume of space
Tonnage�
300 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Note: Over-reliability on tank stabilizers should be avoided and safepractice is always to load and discharge in an even manner to avoidany one side ever become adversely affected by localized tonnage.
Example 16When would it be considered appropriate to carry out a ‘draught survey’?AnswerThe purpose of a draught survey being conducted would usually be to:
1. ascertain any bending along the length of the vessel, usually after theloading of a bulk cargo
2. determine the exact displacement in order to calculate the totalweight of cargo loaded.
App-b.qxd 3/3/05 9:56 AM Page 300
Example 17A vessel is scheduled to load sacks of mail. How would these be loadedon a general cargo vessel if they are loose and not in a container, andwhat precautions would a prudent Chief Officer take? (Figure B.1)
Self-examiner – questions and recommended answers 301
Cargo box
(b)
Cargo net
(a)
Fig. B.1
AnswerMails are classed as a specialized cargo and as such would be given lock-up stow.
The bags would be tallied in and tallied out at the ports of loading anddischarge, respectively. Watchmen or responsible Ship’s Officers wouldmonitor the movement of the mails probably being loaded by means ofcargo nets or cargo boxes.
Example 18What cargo information would the Master of a ‘Bulk Carrier’ pass to theloading terminal when expecting to berth, to take a full cargo of coal?Answer1. In addition to passing the ship’s particulars, a pre-loading plan of
cargo stowage by hatch, together with the hatch loading order andrespective quantities on each pour, assuming that the vessel has suf-ficient information to prepare such a plan. Confirmation that holdswere in a state of readiness to load.
2. The provisional arrival and departure draughts together with detailsof the ship’s own cargo-handling gear and respective capacities of same; details of the ballast capacity and the time required to de-ballast.
3. Additional ship-keeping details reflecting the ‘gangway’ position, the number of moorings, etc. would also be included as standardinformation.
App-b.qxd 3/3/05 9:56 AM Page 301
Example 19For what purpose would a Cargo Officer use the ‘load density plan’?AnswerThe Ship’s Chief Officer would use the load density plan to check the capacity of cargo compartments to ascertain the volume of the space andconsider the ‘point loading’ factor to ensure that the deck strength is ade-quate to accommodate the intended cargo tonnage to be stowed in thespace. Particularly useful with heavy lifts where a concentrated weightover a small area may be seen to exceed the tonnage per square metre.
Example 20What is contained in the Register of Lifting Appliances and Cargo-Handling Gear?AnswerThe ‘Register’ is kept up-to-date by the Ship’s Chief Officer and containsall the certificates for the lifting appliances, the wires, shackles hooks,chains, etc. used aboard the vessel, for cargo operations.
302 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
App-b.qxd 3/3/05 9:56 AM Page 302
Codes and conventions effecting cargo work operationsCode of Safe Working Practice for Merchant Seaman
Code of Safe Working Practice for the Loading and Unloading of BulkCargoes
Inert Gas Code
IMDG, Code (Hazardous Cargoes)
IMO (BLU Code)
IMO, Code of Safe Working Practice for Cargo Stowage
IMO, Construction and Equipment Code (Ships Carrying DangerousChemicals in Bulk)
IMO, Grain Regulations
IMO, ISPS Code
International Bulk Cargo CodeInternational Code for the Safe Carriage of GrainInternational Safety Management Code
MARPOL Convention and Subsequent Amendments
Merchant Shipping Regulations for Control of Noxious Liquid Substancesin Bulk
Merchant Shipping (Load Lines) (Deck Cargo) Regulations
SOLAS ’74 Convention (and Subsequent Amendments)
ICS Tanker Safety Guide (Chemicals)
Appendix C
Codes and conventions affecting cargo work operations, additional references andbibliography
App-c.qxd 3/3/05 12:24 PM Page 303
304 Cargo Work for Maritime Operations
Additional references
Statutory instrumentsS.I. 1509: 1997, The Merchant Shipping (Cargo Ship Construction)Regulations 1997S.I. 1644: 1999, The Merchant Shipping (Additional Safety Measures forBulk Carriers)S.I. 336: 1999 Merchant Shipping-Safety. M.S. (Carriage of Cargoes)RegulationsS.I. 929: 2004, Gas Carrier Amendment RegulationsS.I. 930: 2004, Dangerous or Noxious Liquid Substances in Bulk: AmendmentRegulationsMGN 144, The Merchant Shipping (Additional Safety Measures for BulkCarriers) Regulations 1999MGN 157, Safety of Personnel during Container Securing Operations, MCAMIN 154 (M) Safe Loading of Bulk Carriers
BibliographyRecommendations on the Safe Transport of Dangerous Cargoes andRelated Activities in Port Areas, IMOCargo Access Equipment, published by Clarke ChapmanCargo Stowage and Securing, A Guide to Good Practice, Charles BliaultCode of Safe Practice for Cargo Stowage and Securing, IMOCode of Safe Practice for Ships Carrying Timber Deck Cargoes, IMODesign and Operation of Ships Derrick Rigs, British Standards InstituteHatch Cover Inspections, W. Vervloesem, Nautical InstituteInternational Code for the Safe Carriage of Packaged Irradiated NuclearFuel, Plutonium and High-Level Radioactive Wastes on Board Ships, IMOInternational Safety Guide for Oil Tankers and Terminals (ISGOTT),WitherbysLashing and Securing of Deck Cargoes, Capt. J.R. Knott, BA.FNI, NauticalInstituteThomas’ Stowage, Brown Son and Ferguson
App-c.qxd 3/3/05 12:24 PM Page 304
Commodity and detail index
This commodity index, lists numerous cargo type and product varieties,but it is not exhaustive. Not all items are detailed within the main text andusers are advised to reference shipper’s documentation as well as otherassociated works.
Limited detail on commodities is enclosed together with the stowage fac-tor where appropriate and the relevant page number if considered withinthe main body of this work.
Commodity name and details Stowage Page factor reference(m3/tonne)
Acetone In drums, see IMDG code 2.35–2.5Acids Highly corrosive. IMDG code. – 272
Handling precautions requiredAgricultural In crates 1.39–2.23machineryAmmonia LPG cargo carriage. IMDG – 174
code referenceAmmunition Magazine stowage. (Dynamite) Various 261, 265
Dangerous goods IMDG codeAnaesthetics May need temperature controls. – 163
Special lock-up stowage as drugsAnchor Cable Flaked flat athwartships in holds Variable with
and generally overstowed cable diameterApples Temperature control carriage. Cartons 2.37–2.65 198Apricots Dried fruit 1.39–1.45 87
Fresh 2.56–2.78Asbestos in See IMDG code 1.53–1.67casesAsphalt Contains drying oils and liable to 1.39
spontaneous combustion. Should be properly dry
Bacon Cool stowage 1.73–1.84 198Bale goods Various, e.g. Cotton -700 lbs per bale 3.62–3.76 80
(contd.)
CommodityIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:08 PM Page 305
Bagged goods Various commodities 2.0–2.23 25, 26, 78–80Bananas Mostly in cartons at a carriage 199–200
temperature of 12/13ºCCartons 3.63–3.90
Barbed wire In reels 1.56–1.67Barley Grain regulations. Bulk 1.36–1.50 107
Bagged 1.45–1.67Barrels Stowed on side bung up, e.g. 1.73–1.78 82, 83
Castor Oil (also in drums) 1.67–1.73Codfish (salted) 1.90–2.00Colza Oil (also in drums) 1.67–1.73 Creosote (also in drums or bulk) 1.67–1.87 161Fish Oil (also in bulk) 1.62–167Glucose 1.28–1.34Tung Oil 1.78–1.81
Bean cargoes In bags, e.g. 79Cocoa, coffee, soya, etc. 2.17average S/FSome products also shipped in bulk
Beef (Chilled) cartons 1.53–3.76 197(Frozen) 2.37–2.79(Chilled) boneless 1.67–1.74
Beer Bottled in cartons or in casks 1.39–1.84 82(empty casks/drums)Cartons 1.50–1.56Casks 1.95–2.09Bottled 8.36–9.75
Bitumen Inflammable shipped - In solid or liquid form. Will taint other cargoes. (RD 1.00-1.10)Barrels 1.25–1.35 161Drums 1.28–1.39Casks 1.53
Bone meal Stow clear of edible goods. Bags 1.11–1.25 78Bones in bulk 2.23
Bricks In crates 0.70Bulk cargoes Various commodities Varies between 100–125
0.31–2.81Bullion, Valuable cargoes Various 71, 88bank notes, Tally in and tally out, lock up stowstamps, etc.Butane LPG cargo carriage 173Butter Dairy product in cases 1.45-1.50 197
Cable Stowed on reels which must be Size variant 88secured against movement
Canned fruits Cartons 1.67
306 Commodity and Detail Index
Commodity name and details Stowage Page factor reference(m3/tonne)
CommodityIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:08 PM Page 306
Carbon Black Bags often on pallets. Very dirty 1.67cargo may siftProtect other cargoes, see IMDG code
Cars designated car carrier. Individual cars 4.18–8.3 223–229may also be shipped in containers or in open stow. 400 mm required between car unitsCrated motor cycles 3.34
Carpets Valuable cargo in bales 2.79–3.34 80Case goods Various Size variant 85Casks Various commodities, e.g. 86
China Clay 1.23–1.34Chutney 1.06–1.11Copper Sulphate (highly corrosive) 1.23–1.28Glue (liquid) 3.07–3.34Ginger 1.58–1.81Stearine (natural fat) 1.73–1.78
Cattle meal cake Bags or bulk 1.95–2.09 78Caustic Soda IMDG code reference. Drums 0.95Cement Different specific gravities. Unitized 0.72–0.79 78, 240
Bags 0.65–0.70Drums 0.98–1.11Bulk 0.61–0.64
Cheese Temperature sensitive 198Crates 1.48–1.62Cartons 1.00–1.34Cases 1.20–1.25
Chemicals Various 78, 161IMDG code, bulk chemical code –
China ware/ Various packages 3.34–5.57porcelain Careful handling - usual for
container shipmentCinnamon Highly scented stow away from 91
other cargoesBundles 3.62–3.90Cases 2.79
Cloves May damage by moisture. Ventilate 91well and stow away all other goods. Liable to damageChests 3.07–3.21Bales 3.07–3.34Bags 3.38–3.42
Coal IMDG code 1.25–1.35 91, 117Bulk requires surface ventilationStowage factor variants depending on Country of origin
Commodity and detail index 307
Commodity name and details Stowage Page factor reference(m3/tonne)
(contd.)
CommodityIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:08 PM Page 307
Cocoa Beans in bags 2.0–2.15 79Coconut oil Bulk, deep tank carriage 1.06 92Coffee Beans in bags 1.81–2.09 79Coir (Coconut fibre) in bales 2.79Coke Bulk. Absorbs 20% of its weight in 1.95–2.79 117
moisture if carried as deck cargoConcentrates May need shifting boards Varies on 101, 121Bulk commodity
Average 0.50–0.56e.g. Copper concentrates 0.39–0.50Zinc concentrates 0.56–0.61
Condensed milk Cases 1.25–1.28Confectionary In cases or cartons 2.34Containers Generally, goods stowed in 230–258
containers are under the same conditions as open stow
Copper Ingots, ore, coils or concentrates 117-119Coils 0.84
Copra Stow away from edible foods 79, 122Highly infested with copra ‘bugs’Troublesome to humans, bulk (hold) 1.95Avoid steelwork contact (tween deck) 2.09–2.15 T/D Bags (hold) 2.09, 2.37 T/D
Corn Grain regulations apply, bulk 1.25–1.41 107Or in bags 1.39–1.53
Cotton Waste. Liable to spontaneous 3.90–4.46 80combustion shipped in bales. Cotton goods in cartons. NB. Cotton seed classed as grain, under IMO
Crude oil Tanker cargo (S.G. 0.8/0.9) 126–149
Dairy products Various. Usually shipped in cartons or varies with 195, 197, 198cases e.g. Eggs, butter, cheese, etc. commodity
Diesel oil (S.G. 0.6 / 0.9) 130, 161Dried Blood In bags 1.11–1.67 79Dyes May be powder, liquid or in paste Varies on 86
form. See IMDG code. May cause package typestaining
Earthenware Mixed parcelsPipes 1.48–1.67Crates 2.79–3.34Cases 1.81–1.95Unpacked 5.57
Eggs In boxes 2.93–3.48 198In liquid form. Frozen cases and packs 1.11–1.25
308 Commodity and Detail Index
Commodity name and details Stowage Page factor reference(m3/tonne)
CommodityIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:08 PM Page 308
Elephants On deck. Full grown animals weigh 200, 201upto 3 tonnes. Allow for 120 litres of water and 280 kg of food per day. Bills of laden should be endorsed to show that the ship is not responsible for mortality during passage (see livestock)
Esparto Grass (Fibre in bales) 3.62–4.74 81Liable to spontaneous combustion
Ethyl Acetate Inflammable liquid, drums 1.50–1.78Ethyl Chloride Inflammable liquid, drums 3.62Ethylene Fully refrigerated 174Explosives Dangerous Goods. Ammunition, 261, 265
dynamite and fireworks. See IMDG code may require magazine stowage depending on type
Fertilizers In bags or bulk 1.39–1.67Fibres In bales 2.79–3.34 81Fish (Frozen) 198
Boxes or cartons -18º to -15ºC 2.50Little danger of taint.Shellfish, crates/cartons 2.28Crustaceans, crates/cartons 2.34
Fishmeal Liable to spontaneous combustion 79Bags must be well dunnaged to 1.73–1.81provide adequate ventilationBulk fishmeal may be in pellet or 1.34powder formSpace must be full to avoid shifting
Fish oil May be shipped in bulk or tins in casesBulk 1.09Cased tins 1.39–1.48
Flour Bags. Keep off steelwork 1.39–1.59 79, 91Formic acid Corrosive. Reference IMDG codeFruit Green - clean spaces with mechanical 2.37–2.65 87, 88
ventilation (extractor fans) Cases or cartonsDried, cases 1.95–2.09 87Cartons 1.42
Fuel oil (RD 0.92 / 0.99) 161Furniture Large packing cases 1.1–2.2
Garlic in bags Strong smelling 2.65 87Gases (Compressed) in approved cylinders 181, 182
Commodity and detail index 309
Commodity name and details Stowage Page factor reference(m3/tonne)
(contd.)
CommodityIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:08 PM Page 309
Gas Oil (RD 0.84 / 0.87) 161Gasoline Cases, drums or bulk. Highly 1.39–1.4 145, 161
inflammableGinger Preserved in syrup, wet cargo: casks 1.58–1.81
Cases 2.95–2.09Glass Crates stowed end on and supported 1.26–1.53Glue Various methods of carriage. Bales 4.18–5.57
Reference IMDG code, Drums 3.34Cases 1.81–2.09Casks 3.07–3.34
Grain Bags or bulk. Grain Regulations apply 107Bag 1.67–1.81Bulk 1.45–1.67
Grapes Must have cool ventilation 198Cases/cartons 3.29–4.18
Grass seed Bags 1.39–4.18Guano Must not be carried with foodstuffs . 121
Bulk or bagsBags 1.17–1.23Bulk 1.11
Gunpowder IMDG code (see explosives)
Hay/straw In bales 3.34–4.46Hides Shipped in dry or wet condition. 95
Casks, barrels, bales or loose. May be on pallets. Strong smelling ventilateLoose: Dry 2.79–4.18Loose: Wet 1.95Barrels 1.53Bags: wet 1.81–1.95Bags: dry 2.09–2.23Bundles 1.39–1.67
Ingots Copper, lead, etc. 86, 87Aluminium 0.50–0.64Lead 0.28–0.33Tin 0.22–0.28Zinc 0.22–0.33Copper loose 0.28–0.33
Iron (Pig) bulk 0.28–0.33 118Galvanised sheet 0.56Galvanised coils 0.84Ore bulk 0.33-0.42
Jute in bales High fire risk 1.81–1.87
310 Commodity and Detail Index
Commodity name and details Stowage Page factor reference(m3/tonne)
CommodityIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:08 PM Page 310
Kerosene Cases 1.39–1.45 147, 162Drums 1.73-1.78
Lamb Carcases 4.18 197Chilled or frozen carriage - cartons 1.81
Lard Liable to melt with heatIn cases or pails 1.53–1.61Oil in drums 1.67–1.78
Latex Bulk - deep tank stow 1.03 94, 161Or drums 1.38–1.53
Leather Rolls or bales may be valuableBales 1.95–2.79Rolls 5.57
Logs Different wood types stow at various stowage factors because of differing material densitiesTeak 2.23–2.37 190–194Mahogany sq. logs 0.75–0.84
Lubricating oil Usually in cases or 50 gallon drums. 1.48–1.62 161, 162Drums may be deck stowed. (RD 0.85 / 0.95)
Machinery Sometimes cased 1.12–1.53Mail Lock up stow 2.79–4.18 301
Parcels 3.34Maize Grain Regulations apply. Bulk 1.25–1.41 107
Bags 1.39–1.53Meats Chilled of frozen. Cases/cartons 1.81–2.23 197
Mutton- frozen 2.92–3.06Meat meal in bags 2.23–2.37
Melons in crates Adequate ventilation 2.79–3.34Molasses (RD 1.20 / 1.45) Bulk 0.74 94, 162
Drums 1.39–1.67
Nitrates In either bags or bulk. IMDG code 1.11 121reference
Nuts In bags or bulk. Cool, dry stowage. 1.95 122S/F varies on type
Oakum In bales 2.51–2.79 81Pressed bales 1.95–2.09
Oats Liable to heat. Grain Regulations 1.67–1.94 107apply. BulkBags 1.81–2.06
Offal Frozen 2.32–2.37 197
Commodity and detail index 311
Commodity name and details Stowage Page factor reference(m3/tonne)
(contd.)
CommodityIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:08 PM Page 311
Oil (Palm) Heating required - Bulk 1.09Barrels 1.62–1.67
Oil cake In bags 1.53–1.95IMDG code Varies
Olives In kegs or drums 1.90–1.95Olive oil Barrels drums or bulk 1.67–1.73Onions Good ventilation 199
May taint. Cases and crates 2.23–2.29 20020 bags per ton 2.37–2.51
Oranges Cases or cartons 1.67–1.81 198Tainting damage possible
Ores Various types of varying densities 119(in bulk or stated otherwise)Iron 0.33–0.42Zinc 0.56–0.67Bismuth in bags 0.84Chrome 0.34Aluminium 0.84–0.92Manganese 0.47–0.50(Galena) Lead 0.36–0.39
Paint In drums 0.50–0.56 86Paper Keep dry and requires careful handling 87
Reels 1.20–2.65Bales 1.3–1.8Rolls 1.67 and 1.81
Peaches In cartons. Refrigeration. 3.78 87, 88Pears Fruit cases or cartons 2.05–2.96 87, 88Pepper/spices In bags 2.06–2.51 91Personal Effects Usually in crates 2.83 88, 89Phosphates In bulk: granular 1.12 121
Rock 0.92–0.98Pig Iron Bulk. Angle of repose 36º 0.30 118Pipes Bundles 1.67 273, 274Pit Props In bundles 6.41–7.25 190Plums In cartons 2.34–2.41 87, 88Potatoes Bags 1.53–1.81 79
Crates or cartons 1.62–1.90Poultry Crates or cartons. Deep frozen 1.67–2.23 197Prunes In cases or bags (Dried fruit) 1.39–1.45 87Pulses Bulk 0.47 107
Radio active Stow away from crew reference Varies 261, 263materials IMDG code 1.53–2.09Rags In balesRailway iron As rails 0.36–0.42 118
312 Commodity and Detail Index
Commodity name and details Stowage Page factor reference(m3/tonne)
CommodityIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:08 PM Page 312
Rice In bags. Liable to heat and sweat 79, 80, 107and susceptible to strong odours. Must be kept dryPaddy rice 1.81–1.95White rice 1.39–1.45
Rope In coils 2.23–2.78Rubber In block or crepe form. Cases 1.90–1.95 81
Bales 1.81–1.87Sheet 1.67Crepe 3.34
Rum See spiritsRye Grain regulations apply. Requires
extensive trimmingBulk 1.39 107Bags 1.53
Salt In bags or bulk. Bags 1.06–1.11 122Bulk 0.98–1.11
Salt rock Granules. Angle of repose 30º. Bulk 0.98–1.06Sand In bulk 0.53–0.56Sanitary ware In cases/crates 4.18Seeds Stowage factor varies with product 1.28 to 3.76 107Sheep dip In drums 1.25–1.53 86Soda Ash In bags (Treat as dirty cargo) 1.11–1.25 79Soya bean Bulk or bags. Bulk 1.23–1.28
Bags, from US 1.59–1.62Spirits In cartons. Inflammable. Special 1.67–1.81 82
lock up stow, highly pilferable. Also carried in bulk tank containers
Steel work Heavy cargo 74–77, 117–119, 272
Bars 0.33–0.45Billets 0.28–0.39Castings 1.12–1.39Plates 0.28–0.33Pig Iron 0.28–0.33
Scrap Various 104, 118Steel coils May weigh up to 20 tonnes. Also as Various 33, 76,
pipes, castings and plant machinery 77, 119Sugar Dry sugar and Green, (raw wet sugar) 79, 121,
132, 240Dry sugar in bulk 1.11–1.25Dry sugar in bags 1.28–1.34Green sugar in bags 1.11–1.17
Sulphur- Shipped in bulk. Fire, dangerous 0.84–0.89 121, 122cargo, IMDG reference
Commodity and detail index 313
Commodity name and details Stowage Page factor reference(m3/tonne)
(contd.)
CommodityIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:08 PM Page 313
Tallow Deep tank stow with heating 1.67–1.78 92Tea Chests: Delicate cargo and must be 2.79–3.07 91
stowed away from odorous commodities
Tiles Crates 0.98–1.39Timber Carried in many forms and as deck Various 188–194, 275
cargo. Danger from absorption when on deck
Tin See ingots 86Tin plate Bulk packs 0.28–0.39Tobacco In cases 2.23–3.34 81, 91Tomatoes In crates and boxes 1.95–2.09Tyres 4.18–4.87
Vegetable oils Oil or fat from plants. Shipped in 1.67 94, 162drums or deep tanks
Vehicles See cars. Ro-Ro and car carriers
Whale oil In drums 2.09 162In bulk 1.14
Wheat Bagged or bulk. Grain regulations 82, 84, apply 107, 162Bulk 1.18–1.34Bags 1.34–1.50
Whiskey Bottled in cartons (see spirits) S/F 1.67. Also in bulk in container tanks
Wild animals Livestock – 200, 201Wine Cases (bottled) Also now in bulk 1.67–1.95 6, 82–84,
tanker vessels. Cases 126Wood pulp Liable to damage by moisture. 1.25–1.39 81, 189
Shipped in balesWool In bales will vary depending on 0.48 81
country of origin. Average
The reader should note that modernization, especially the use of containers has renderedmany packaging systems obsolete. However, produce packed into containers tends togenerally follow the normal standards regarded as necessary for the safe carriage ofcommodities as ‘General Cargo’ procedures dictated.
314 Commodity and Detail Index
Commodity name and details Stowage Page factor reference(m3/tonne)
CommodityIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:08 PM Page 314
General index
AAbbreviation list xiii–xviiiAbsorption 189, 195, 287Acids and corrosives 272Adiabatic expansion 163Air draught 2Ammonia 94, 161, 305Ammunition 201Anaesthetics 163Anchor cable 305Angle of heel 35, 63Angle of Repose 101Apples 198, 305Apricots 87, 305Asbestos 305Asphalt 305Auto ignition 163, 259
BBACAT 229Back stays 33Bacon 198Bagged cargoes 25, 26, 78–80Bale goods 80Bale Space capacity 2Ballast Management 95, 96, 282Ballast Management Record Book 146Bananas 199, 200Banknotes 259Barley 306Barrels 82, 83Bean cargoes 78, 306Bearers 34Beef 197, 306Beer 82Bill of Lading 89, 282
Bitumin 161, 306Boiling point 163Bone meal 78Bow Visor 206, 213Breaking Strength 34Bricks 306Bridle 20, 34Broken Stowage 2Broken Wire 7Bulk:
Cargoes 100–125Carrier (construction) 103, 105Chemical Code 127, 165Chemicals 129, 163Code of Safe Working Practice
103, 172Density 101Double hulls 105, 166Fluids 93Hold preparation (Bulk cargo) 106Liquefied gases 128References 100Structural Standards 105
Bullion 259Bulldog grips 34Bull wire 34, 38Butane 162Butter 197, 306
CCable reels 87Canned fruits 306Cant 189Carbon Black 307Cars 223, 307Car Carrier 223
GeneralIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:09 PM Page 315
Cargo 231Area 127Battens (spar ceiling) 90, 91Blocks 18Box 301Container 231Documentation 282Doors 212Gear 7–32Handling equipment 15Handling equipment (testing and
certification) 15, 64Handling reference 172Hold construction 36–40Identification 81, 266Manifest 282Net 301Officer 2Officer duties 70–72, 120Plans (Stowage plans) 73, 74, 283Plans (Container vessel) 74(Hazardous goods) 269(Pre-Load) 74(Roll On, Roll Off) 74(Tanker) 74Record Book 282Runner 2, 299Securing manual 2, 219, 271, 282Ship 3Spaces 3, 69, 70Stability calculations 285–289Sweat 89, 90Terminology 2–7Types 1Unit 86, 307
Carpets 80, 307Car Carriers 223–229Carrier 259, 260Car slings 25Case goods 85, 307Casks 86, 307Catalyst 163Cattle Food 78, 307Catwalk 86Caustic Soda 307Cement 78, 240Centre of Buoyancy 3Centre of Gravity 3Centre tank 127
Certificate of Fitness 129, 166, 167, 181, 283
Charter Party 283, 290Check wire 39, 40Cheese 198, 307Chief Officer’s cargo duties 283Chemicals 78, 161, 307
Cargo information 168, 172Carrier Class 165, 169Certificate of fitness 166Code (bulk chemicals) 165, 172Compatibility 171Fires 171Hazards 168Loading discharge 170Measuring devices 153, 155Protection 169, 167Tank barriers 175
Chemical Tanker 127, 165, 166Chilled beef 197China ware 307Cinnamon 91, 307Citrus 307Clean Ballast 127Cloves 91, 307Coal 115–117, 301, 307
Fires 116Loading 116Types 117
Codes and Conventions 303Code of Safe Working Practice 103Code of safe Working Practice
(timber) 189Cocoa 79, 308Coconut oil 92, 308Coffee 79, 308Cofferdam 127Coir fibre 308Coke 117, 308Combination Carriers 101, 130Compatibility Tables 172Concentrates 101, 121, 308Contamination 91Containers 230–258, 308Container:
Beam 231, 237Cargo 232Cargo plan 236, 239Cell 231, 237
316 General Index
GeneralIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:09 PM Page 316
Cell Guide 231Documentation 255, 256Gantry crane 232, 238, 252Karrilift 232Lashings 248Loading 234, 235Markings 235Maximum operating gross weight
233Maximum permissible pay load 233New 233On deck 243–249, 271, 298Owner 233Packing certificate 283Refrigerated 241–242Safety Approval plate 233Ship design 232Shipping and Booking 255, 256Sizes 240Stack 233, 241Tank 240Tare weight 234Terminals 251–255Tracking system 236–240Twenty Feet Equivalent Unit
(teu) 234Types 240, 241
Continuous feeding 128Control temperature 260Conveyor system 101Conversion table xix, xxCopper (ingots) 120, 310Copra 79, 122, 308Cords 190Corn 107, 308Corrosives 86Cotton 80Cotton waste 80, 308Cradle 34Crane barge 57Cranes: 18–24
Advantages/disadvantages 28Gantry types 23, 24Wires 20, 34
Creosote 161Critical pressure 164Critical Structural area 128Critical temperature 164Crude oil 128, 161, 308
Crude Oil Washing (COW) 147–149(COW) Nozzle programme 148
Cylinders 260, 266
DDairy products 195, 197, 308Dangerous goods 3, 260–263
Classes 264, 267Marking of 266, 267
Data Logging System 197Deadweight 3
Cargo 3Scale 98
Deals (timber) 190Deck cargoes 259, 271–275, 304Deck water seal 150, 153, 155, 156Dedicated ship 128Deep tanks 92
Cargoes 94Hat box 93Heating coils 94Preparation of 92Use of 94
Deepwell cargo pumps 176–177Demurrage 290Derricks:
Heavy lift 52, 53Jumbo 34Maintenance 16Rigs 8Single swinging 9, 10Specialised types 10–13Stuelcken 52–57
Dew point 89Diesel Oil 161, 308Dirty cargoes 91Discharge 128Dock Water Allowance (formula and
use) 98, 284Document of Authorisation 283Document of Compliance 262, 283Domestic trade 128Double Bottom 37, 38, 237Double gear 34Double Hull tanker construction 134Double luff tackle 14Draught Notice 291Draught Survey 300Dried blood 79, 308
General index 317
GeneralIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:09 PM Page 317
DrumsDunnage 3, 83, 90, 91Dust explosion 122Dyes 86, 308Dynamic test 15
EEarthenware 308Eccentric wheels 39Eggs 198, 308Elephants 220, 309Elevators (cargo) 211Emergency Escape Breathing Device
(EEBDs) 133Emergency temperature 260Emissions 131Enclosed space (entry permit) 184,
186, 187, 283Esparto Grass 81, 309Ethyl Acetate 309Ethyl Chloride 309Ethylene tankers 176Expeller seed 79Explosi-meter 156–158Explosives 261, 265, 309Export licence 262, 283Exposed hazards 268
FFertilizers 309Fibres 81, 309Filling ratio 164Fish 198, 309Fishmeal 79, 309Fish Oil 309Flammable Gas, dust cargoes 122Flammable limits 128, 298, 299Flammable liquid 260Flammable products 128Flammable Range 260Flash point 128, 260–261Flemish eye 3Flemish hook 3Floating crane 47, 57Floodable length 3Foodstuffs 107, 121, 195Flour 79, 91, 309Flow Moisture Point 102Flow state 102Flu gases 150
Fork lift trucks 29–30Freeboard 290, 291Freezing point 164Freight 4, 292Freon 12, 189Freon 22, 185Fruit:
Chilled 198Dried 87, 309Fresh 87, 88, 309Green 88Juices 85
Fuel Oil 161, 309Furniture 309
GGarbage 128Garlic 87, 309Gas 181, 182
Cargoes 173–186Carrier 128Code 128Compressed 185, 309Dangerous space 177Detection 186Oil 161, 309Operational Knowledge 177,
179–187Safe space 177
Gases 272Gasoline 145, 161, 310General Cargo:
Handling 7Properties 69Vessel construction 36
Ginger 310Glass (cased) 310Glue 310Gooseneck 4Grabs 104, 119, 120Grain 107, 310
Awareness 113Capacity 4Cargo 107–115, 161, 240Document of Authorisation 113Elevator 112Heeling moment tables 114Measure xxStability 112
Grapes 198, 310
318 General Index
GeneralIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:09 PM Page 318
Grass seed 310Ground handling of cargoes 30,
65, 67Guano 121, 310Gunpowder 310Gun tackle 2, 34Gyn (gin) tackle 14
HHallen derrick 10Handling cargoes 1Harmful substances 128, 260
Loading/discharge 269, 270Stowage 268
Hatch:Covers 23, 38–46Types: 39–45
Direct pull 39–42Folding 43Hydraulic 40–42‘M’ type 45Pontoon 23, 39Rack and pinion 41Single pull fixed chain 43, 44Weather deck 40
Hatch work 33–46Hay 310Heating coils 93, 170Heavy Lift cargo 48–63
Beam 49Checklist 143Jumbo derrick 50–52Loading/discharging 47–63, 299Ship 58–62Slinging arrangements 48, 49Stability 47Stuelcken derrick 52–57Tandem lifting 52Top 32, 40Transports 60–63
Heavy weather procedures 292Heeling arm curve 109Hides 95, 310High density cargo 123High speed craft 204, 222Hold preparation 69, 70Hold space 129Holding tank 129Hopper tanks 104Hounds band 4
Hull stress monitors 123–125Hydroscopic 164
IIce accretion 298Ignition point 129Incident (chemicals) 187, 262Incompatible materials 102Inert Gas:
Advantages/disadvantages 155Alarms 155, 158Components 150Deck water seal 155, 156Hazards 153Requirements 151–153System 150–156Voyage cycle 154
Infectious cargoes 123Ingots 86, 314Inhibitor 164Instantaneous rate of discharge 129Insulation 195International:
Bulk Cargo (code) 181Maritime Dangerous Goods (code)
86, 121, 260–270Maritime Dangerous Goods (code0
supplement 262Security Certificate 283Ship and Port Security (code)
277–282Trade 129
Iron 117, 314Bar 118Ore 117Pig 118Railway 118Scrap 118Swarf 118
JJoystick control 11Jumbo derrick 34Jute 310
KKarrilift 232, 258Kerosene 147, 161, 311Kilindo wire 34
General index 319
GeneralIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:09 PM Page 319
LLamb 197, 311Lard 311LASH system 229Lateral drag 34, 299Latex 94, 161, 311Laytime 292Lead block 35Leather 311Lemons 198Lifting beam 35, 49, 50Lifting plant 13, 292
Tests and Inspections 292Lifting purchase 16Limit switch 35Link span 222–224Liquid cargo:
Measurement 137–140Liquefied gases 129, 161, 180Liquid Natural Gas (LNG) 173–175,
179Liquid Propane Gas (LPG) 175, 176Livestock 188, 189, 200, 201, 272Load density plan 4, 35, 302Loadicator 96, 247–251, 297, 298Load lines 96–99Load lines (timber) 97, 98, 189Load line zones 99Load on top 144, 145Loading plan (tanker) 144Loading tanker checklist 143Logs 190–194, 311Long ton 4Lower hold 38Lubricating oil 161, 162, 311Luffing derrick 4Luff tackle 14
MMachinery 311Magazine stowage 261, 265Mails 301, 311Maize 107, 311Manifold connection 138MARPOL (definitions) 126–133MARPOL 262Mast Table 7Mates Receipts 88Measurement cargo 4Meats 197, 311Medical First Aid Guide 260–262
Melons 311Miscible 129Moisture content 102Moisture migration 102Molasses 94, 162, 311Monkey Face Plate (Union plate) 7
NNarcosis 164Nitrates 121, 311Nitrogen oxides 129Note of Protest 284Noxious Liquid Substance 129, 127Nuts 122, 311
OOakum 81, 311Oats 107, 311Offal 311Offshore Supply 274Oil:
Cake 312Calculations 128Cargo carriage 132Discharge 146Drums 272Fuel Unit 129Mixture 130Record book 146, 293Seed 78Tanker 130
Olives 312Olive Oil 312Onions 87, 312Optional cargo 92Oranges 198, 312Ores (various) 119, 312Overcarried cargo 92Overhauling 35Oxidation 122Oxidizing 164, 261Oxygen analyser 158, 159
PPackaging and labelling 81, 82, 265, 266Padding 164Paints 86, 312Palletization 28Pallet transporter 28, 29Paper cargoes 87, 312Parcel tanker 167
320 General Index
GeneralIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:09 PM Page 320
Passenger ship 4, 281Peaches 317Pears 312, 198Pepper 91, 312Permeability 4Permissible exposure limit 130Permissible length 5Permit to work 187Peroxides 261Personal effects 71, 88, 312Phosphates 121, 312Pig iron 118, 312Pilferage 92Pipelines 134–137
Direct system 135Free flow 137Ring main 136
Pipes 118, 273, 274, 312Pit props 190, 312Plimsoll Mark 97Plumb line 35Plums 312Polymerization 164Pontoon hatches 249Potatoes 79, 312Poultry 197, 312Pour 102Pressure vacuum valve 150Preventor 35Primary barrier 130Product carrier 130, 161–162Project cargo 54–68
Administration 63–64Planning 62–68
Proof load 15Propane 162Protest 284, 292–293Prunes 87, 312Pulses 107Pump rooms 184Purchase 10, 36Purging 180, 183
QQuoins 82, 83
RRadioactive substances 261, 265, 312Railway iron 118, 312Ramps (internal) 205, 211
Ramshorn hook 36, 55, 58Rancidity 95Reaction cargoes 123, 171Reducing agent 164Reefer 189, 195–197, 199
Container units 199–200, 204, 216,240–242
Container ventilation 200Refrigerants 189, 196Refrigerated cargoes 194Refrigeration plant 195, 196References 304Register of Ships Lifting Appliances
and Cargo:Handling Gear 16, 17, 36, 284, 302
Reid Vapour Pressure 164Reliquefaction plant 176, 184, 185Residue 130Rice 79, 80, 107, 313Riding turn 5Rigging Plan 21, 34Right of Ferry 204Ring bolt 5Ring Main system 136Ro-Pax 204, 205, 210Rope 313Ro-Ro (Roll On Roll Off) 202–209
Definitions 204–205Design 206–210Ramps 207–210Stability 220, 221Units 214, 216–218
Rubber 81, 313Rum 313Running rigging 5Rye 107, 313
SSafety tongue 5Safe Working Load (SWL) 5, 13, 14SWL Slings 28Salt 122, 313Sanitary ware 313Saucer 36Schooner guy 5Seattle Hook 8Secondary Barrier 130Securing cargoes 76, 86Security 293
Activity 279–282Cargo 279
General index 321
GeneralIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:09 PM Page 321
Company Security Officer (CSO) 278Incident 279Levels 1, 2 and 3 278, 279Officer (Ship) (SSO) 277, 278(Port facility) (PFSO) 278Plan (ship) 277, 278(Port) 278Threat 279
SeaBee 229Seeds 107, 313Segregation 262, 266, 267Segregated Ballast 131Self examiner (Questions and
Answers) 295–302Self reaction 164Separation of cargoes 91, 111Settled pressure 260Sewage 131Sheep dip 86, 313Sheer legs 5, 57Shifting boards 108–113Shift of cargo (dry) 122Shift of cargo (wet) 122Shift of Grain 108Ship 131Shore 5, 110Shuttle tanker 160Side loading operations 32Sift proof 260Single buoy mooring 126Slings 25–28Slop tank 131Sludge oil 131Snatch block 5Snotter 6, 273Soda ash 79, 313Sounding 139SOPEP 146Soya bean 313Special area 132Special category space 205, 215Specialist cargoes 188Speed crane 6, 10, 18Spider band 6, 52Spirits 82Spontaneous combustion 79, 123Spreader 6, 28, 36, 52Stability 96
Abbreviations 284, 285Booklet 284
Calculations 295Stabilizers 6Standing rigging 6Static test (lifting plant) 15Steadying lines 36Steel Cargoes 74–77, 117–119, 272
Coils 33, 76, 77, 119, 313Loading/discharging 120, 121Ore (iron) 298Plate 77
Stere (timber) 188Stern door 208–210Stowage factor 6, 298, 305Straddle truck 232Stresses (from cargo operations) 144,
145, 244, 251Stuelcken derrick rig 10, 34, 36, 49, 57Sub-division factor 6Sub limitation 157Substantial corrosion 132Sugar 79, 122, 240, 313Sulphur 121, 122, 313Sulphur oxides 131Suspect area 132Swinging derrick 8–10
TTabernacle 36Taint 91Tally Clerk account 88Tallow 92, 314Tallying 71, 88Tandem lifting 52, 54Tank 132, 141
Atmosphere 155–160Ballasting 146Barriers 174, 175Bottom washing 146, 147Cleaning 146Construction (LNG) 175Construction (Chemical) 167Containers 240Cooling 180Cover 132Dome 132Drying 180Entry 184, 186, 187Inerting 180Measurement 141, 142Prismatic 175, 179
322 General Index
GeneralIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:09 PM Page 322
Purging 180, 183Vehicles 216, 268Washing machines 147
Tank top ceiling 91Tanker 126, 187
Cargoes 126–187Definition 132Design 132Discharging 146Equipment Regulations 133Loading 142–145Pipelines 134–137
Tea 91, 314Terminal Operations (containers)
250–258Three fold purchase 14Threshold limit value 133, 164Timber 188–194, 275, 314
Deck cargoes 189, 191, 192, 275Battens 190Boards 190Cant 189Cords 190Examples 190Fathom 190Lashing 189, 191, 192Loadlines 97, 98, 189Logs 190, 192–194Packaged 193, 194Stack 190Stere 190Walkway 192, 271
Time weighted average 133Tin 314Tobacco 81, 91, 314Tomatoes 314Tomming off (see shore) 6, 75Tonne 6Toxic (gas, dust) 123Toxic product 133Transportable moisture limit 102, 284Transport units 266Trimming 103, 114Trunnion 6Tumbler 7Tween deck 37, 45Tyres 314
U‘U’ Bolt 7
Ullage 133, 139, 141, 144, 295Union Plate 7Union Purchase 8–10Union rig 7, 8, 14
VVapour density 164Vapour lines 167, 168Vapour pressure 133, 164Vapour recovery systems 293, 294Vegetable oils 94, 162, 314Vehicle 321
Decks, drainage systems 213–215Securing 218–220Stow 275Types 216, 217
Velle derrick 7, 11–13Velocity ratio 14Ventilation 89, 90
Forced 90Through 89, 90
Void space 133Volatile chemicals 172Volatile liquid 133Volumetric heeling moment 109–112Voyage planning (project cargo) 64–68
WWalk back 7Walkways 271Water Ingress Alarms 103, 105Water reactive 261Weather deck 7Whale oil 162, 314Wheat 72, 107, 156, 314Whessoe Tank Gauge 141Wild animals (see livestock,
commodity index) 314Wine 6, 82–83, 126, 162, 314Wing tanks 133, 237Wires per strand (wps) 7Wire slings 28Wood pulp 81, 189, 314Wool 81, 314Working pressure 261
Y‘Y’ Mast 11, 12Yard and Stay 7Yoke 11, 12, 35
General index 323
GeneralIndex.qxd 3/3/05 4:09 PM Page 323